]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
35121e84ddebda4bfc2b8e0a3da17e51d2e57089
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual.''
26 @end quotation
27 @end copying
28
29 @iftex
30 @iflatex
31 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33 \usepackage{pagestyle}
34 \usepackage{epsfig}
35 \usepackage{pixidx}
36 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39 \else
40 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
42 \pdfcompresslevel=9
43 \fi
44
45 \makeindex
46 \begin{document}
47
48 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
49 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
50 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58 \else
59 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60 \fi
61 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109 }
110
111 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114 {\mbox{}}
115 }
116
117 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118 \gnusdimen 0pt
119
120 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121 \gnuscleardoublepage
122 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123 \chapter{#2}
124 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126 \thispagestyle{empty}
127 \hspace*{-2cm}
128 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131 \end{picture}
132 \clearpage
133 }
134
135 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136 \begin{figure}
137 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138 #3
139 \end{picture}
140 \caption{#1}
141 \end{figure}
142 }
143
144 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164 \section{#1}
165 }
166
167 \newenvironment{codelist}%
168 {\begin{list}{}{
169 }
170 }{\end{list}}
171
172 \newenvironment{asislist}%
173 {\begin{list}{}{
174 }
175 }{\end{list}}
176
177 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178 {\begin{list}{}{
179 \labelwidth=0cm
180 }
181 }{\end{list}}
182
183 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184 {\begin{list}{}{
185 }
186 }{\end{list}}
187
188 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
189 {\begin{list}{}{
190 }
191 }{\end{list}}
192
193 \newenvironment{samplist}%
194 {\begin{list}{}{
195 }
196 }{\end{list}}
197
198 \newenvironment{varlist}%
199 {\begin{list}{}{
200 }
201 }{\end{list}}
202
203 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
204 {\begin{list}{}{
205 }
206 }{\end{list}}
207
208 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213 {
214 {
215 \ifodd\count0
216 {
217 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218 }
219 \else
220 {
221 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222 }
223 }
224 \fi
225 }
226 }
227 {
228 \ifodd\count0
229 \mbox{} \hfill
230 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231 \else
232 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233 \hfill \mbox{}
234 \fi
235 }
236
237 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238 {
239 {
240 \ifodd\count0
241 {
242 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243 }
244 \else
245 {
246 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247 }
248 \fi
249 }
250 }
251 {
252 \ifodd\count0
253 \mbox{} \hfill
254 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255 \else
256 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257 \hfill \mbox{}
258 \fi
259 }
260
261 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
262 {
263 {
264 \ifodd\count0
265 {
266 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267 }
268 \else
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271 }
272 \fi
273 }
274 }
275 {
276 \ifodd\count0
277 \mbox{} \hfill
278 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279 \else
280 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281 \hfill \mbox{}
282 \fi
283 }
284
285 \pagenumbering{roman}
286 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288 @end iflatex
289 @end iftex
290
291 @iftex
292 @iflatex
293
294 \begin{titlepage}
295 {
296
297 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299 \parindent=0cm
300 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304 \vfill
305 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306 \vfill
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309 \newpage
310 }
311
312 \mbox{}
313 \vfill
314
315 \thispagestyle{empty}
316
317 @c @insertcopying
318 \newpage
319 \end{titlepage}
320 @end iflatex
321 @end iftex
322
323 @dircategory Emacs network features
324 @direntry
325 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
326 @end direntry
327 @iftex
328 @finalout
329 @end iftex
330
331
332 @titlepage
333 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
334 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
335 @end ifset
336 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
337 @title Gnus Manual
338 @end ifclear
339
340 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
341 @page
342 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
343 @insertcopying
344 @end titlepage
345
346 @summarycontents
347 @contents
348
349 @node Top
350 @top The Gnus Newsreader
351
352 @ifinfo
353
354 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
355 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
356 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
357 luck.
358
359 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
360 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
361
362 @ifnottex
363 @insertcopying
364 @end ifnottex
365
366 @end ifinfo
367
368 @iftex
369
370 @iflatex
371 \tableofcontents
372 \gnuscleardoublepage
373 @end iflatex
374
375 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379 being accused of plagiarism:
380
381 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384 can even read news with it!
385
386 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391 the program.
392
393 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
394 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
395
396 @heading Other related manuals
397 @itemize
398 @item Message manual: Composing messages
399 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
401 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
402 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
403 @end itemize
404
405 @end iftex
406
407 @menu
408 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
409 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
410 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
411 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
412 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
413 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
414 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
415 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
416 * Various:: General purpose settings.
417 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421 * Key Index:: Key Index.
422
423 Other related manuals
424
425 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
426 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
427 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
428 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
429 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
430
431 @detailmenu
432 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
433
434 Starting Gnus
435
436 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
437 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
438 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
439 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
440 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
441 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
442 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
443 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
444 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
445 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
446
447 New Groups
448
449 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
450 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
451 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
452
453 Group Buffer
454
455 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
456 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
457 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
458 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
459 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
460 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
461 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
462 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
463 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
464 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
465 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
466 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
467 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
468 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
469 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
470 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
471 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
472 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
473
474 Group Buffer Format
475
476 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
477 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
478 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
479
480 Group Topics
481
482 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
483 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
484 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
485 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
486 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
487
488 Misc Group Stuff
489
490 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
491 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
492 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
493 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
494 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
495
496 Summary Buffer
497
498 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
499 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
500 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
501 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
502 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
503 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
504 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
505 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
506 * Threading:: How threads are made.
507 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
508 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
509 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
510 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
511 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
512 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
513 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
514 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
515 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
516 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
517 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
518 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
519 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
520 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
521 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
522 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
523 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
524 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
525 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
526 or reselecting the current group.
527 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
528 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
529 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
530 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
531
532 Summary Buffer Format
533
534 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
535 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
536 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
537 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
538
539 Choosing Articles
540
541 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
542 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
543
544 Reply, Followup and Post
545
546 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
547 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
548 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
549 * Canceling and Superseding::
550
551 Marking Articles
552
553 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
554 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
555 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
556 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
557 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
558 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
559
560 Threading
561
562 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
563 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
564
565 Customizing Threading
566
567 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
568 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
569 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
570 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
571
572 Decoding Articles
573
574 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
575 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
576 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
577 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
578 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
579 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
580
581 Decoding Variables
582
583 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
584 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
585 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
586
587 Article Treatment
588
589 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
590 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
591 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
592 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
593 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
594 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
595 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
596 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
597 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
598 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
599 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
600
601 Alternative Approaches
602
603 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
604 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
605
606 Various Summary Stuff
607
608 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
609 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
610 * Summary Generation Commands::
611 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
612
613 Article Buffer
614
615 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
616 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
617 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
618 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
619 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
620
621 Composing Messages
622
623 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
624 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
625 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
626 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
627 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
628 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
629 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
630 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
631 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
632
633 Select Methods
634
635 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
636 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
637 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
638 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
639 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
640 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
641 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
642 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
643 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
644
645 Server Buffer
646
647 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
648 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
649 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
650 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
651 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
652 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
653 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
654
655 Getting News
656
657 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
658 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
659
660 @acronym{NNTP}
661
662 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
663 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
664 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
665
666 Getting Mail
667
668 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
669 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
670 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
671 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
672 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
673 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
674 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
675 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
676 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
677 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
678 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
679 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
680 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
681
682 Mail Sources
683
684 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
685 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
686 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
687
688 Choosing a Mail Back End
689
690 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
691 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
692 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
693 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
694 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
695 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
696 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
697
698 Browsing the Web
699
700 * Archiving Mail::
701 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
702 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
703 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
704
705 Other Sources
706
707 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
708 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
709 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
710 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
711 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
712
713 Document Groups
714
715 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720
721 Email Based Diary
722
723 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
724 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
725 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
726
727 The NNDiary Back End
728
729 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
730 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
731 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
732
733 The Gnus Diary Library
734
735 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
736 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
737 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
738 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
739
740 Gnus Unplugged
741
742 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
743 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
744 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
745 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
746 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
747 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
748 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
749 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
750 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
751 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
752 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
753 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
754 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
755 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
756
757 Agent Categories
758
759 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
760 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
761 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
762
763 Agent Commands
764
765 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
766 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
767 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
768
769 Scoring
770
771 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
772 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
773 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
774 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
775 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
776 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
777 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
778 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
779 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
780 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
781 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
782 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
783 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
784 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
785 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
786 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
787
788 Advanced Scoring
789
790 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
791 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
792 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
793
794 Searching
795
796 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
797 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
798
799 nnir
800
801 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
802 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
803 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
804
805 Setting up nnir
806
807 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
808
809 Various
810
811 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
812 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
813 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
814 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
815 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
816 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
817 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
818 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
819 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
820 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
821 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
822 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
823 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
824 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
825 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
826 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
827 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
828 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
829 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
830
831 Formatting Variables
832
833 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
834 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
835 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
836 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
837 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
838 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
839 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
840 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
841
842 Image Enhancements
843
844 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
845 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
846 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
847 meant to be shown.
848 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
849 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
850 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
851
852 Thwarting Email Spam
853
854 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
855 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
856 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
857 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
858
859 Spam Package
860
861 * Spam Package Introduction::
862 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
863 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
864 * Spam and Ham Processors::
865 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
866 * Spam Back Ends::
867 * Extending the Spam package::
868 * Spam Statistics Package::
869
870 Spam Statistics Package
871
872 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
873 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
874 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
875
876 Appendices
877
878 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
879 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
880 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
881 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
882 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
883 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
884 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
885 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
886 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
887
888 History
889
890 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
891 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
892 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
893 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
894 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
895 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
896 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
897 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
898
899 New Features
900
901 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
902 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
903 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
904 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
905 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
906 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
907 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
908 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
909
910 Customization
911
912 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
913 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
914 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
915 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
916
917 Gnus Reference Guide
918
919 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
920 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
921 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
922 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
923 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
924 * Group Info:: The group info format.
925 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
926 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
927 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
928
929 Back End Interface
930
931 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
932 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
933 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
934 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
935 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
936 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
937
938 Various File Formats
939
940 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
941 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
942
943 Emacs for Heathens
944
945 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
946 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
947
948 @end detailmenu
949 @end menu
950
951 @node Starting Up
952 @chapter Starting Gnus
953 @cindex starting up
954
955 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
956 Heathens} first.
957
958 @kindex M-x gnus
959 @findex gnus
960 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
961 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
962 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
963 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
964 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
965 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
966
967 @findex gnus-other-frame
968 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
969 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
970 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
971
972 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
973 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
974 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
975
976 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
977 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
978
979 @menu
980 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
981 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
982 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
983 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
984 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
985 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
986 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
987 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
988 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
989 @end menu
990
991
992 @node Finding the News
993 @section Finding the News
994 @cindex finding news
995
996 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
997 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
998 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
999 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1000 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1001 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1002 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1003 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1004
1005 @vindex gnus-select-method
1006 @c @head
1007 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1008 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1009 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1010 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1011 secondary or foreign groups.
1012
1013 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1014 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1015
1016 @lisp
1017 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1018 @end lisp
1019
1020 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1021
1022 @lisp
1023 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1024 @end lisp
1025
1026 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1027 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1028 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1029 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1030
1031 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1032 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1033 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1034 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1035 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1036 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1037 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1038 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1039 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1040
1041 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1042 @kindex B (Group)
1043 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1044 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1045 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1046 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1047 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1048 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1049
1050 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1051 @c @head
1052 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1053 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1054 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1055 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1056 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1057 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1058 groups are.
1059
1060 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1061 you would typically set this variable to
1062
1063 @lisp
1064 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1065 @end lisp
1066
1067
1068
1069 @node The Server is Down
1070 @section The Server is Down
1071 @cindex server errors
1072
1073 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1074 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1075 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1076
1077 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1078 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1079 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1080 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1081 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1082 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1083 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1084
1085 @findex gnus-no-server
1086 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1087 @c @head
1088 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1089 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1090 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1091 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1092 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1093 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1094 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1095
1096
1097 @node Slave Gnusae
1098 @section Slave Gnusae
1099 @cindex slave
1100
1101 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1102 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1103 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1104 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1105
1106 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1107 @file{.newsrc} file.
1108
1109 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1110 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1111 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1112 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1113 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1114 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1115 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1116
1117 @findex gnus-slave
1118 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1119 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1120 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1121 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1122 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1123 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1124 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1125 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1126
1127 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1128 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1129
1130 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1131 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1132 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1133 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1134 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1135
1136
1137
1138 @node New Groups
1139 @section New Groups
1140 @cindex new groups
1141 @cindex subscription
1142
1143 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1144 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1145 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1146 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1147 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1148 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1149 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1150 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1151 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1152
1153 @menu
1154 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1155 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1156 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1157 @end menu
1158
1159
1160 @node Checking New Groups
1161 @subsection Checking New Groups
1162
1163 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1164 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1165 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1166 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1167 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1168 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1169 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1170 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1171 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1172 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1173 command.
1174
1175 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1176 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1177 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1178 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1179 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1180 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1181 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1182 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1183 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1184 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1185 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1186
1187 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1188 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1189 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1190 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1191 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1192 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1193
1194
1195 @node Subscription Methods
1196 @subsection Subscription Methods
1197
1198 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1199 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1200 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1201
1202 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1203 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1204
1205 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1206
1207 @table @code
1208
1209 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1210 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1211 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1212 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1213 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1214 (with @kbd{u}).
1215
1216 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1217 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1218 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1219 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1220
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1223 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1227 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1228 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1229 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1230 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1231 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1232 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1233 up. Or something like that.
1234
1235 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1237 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1238 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1239 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1240
1241 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1242 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1243 Kill all new groups.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1247 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1248 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1249 topic parameter that looks like
1250
1251 @example
1252 "nnml"
1253 @end example
1254
1255 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1256 that topic.
1257
1258 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1259 top-level topic.
1260
1261 @end table
1262
1263 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1264 A closely related variable is
1265 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1266 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1267 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1268 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1269 hierarchy or not.
1270
1271 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1272 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1273 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1274 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1275
1276
1277 @node Filtering New Groups
1278 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1279
1280 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1281 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1282 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1283
1284 @example
1285 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1286 @end example
1287
1288 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1289 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1290 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1291 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1292 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1293 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1294 subscribing these groups.
1295 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1296 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1297
1298 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1299 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1300 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1320 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1321 variable to @code{nil}.
1322
1323 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1324 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1325 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1326 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1327 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1328 should be subscribed automatically.
1329
1330 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1331 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1332
1333
1334 @node Changing Servers
1335 @section Changing Servers
1336 @cindex changing servers
1337
1338 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1339 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1340 very flaky and you want to use another.
1341
1342 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1343 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1344
1345 @emph{Wrong!}
1346
1347 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1348 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1349 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1350 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1351 worthless.
1352
1353 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1354 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1355 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1356 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1357 Use with caution.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1360 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1361 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1362 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1363
1364 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1365 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1366 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1367 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1368 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1369 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1370 cache for all groups).
1371
1372
1373 @node Startup Files
1374 @section Startup Files
1375 @cindex startup files
1376 @cindex .newsrc
1377 @cindex .newsrc.el
1378 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1379
1380 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1381 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1382 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1383 read.
1384
1385 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1386 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1387 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1388 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1389 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1390 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1391 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1392
1393 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1394 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1395 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1396 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1397 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1398 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1399
1400 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1401 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1402 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1403 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1404 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1405 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1406 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1407 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1408 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1409 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1410 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1411 news reader.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1414 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1415 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1416 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1417 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1418 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1419 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1420 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1421 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1422 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1423 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1424 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1427 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1428 @vindex version-control
1429 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1430 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1431 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1432 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1433 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1434 @code{version-control} variable.
1435
1436 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1437 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1438 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1439 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1440 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1441 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1442 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1443 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1444 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1445 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1446
1447 @lisp
1448 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1449 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1450
1451 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1452 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1453 @end lisp
1454
1455 @vindex gnus-init-file
1456 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1457 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1458 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1459 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1460 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1461 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1462 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1463 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1464 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1465 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1466 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1467 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1468 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1469
1470
1471 @node Auto Save
1472 @section Auto Save
1473 @cindex dribble file
1474 @cindex auto-save
1475
1476 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1477 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1478 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1479 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1480 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1481 this file.
1482
1483 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1484 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1485 saved.
1486
1487 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1488 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1489 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1490
1491 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1492 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1493 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1494 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1495 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1496 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1497
1498 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1499 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1500 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1501
1502
1503 @node The Active File
1504 @section The Active File
1505 @cindex active file
1506 @cindex ignored groups
1507
1508 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1509 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1510 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1511
1512 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1513 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1514 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1515 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1516 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1517 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1518 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1519
1520 @c This variable is
1521 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1522 @c if you set it to anything else.
1523
1524 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1525 @c @head
1526 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1527 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1528 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1529
1530 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1531 you actually subscribe to.
1532
1533 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1534 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1535 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1536 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1537
1538 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1539 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1540 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1541 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1542 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1543 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1544
1545 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1546 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1547 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1548 variable.
1549
1550 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1551 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1552 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1553 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1554 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1555 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1556
1557 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1558 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1559
1560 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1561 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1562
1563 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1564 secondary select methods.
1565
1566
1567 @node Startup Variables
1568 @section Startup Variables
1569
1570 @table @code
1571
1572 @item gnus-load-hook
1573 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1574 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1575 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1576 times you start Gnus.
1577
1578 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1579 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1580 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1581
1582 @item gnus-startup-hook
1583 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1584 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1585
1586 @item gnus-started-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1588 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1589 successfully.
1590
1591 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1592 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1593 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1594 generating the group buffer.
1595
1596 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1597 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1598 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1599 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1600 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1601 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1602 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1603 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1604
1605 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1606 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1607 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1608 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1609 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1610 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1611
1612 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1613 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1614 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1615
1616 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1617 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1618 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1619 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1620 group operation some.
1621
1622 @end table
1623
1624
1625 @node Group Buffer
1626 @chapter Group Buffer
1627 @cindex group buffer
1628
1629 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1630 @c
1631 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1632 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1633 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1634 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1635 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1636 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1637 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1638 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1639 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1640 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1641 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1642 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1643 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1644 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1645 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1646 @c human rights at 9...
1647
1648
1649 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1650 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1651 long as Gnus is active.
1652
1653 @iftex
1654 @iflatex
1655 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1656 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1657 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1658 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1659 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1660 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1661 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1662 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1663 }
1664 @end iflatex
1665 @end iftex
1666
1667 @menu
1668 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1669 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1670 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1671 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1672 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1673 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1674 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1675 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1676 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1677 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1678 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1679 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1680 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1681 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1682 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1683 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1684 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1685 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1686 @end menu
1687
1688
1689 @node Group Buffer Format
1690 @section Group Buffer Format
1691
1692 @menu
1693 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1694 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1695 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1696 @end menu
1697
1698 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1699 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1700 available in Emacs.
1701
1702 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1703 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1704 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1705 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1706 Emacs version.
1707
1708 @node Group Line Specification
1709 @subsection Group Line Specification
1710 @cindex group buffer format
1711
1712 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1713 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1714
1715 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1716
1717 @example
1718 25: news.announce.newusers
1719 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1720 @end example
1721
1722 Quite simple, huh?
1723
1724 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1725 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1726 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1727 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1728
1729 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1730 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1731 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1732 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1733 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1734 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1735
1736 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1737
1738 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1739 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1740 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1741 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1742 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1743
1744 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1745 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1746 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1747
1748 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1749
1750 @table @samp
1751
1752 @item M
1753 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1754
1755 @item S
1756 Whether the group is subscribed.
1757
1758 @item L
1759 Level of subscribedness.
1760
1761 @item N
1762 Number of unread articles.
1763
1764 @item I
1765 Number of dormant articles.
1766
1767 @item T
1768 Number of ticked articles.
1769
1770 @item R
1771 Number of read articles.
1772
1773 @item U
1774 Number of unseen articles.
1775
1776 @item t
1777 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1778 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1779
1780 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1781 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1782 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1783 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1784 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1785 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1786 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1787
1788 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1789 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1790 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1791 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1792 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1793 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1794 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1795
1796 @item y
1797 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1798
1799 @item i
1800 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1801
1802 @item g
1803 Full group name.
1804
1805 @item G
1806 Group name.
1807
1808 @item C
1809 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1810 comment element in the group parameters.
1811
1812 @item D
1813 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1814 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1815 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1816 command.
1817
1818 @item o
1819 @samp{m} if moderated.
1820
1821 @item O
1822 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1823
1824 @item s
1825 Select method.
1826
1827 @item B
1828 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1829
1830 @item n
1831 Select from where.
1832
1833 @item z
1834 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1835 used.
1836
1837 @item P
1838 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1839
1840 @item c
1841 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1842 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1843 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1844 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1845 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1846
1847 @item m
1848 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1849 @cindex %
1850 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1851 the group lately.
1852
1853 @item p
1854 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1855
1856 @item d
1857 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1858 Timestamp}).
1859
1860 @item F
1861 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1862 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1863 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1864 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1865
1866 @item u
1867 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1868 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1869 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1870 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1871 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1872 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1873 specifier.
1874 @end table
1875
1876 @cindex *
1877 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1878 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1879 group, or a bogus native group.
1880
1881
1882 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1883 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1884 @cindex group mode line
1885
1886 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1887 The mode line can be changed by setting
1888 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1889 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1890
1891 @table @samp
1892 @item S
1893 The native news server.
1894 @item M
1895 The native select method.
1896 @end table
1897
1898
1899 @node Group Highlighting
1900 @subsection Group Highlighting
1901 @cindex highlighting
1902 @cindex group highlighting
1903
1904 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1905 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1906 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1907 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1908 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1909
1910 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1911 background is dark:
1912
1913 @lisp
1914 (cond (window-system
1915 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1916 (defface my-group-face-1
1917 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1918 (defface my-group-face-2
1919 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1920 "Second group face")
1921 (defface my-group-face-3
1922 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1923 (defface my-group-face-4
1924 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-5
1926 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1927
1928 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1929 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1930 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1931 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1932 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1933 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1934 @end lisp
1935
1936 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1937
1938 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1939 include:
1940
1941 @table @code
1942 @item group
1943 The group name.
1944 @item unread
1945 The number of unread articles in the group.
1946 @item method
1947 The select method.
1948 @item mailp
1949 Whether the group is a mail group.
1950 @item level
1951 The level of the group.
1952 @item score
1953 The score of the group.
1954 @item ticked
1955 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1956 @item total
1957 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1958 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1959 @item topic
1960 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1961 topic being inserted.
1962 @end table
1963
1964 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1965 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1966 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1967
1968 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1969 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1970 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1971 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1972
1973
1974 @node Group Maneuvering
1975 @section Group Maneuvering
1976 @cindex group movement
1977
1978 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1979 expected, hopefully.
1980
1981 @table @kbd
1982
1983 @item n
1984 @kindex n (Group)
1985 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1986 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1987 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1988
1989 @item p
1990 @itemx DEL
1991 @kindex DEL (Group)
1992 @kindex p (Group)
1993 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1994 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1995 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1996
1997 @item N
1998 @kindex N (Group)
1999 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2000 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2001
2002 @item P
2003 @kindex P (Group)
2004 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2005 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2006
2007 @item M-n
2008 @kindex M-n (Group)
2009 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2010 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2011 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2012
2013 @item M-p
2014 @kindex M-p (Group)
2015 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2016 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2017 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2018 @end table
2019
2020 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2021
2022 @table @kbd
2023
2024 @item j
2025 @kindex j (Group)
2026 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2027 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2028 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2029 like living groups.
2030
2031 @item ,
2032 @kindex , (Group)
2033 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2034 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2035 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2036
2037 @item .
2038 @kindex . (Group)
2039 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2040 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2041 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2042 @end table
2043
2044 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2045 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2046 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2047 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2048 is @code{t}.
2049
2050 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2051 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2052 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2053 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2054 @code{t}.
2055
2056 @node Selecting a Group
2057 @section Selecting a Group
2058 @cindex group selection
2059
2060 @table @kbd
2061
2062 @item SPACE
2063 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2064 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2065 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2066 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2067 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2068 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2069 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2070 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2071 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2072 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2073
2074 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2075 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2076 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2077
2078 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2079 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2080 ones.
2081
2082 @item RET
2083 @kindex RET (Group)
2084 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2085 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2086 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2087 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2088 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2089 entry.
2090
2091 @item M-RET
2092 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2093 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2094 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2095 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2096 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2097 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2098 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2099 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2100 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2101 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2102
2103 @item M-SPACE
2104 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2105 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2106 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2107 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2108 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2109
2110 @item C-M-RET
2111 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2112 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2113 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2114 doing any processing of its contents
2115 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2116 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2117 manner will have no permanent effects.
2118
2119 @end table
2120
2121 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2122 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2123 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2124 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2125 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2126 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2127 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2128 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2129 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2130 most recently will be fetched.
2131
2132 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2133 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2134 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2135 newsgroups.
2136
2137 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2138 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2139 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2140 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2141 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2142 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2143 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2144 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2145 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2146 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2147 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2148 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2149 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2150 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2151 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2152 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2153 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2154
2155 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2156 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2157 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2158 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2159 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2160 Which article this is controlled by the
2161 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2162 variable are:
2163
2164 @table @code
2165
2166 @item unread
2167 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2168
2169 @item first
2170 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2171
2172 @item unseen
2173 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2174
2175 @item unseen-or-unread
2176 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2177 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2178 unread article.
2179
2180 @item best
2181 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2182
2183 @end table
2184
2185 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2186 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2187
2188 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2189 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2190 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2191 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2192 selected.
2193
2194
2195 @node Subscription Commands
2196 @section Subscription Commands
2197 @cindex subscription
2198
2199 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2200 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2201 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2202 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2203 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2204
2205 @table @kbd
2206
2207 @item S t
2208 @itemx u
2209 @kindex S t (Group)
2210 @kindex u (Group)
2211 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2212 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2213 Toggle subscription to the current group
2214 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2215
2216 @item S s
2217 @itemx U
2218 @kindex S s (Group)
2219 @kindex U (Group)
2220 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2221 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2222 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2223 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2224
2225 @item S k
2226 @itemx C-k
2227 @kindex S k (Group)
2228 @kindex C-k (Group)
2229 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2230 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2231 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2232
2233 @item S y
2234 @itemx C-y
2235 @kindex S y (Group)
2236 @kindex C-y (Group)
2237 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2238 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2239
2240 @item C-x C-t
2241 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2242 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2243 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2244 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2245 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2246
2247 @item S w
2248 @itemx C-w
2249 @kindex S w (Group)
2250 @kindex C-w (Group)
2251 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2252 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2253
2254 @item S z
2255 @kindex S z (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2257 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2258
2259 @item S C-k
2260 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2261 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2262 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2263 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2264 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2265 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2266 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2267 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2268 @file{.newsrc} file.
2269
2270 @end table
2271
2272 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2273
2274
2275 @node Group Data
2276 @section Group Data
2277
2278 @table @kbd
2279
2280 @item c
2281 @kindex c (Group)
2282 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2283 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2284 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2285 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2286 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2287 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2288 the group buffer.
2289
2290 @item C
2291 @kindex C (Group)
2292 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2293 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2294 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2295
2296 @item M-c
2297 @kindex M-c (Group)
2298 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2299 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2300 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2301
2302 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2303 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2304 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2305 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2306 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2307 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2308 caution.
2309
2310 @end table
2311
2312
2313 @node Group Levels
2314 @section Group Levels
2315 @cindex group level
2316 @cindex level
2317
2318 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2319 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2320 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2321 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2322 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2323
2324 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2325
2326 @table @kbd
2327
2328 @item S l
2329 @kindex S l (Group)
2330 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2331 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2332 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2333 prompted for a level.
2334 @end table
2335
2336 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2337 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2338 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2339 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2340 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2341 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2342 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2343 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2344 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2345 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2346 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2347 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2348 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2349 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2350 reasons of efficiency.
2351
2352 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2353 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2354
2355 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2356 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2357 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2358 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2359 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2360 groups are hidden, in a way.
2361
2362 @cindex zombie groups
2363 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2364 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2365 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2366 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2367 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2368 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2369
2370 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2371 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2372 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2373 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2374 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2375 list of killed groups.)
2376
2377 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2378 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2379 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2380
2381 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2382 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2383 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2384 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2385 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2386 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2387 relevant valid ranges.
2388
2389 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2390 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2391 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2392 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2393 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2394 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2395 rest.
2396
2397 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2398 one with the best level.
2399
2400 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2401 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2402 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2403 by default.
2404 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2405 be called and the result will be used as value.
2406
2407
2408 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2409 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2410 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2411 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2412 listed.
2413
2414 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2415 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2416 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2417 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2418
2419 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2420 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2421 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2422 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2423 to 5. The default is 6.
2424
2425
2426 @node Group Score
2427 @section Group Score
2428 @cindex group score
2429 @cindex group rank
2430 @cindex rank
2431
2432 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2433 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2434 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2435 reason?
2436
2437 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2438 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2439 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2440 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2441 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2442 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2443 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2444 least significant part.))
2445
2446 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2447 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2448 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2449 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2450 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2451 action after each summary exit, you can add
2452 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2453 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2454 slow things down somewhat.
2455
2456
2457 @node Marking Groups
2458 @section Marking Groups
2459 @cindex marking groups
2460
2461 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2462 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2463 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2464 bidding on those groups.
2465
2466 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2467 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2468 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2469
2470 @table @kbd
2471
2472 @item #
2473 @kindex # (Group)
2474 @itemx M m
2475 @kindex M m (Group)
2476 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2477 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2478
2479 @item M-#
2480 @kindex M-# (Group)
2481 @itemx M u
2482 @kindex M u (Group)
2483 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2484 Remove the mark from the current group
2485 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2486
2487 @item M U
2488 @kindex M U (Group)
2489 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2490 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2491
2492 @item M w
2493 @kindex M w (Group)
2494 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2495 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2496
2497 @item M b
2498 @kindex M b (Group)
2499 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2500 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2501
2502 @item M r
2503 @kindex M r (Group)
2504 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2505 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2506 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2507 @end table
2508
2509 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2510
2511 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2512 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2513 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2514 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2515 the command to be executed.
2516
2517
2518 @node Foreign Groups
2519 @section Foreign Groups
2520 @cindex foreign groups
2521
2522 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2523 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2524 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2525 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2526 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2527 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2528 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2529 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2530
2531 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2532 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2533 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2534 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2535 consulted.
2536
2537 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2538 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2539 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2540
2541 @table @kbd
2542
2543 @item G m
2544 @kindex G m (Group)
2545 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2546 @cindex making groups
2547 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2548 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2549 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2550
2551 @item G M
2552 @kindex G M (Group)
2553 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2554 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2555 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2556
2557 @item G r
2558 @kindex G r (Group)
2559 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2560 @cindex renaming groups
2561 Rename the current group to something else
2562 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2563 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2564 on some back ends.
2565
2566 @item G c
2567 @kindex G c (Group)
2568 @cindex customizing
2569 @findex gnus-group-customize
2570 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2571
2572 @item G e
2573 @kindex G e (Group)
2574 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2575 @cindex renaming groups
2576 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2577 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2578
2579 @item G p
2580 @kindex G p (Group)
2581 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2582 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2583 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2584
2585 @item G E
2586 @kindex G E (Group)
2587 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2588 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2589 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2590
2591 @item G d
2592 @kindex G d (Group)
2593 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2594 @cindex nndir
2595 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2596 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2597
2598 @item G h
2599 @kindex G h (Group)
2600 @cindex help group
2601 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2602 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2603
2604 @item G D
2605 @kindex G D (Group)
2606 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2607 @cindex nneething
2608 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2609 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2610 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2611
2612 @item G f
2613 @kindex G f (Group)
2614 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2615 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2616 @cindex nndoc
2617 Make a group based on some file or other
2618 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2619 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2620 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2621 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2622 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2623 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2624 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2625 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2626 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2627
2628 @item G u
2629 @kindex G u (Group)
2630 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2631 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2632 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2633 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2634
2635 @item G w
2636 @kindex G w (Group)
2637 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2638 @cindex Google
2639 @cindex nnweb
2640 @cindex gmane
2641 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2642 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2643 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2644 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2645 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2646 @xref{Web Searches}.
2647
2648 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2649 to a particular group by using a match string like
2650 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2651
2652 @item G R
2653 @kindex G R (Group)
2654 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2655 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2656 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2657 @xref{RSS}.
2658
2659 @item G DEL
2660 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2661 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2662 This function will delete the current group
2663 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2664 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2665 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2666 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2667 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2668
2669 @item G V
2670 @kindex G V (Group)
2671 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2672 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2673 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2674
2675 @item G v
2676 @kindex G v (Group)
2677 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2678 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2679 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2680 @end table
2681
2682 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2683 methods.
2684
2685 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2686 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2687 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2688 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2689 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2690 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2691 newsgroups.
2692
2693
2694 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2695 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2696
2697 @table @code
2698 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2699 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2700 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2701 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2702 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2703 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2704 the article range.
2705
2706 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2707 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2708 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2709 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2710 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2711 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2712 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2713 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2714 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2715 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2716
2717 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2718 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2719 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2720 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2721 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2722
2723 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2724 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2725 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2726 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2730 Buttons}.
2731
2732 Here is an example:
2733 @lisp
2734 (require 'gnus-art)
2735 (add-to-list
2736 'gnus-button-alist
2737 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2738 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2739 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2740 @end lisp
2741
2742
2743 @node Group Parameters
2744 @section Group Parameters
2745 @cindex group parameters
2746
2747 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2748
2749 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2750 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2751 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2752 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2753 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2754 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2755 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2756
2757 Here's an example group parameter list:
2758
2759 @example
2760 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2761 (auto-expire . t))
2762 @end example
2763
2764 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2765 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2766 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2767 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2768
2769 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2770 is an alist of regexps and values.
2771
2772 The following group parameters can be used:
2773
2774 @table @code
2775 @item to-address
2776 @cindex to-address
2777 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2778
2779 @example
2780 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2781 @end example
2782
2783 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2784 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2785 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2786 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2787 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2788
2789 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2790 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2791 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2792 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2793 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2794 list address instead.
2795
2796 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2797
2798 @item to-list
2799 @cindex to-list
2800 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2801
2802 @example
2803 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2804 @end example
2805
2806 It is totally ignored
2807 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2808 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2809
2810 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2811 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2812 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2813 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2814 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2815
2816 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2817 @cindex mail list groups
2818 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2819 entering summary buffer.
2820
2821 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2822
2823 @anchor{subscribed}
2824 @item subscribed
2825 @cindex subscribed
2826 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2827 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2828 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2829 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2830 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2831 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2832 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2833 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2834
2835 @lisp
2836 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2837 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2838 @end lisp
2839
2840 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2841 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2842
2843 @item visible
2844 @cindex visible
2845 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2846 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2847 of whether it has any unread articles.
2848
2849 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2850 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2851
2852 @item broken-reply-to
2853 @cindex broken-reply-to
2854 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2855 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2856 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2857 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2858 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2859 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2860
2861 @item to-group
2862 @cindex to-group
2863 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2864 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2865
2866 @item newsgroup
2867 @cindex newsgroup
2868 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2869 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2870 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2871 news group.
2872
2873 @item gcc-self
2874 @cindex gcc-self
2875 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2876 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2877 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2878 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2879 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2880 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2881 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2882
2883 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2884 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2885 doesn't accept articles.
2886
2887 @item auto-expire
2888 @cindex auto-expire
2889 @cindex expiring mail
2890 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2891 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2892 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2893
2894 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2895
2896 @item total-expire
2897 @cindex total-expire
2898 @cindex expiring mail
2899 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2900 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2901 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2902 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2903 expiry.
2904
2905 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2906
2907 @item expiry-wait
2908 @cindex expiry-wait
2909 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2910 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2911 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2912 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2913 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2914 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2915 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2916
2917 @item expiry-target
2918 @cindex expiry-target
2919 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2920 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2921
2922 @item score-file
2923 @cindex score file group parameter
2924 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2925 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2926 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2927
2928 @item adapt-file
2929 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2930 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2931 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2932 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2933
2934 @item admin-address
2935 @cindex admin-address
2936 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2937 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2938 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2939 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2940
2941 @item display
2942 @cindex display
2943 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2944 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2945
2946 @table @code
2947 @item all
2948 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2949
2950 @item an integer
2951 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2952 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2953
2954 @item default
2955 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2956 ticked articles.
2957
2958 @item an array
2959 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2960
2961 Here are some examples:
2962
2963 @table @code
2964 @item [unread]
2965 Display only unread articles.
2966
2967 @item [not expire]
2968 Display everything except expirable articles.
2969
2970 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2971 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2972 responded to.
2973 @end table
2974
2975 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2976 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2977 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2978 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2979 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2980
2981 @end table
2982
2983 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2984 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2985 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2986
2987 @item comment
2988 @cindex comment
2989 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2990 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2991 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2992
2993 @item charset
2994 @cindex charset
2995 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2996 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2997 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2998
2999 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3000
3001 @item ignored-charsets
3002 @cindex ignored-charset
3003 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3004 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3005 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3006
3007 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3008
3009 @item posting-style
3010 @cindex posting-style
3011 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3012 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3013 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3014 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3015 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3016
3017 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3018 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3019 like this in the group parameters:
3020
3021 @example
3022 (posting-style
3023 (name "Funky Name")
3024 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3025 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3026 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3027 @end example
3028
3029 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3030 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3031 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3032 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3033 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3034 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3035 to.
3036
3037
3038 @item post-method
3039 @cindex post-method
3040 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3041 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3042
3043 @item mail-source
3044 @cindex mail-source
3045 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3046 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3047 mail source for this group.
3048
3049 @item banner
3050 @cindex banner
3051 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3052 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3053 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3054 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3055 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3056
3057 @item sieve
3058 @cindex sieve
3059 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3060 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3061 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3062 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3063
3064 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3065 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3066 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3067 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3068
3069 @example
3070 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3071 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3072 @}
3073 @end example
3074
3075 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3076 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3077 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3078 like the following is generated:
3079
3080 @example
3081 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3082 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3083 @}
3084 @end example
3085
3086 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3087 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3088
3089 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3090 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3091
3092 @item (agent parameters)
3093 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3094 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3095 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3096 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3097 minimize the configuration effort.
3098
3099 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3100 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3101 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3102 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3103 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3104 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3105 @code{eval}ed there.
3106
3107 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3108 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3109 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3110 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3111 form needs to be set to it.
3112
3113 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3114 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3115 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3116 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3117 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3118 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3119 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3120
3121 @lisp
3122 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3123 @end lisp
3124
3125 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3126 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3127 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3128
3129 @example
3130 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3131 @end example
3132
3133 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3134 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3135 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3136 into the group parameters for the group.
3137
3138 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3139 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3140 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3141 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3142 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3143
3144 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3145 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3146 following is added to a group parameter
3147
3148 @lisp
3149 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3150 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3151 @end lisp
3152
3153 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3154 expired.
3155
3156 @end table
3157
3158 @vindex gnus-parameters
3159 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3160 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3161 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3162 For example:
3163
3164 @lisp
3165 (setq gnus-parameters
3166 '(("mail\\..*"
3167 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3168 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3169 (gnus-summary-line-format
3170 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3171 (gcc-self . t)
3172 (display . all))
3173
3174 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3175 (to-group . "\\1"))
3176
3177 ("mail\\.me"
3178 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3179
3180 ("list\\..*"
3181 (total-expire . t)
3182 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3183 @end lisp
3184
3185 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3186 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3187 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3188 override the first.
3189
3190 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3191 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3192
3193 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3194 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3195 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3196 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3197 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3198 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3199 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3200 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3201 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3202 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3203 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3204 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3205
3206 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3207 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3208 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3209 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3210 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3211 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3212 weekly news RSS feed
3213 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3214 @xref{RSS}.
3215
3216 @lisp
3217 (setq
3218 gnus-parameters
3219 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3220 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3221 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3222 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3223 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3224 ("nnrss.*debian"
3225 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3226 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3227 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3228 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3229 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3230 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3231 @end lisp
3232
3233
3234 @node Listing Groups
3235 @section Listing Groups
3236 @cindex group listing
3237
3238 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3239
3240 @table @kbd
3241
3242 @item l
3243 @itemx A s
3244 @kindex A s (Group)
3245 @kindex l (Group)
3246 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3247 List all groups that have unread articles
3248 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3249 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3250 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3251 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3252 groups).
3253
3254 @item L
3255 @itemx A u
3256 @kindex A u (Group)
3257 @kindex L (Group)
3258 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3259 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3260 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3261 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3262 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3263 unsubscribed groups).
3264
3265 @item A l
3266 @kindex A l (Group)
3267 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3268 List all unread groups on a specific level
3269 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3270 with no unread articles.
3271
3272 @item A k
3273 @kindex A k (Group)
3274 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3275 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3276 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3277 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3278 from the server.
3279
3280 @item A z
3281 @kindex A z (Group)
3282 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3283 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3284
3285 @item A m
3286 @kindex A m (Group)
3287 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3288 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3289 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3290
3291 @item A M
3292 @kindex A M (Group)
3293 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3294 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3295
3296 @item A A
3297 @kindex A A (Group)
3298 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3299 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3300 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3301 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3302 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3303 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3304 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3305 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3306
3307 @item A a
3308 @kindex A a (Group)
3309 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3310 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3311 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3312
3313 @item A d
3314 @kindex A d (Group)
3315 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3316 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3317 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3318
3319 @item A c
3320 @kindex A c (Group)
3321 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3322 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3323
3324 @item A ?
3325 @kindex A ? (Group)
3326 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3327 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3328
3329 @item A !
3330 @kindex A ! (Group)
3331 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3332 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3333
3334 @item A /
3335 @kindex A / (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3337 Further limit groups within the current selection
3338 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3339 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3340 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3341 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3342 articles.
3343
3344 @item A f
3345 @kindex A f (Group)
3346 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3347 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3348
3349 @item A p
3350 @kindex A p (Group)
3351 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3352 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3353
3354 @end table
3355
3356 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3357 @cindex visible group parameter
3358 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3359 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3360 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3361 get the same effect.
3362
3363 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3364 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3365 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3366 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3367 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3368
3369
3370 @node Sorting Groups
3371 @section Sorting Groups
3372 @cindex sorting groups
3373
3374 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3375 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3376 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3377 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3378 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3379 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3380 include:
3381
3382 @table @code
3383
3384 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3385 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3386 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3387
3388 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3389 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3390 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3391
3392 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3393 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3394 Sort by group level.
3395
3396 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3397 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3398 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3399
3400 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3401 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3402 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3403 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3404
3405 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3406 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3407 Sort by number of unread articles.
3408
3409 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3410 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3411 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3412
3413 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3414 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3415 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3416
3417
3418 @end table
3419
3420 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3421 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3422 the last one.
3423
3424
3425 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3426 some sorting criteria:
3427
3428 @table @kbd
3429 @item G S a
3430 @kindex G S a (Group)
3431 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3432 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3433 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3434
3435 @item G S u
3436 @kindex G S u (Group)
3437 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3438 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3439 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3440
3441 @item G S l
3442 @kindex G S l (Group)
3443 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3444 Sort the group buffer by group level
3445 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3446
3447 @item G S v
3448 @kindex G S v (Group)
3449 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3450 Sort the group buffer by group score
3451 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3452
3453 @item G S r
3454 @kindex G S r (Group)
3455 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3456 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3457 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3458
3459 @item G S m
3460 @kindex G S m (Group)
3461 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3462 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3463 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3464
3465 @item G S n
3466 @kindex G S n (Group)
3467 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3468 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3469 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3470
3471 @end table
3472
3473 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3474 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3475
3476 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3477 commands will sort in reverse order.
3478
3479 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3480
3481 @table @kbd
3482 @item G P a
3483 @kindex G P a (Group)
3484 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3485 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3486 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3487
3488 @item G P u
3489 @kindex G P u (Group)
3490 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3491 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3492 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3493
3494 @item G P l
3495 @kindex G P l (Group)
3496 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3497 Sort the groups by group level
3498 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3499
3500 @item G P v
3501 @kindex G P v (Group)
3502 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3503 Sort the groups by group score
3504 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3505
3506 @item G P r
3507 @kindex G P r (Group)
3508 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3509 Sort the groups by group rank
3510 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3511
3512 @item G P m
3513 @kindex G P m (Group)
3514 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3515 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3516 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3517
3518 @item G P n
3519 @kindex G P n (Group)
3520 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3521 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3522 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3523
3524 @item G P s
3525 @kindex G P s (Group)
3526 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3527 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3528
3529 @end table
3530
3531 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3532 move groups around.
3533
3534
3535 @node Group Maintenance
3536 @section Group Maintenance
3537 @cindex bogus groups
3538
3539 @table @kbd
3540 @item b
3541 @kindex b (Group)
3542 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3543 Find bogus groups and delete them
3544 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3545
3546 @item F
3547 @kindex F (Group)
3548 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3549 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3550 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3551 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3552 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3553 zombies.
3554
3555 @item C-c C-x
3556 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3557 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3558 @cindex expiring mail
3559 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3560 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3561 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3562 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3563
3564 @item C-c C-M-x
3565 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3566 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3567 @cindex expiring mail
3568 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3569 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3570
3571 @end table
3572
3573
3574 @node Browse Foreign Server
3575 @section Browse Foreign Server
3576 @cindex foreign servers
3577 @cindex browsing servers
3578
3579 @table @kbd
3580 @item B
3581 @kindex B (Group)
3582 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3583 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3584 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3585 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3586 @end table
3587
3588 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3589 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3590 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3591 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3592
3593 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3594
3595 @table @kbd
3596 @item n
3597 @kindex n (Browse)
3598 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3599 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3600
3601 @item p
3602 @kindex p (Browse)
3603 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3604 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3605
3606 @item SPACE
3607 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3608 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3609 Enter the current group and display the first article
3610 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3611
3612 @item RET
3613 @kindex RET (Browse)
3614 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3615 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3616
3617 @item u
3618 @kindex u (Browse)
3619 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3620 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3621 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3622 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3623 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3624 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3625 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3626
3627 @item l
3628 @itemx q
3629 @kindex q (Browse)
3630 @kindex l (Browse)
3631 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3632 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3633
3634 @item d
3635 @kindex d (Browse)
3636 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3637 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3638
3639 @item ?
3640 @kindex ? (Browse)
3641 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3642 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3643 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3644 @end table
3645
3646
3647 @node Exiting Gnus
3648 @section Exiting Gnus
3649 @cindex exiting Gnus
3650
3651 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3652
3653 @table @kbd
3654 @item z
3655 @kindex z (Group)
3656 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3657 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3658 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3659 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3660
3661 @item q
3662 @kindex q (Group)
3663 @findex gnus-group-exit
3664 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3665 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3666
3667 @item Q
3668 @kindex Q (Group)
3669 @findex gnus-group-quit
3670 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3671 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3672 @end table
3673
3674 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3675 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3676 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3677 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3678 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3679 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3680 exiting Gnus.
3681
3682 Note:
3683
3684 @quotation
3685 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3686 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3687 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3688 plastic chair.
3689 @end quotation
3690
3691
3692 @node Group Topics
3693 @section Group Topics
3694 @cindex topics
3695
3696 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3697 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3698 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3699 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3700 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3701 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3702
3703 @iftex
3704 @iflatex
3705 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3706 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3707 }
3708 @end iflatex
3709 @end iftex
3710
3711 Here's an example:
3712
3713 @example
3714 Gnus
3715 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3716 3: comp.emacs
3717 2: alt.religion.emacs
3718 Naughty Emacs
3719 452: alt.sex.emacs
3720 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3721 Misc
3722 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3723 13: comp.sources.unix
3724 @end example
3725
3726 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3727 @kindex t (Group)
3728 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3729 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3730 is a toggling command.)
3731
3732 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3733 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3734 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3735 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3736 Hot and bothered?
3737
3738 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3739 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3740 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3741
3742 @lisp
3743 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3744 @end lisp
3745
3746 @menu
3747 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3748 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3749 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3750 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3751 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3752 @end menu
3753
3754
3755 @node Topic Commands
3756 @subsection Topic Commands
3757 @cindex topic commands
3758
3759 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3760 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3761 definitions slightly.
3762
3763 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3764 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3765 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3766 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3767 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3768 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3769
3770 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3771 the way you like.
3772
3773 @table @kbd
3774
3775 @item T n
3776 @kindex T n (Topic)
3777 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3778 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3779 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3780
3781 @item T TAB
3782 @itemx TAB
3783 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3784 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3785 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3786 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3787 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3788 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3789
3790 @item M-TAB
3791 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3792 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3793 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3794 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3795
3796 @end table
3797
3798 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3799 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3800 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3801 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3802
3803 @table @kbd
3804
3805 @item C-k
3806 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3807 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3808 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3809 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3810
3811 @item C-y
3812 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3813 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3814 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3815 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3816 before all groups.
3817
3818 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3819 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3820 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3821 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3822 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3823
3824 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3825 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3826
3827 @end table
3828
3829 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3830 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3831 key.
3832
3833 @table @kbd
3834
3835 @item RET
3836 @kindex RET (Topic)
3837 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3838 @itemx SPACE
3839 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3840 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3841 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3842 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3843 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3844 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3845
3846 @end table
3847
3848 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3849
3850 @table @kbd
3851
3852 @item T m
3853 @kindex T m (Topic)
3854 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3855 Move the current group to some other topic
3856 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3857 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3858
3859 @item T j
3860 @kindex T j (Topic)
3861 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3862 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3863
3864 @item T c
3865 @kindex T c (Topic)
3866 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3867 Copy the current group to some other topic
3868 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3869 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3870
3871 @item T h
3872 @kindex T h (Topic)
3873 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3874 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3875 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3876
3877 @item T s
3878 @kindex T s (Topic)
3879 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3880 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3881 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3882
3883 @item T D
3884 @kindex T D (Topic)
3885 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3886 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3887 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3888 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3889 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3890 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3891 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3892 topic.
3893
3894 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3895 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3896
3897 @item T M
3898 @kindex T M (Topic)
3899 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3900 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3901 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3902
3903 @item T C
3904 @kindex T C (Topic)
3905 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3906 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3907 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3908
3909 @item T H
3910 @kindex T H (Topic)
3911 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3912 Toggle hiding empty topics
3913 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3914
3915 @item T #
3916 @kindex T # (Topic)
3917 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3918 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3919 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3920 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3921
3922 @item T M-#
3923 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3924 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3925 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3926 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3927 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3928
3929 @item C-c C-x
3930 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3931 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3932 @cindex expiring mail
3933 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3934 expiry process (if any)
3935 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3936
3937 @item T r
3938 @kindex T r (Topic)
3939 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3940 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3941
3942 @item T DEL
3943 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3944 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3945 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3946
3947 @item A T
3948 @kindex A T (Topic)
3949 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3950 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3951 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3952
3953 @item T M-n
3954 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3955 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3956 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3957
3958 @item T M-p
3959 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3960 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3961 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3962
3963 @item G p
3964 @kindex G p (Topic)
3965 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3966 @cindex group parameters
3967 @cindex topic parameters
3968 @cindex parameters
3969 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3970 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3971
3972 @end table
3973
3974
3975 @node Topic Variables
3976 @subsection Topic Variables
3977 @cindex topic variables
3978
3979 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3980 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3981
3982 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3983 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3984 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3985 Valid elements are:
3986
3987 @table @samp
3988 @item i
3989 Indentation.
3990 @item n
3991 Topic name.
3992 @item v
3993 Visibility.
3994 @item l
3995 Level.
3996 @item g
3997 Number of groups in the topic.
3998 @item a
3999 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4000 @item A
4001 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4002 @end table
4003
4004 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4005 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4006 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4007 The default is 2.
4008
4009 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4010 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4011
4012 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4013 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4014 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4015
4016
4017 @node Topic Sorting
4018 @subsection Topic Sorting
4019 @cindex topic sorting
4020
4021 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4022 commands:
4023
4024
4025 @table @kbd
4026 @item T S a
4027 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4028 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4029 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4030 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4031
4032 @item T S u
4033 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4034 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4035 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4036 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4037
4038 @item T S l
4039 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4040 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4041 Sort the current topic by group level
4042 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4043
4044 @item T S v
4045 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4046 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4047 Sort the current topic by group score
4048 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4049
4050 @item T S r
4051 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4052 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4053 Sort the current topic by group rank
4054 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4055
4056 @item T S m
4057 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4058 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4059 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4060 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4061
4062 @item T S e
4063 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4064 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4065 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4066 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4067
4068 @item T S s
4069 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4070 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4071 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4072 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4073 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4074
4075 @end table
4076
4077 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4078 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4079 sorting.
4080
4081
4082 @node Topic Topology
4083 @subsection Topic Topology
4084 @cindex topic topology
4085 @cindex topology
4086
4087 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4088
4089 @example
4090 @group
4091 Gnus
4092 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4093 3: comp.emacs
4094 2: alt.religion.emacs
4095 Naughty Emacs
4096 452: alt.sex.emacs
4097 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4098 Misc
4099 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4100 13: comp.sources.unix
4101 @end group
4102 @end example
4103
4104 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4105 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4106 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4107 follows:
4108
4109 @lisp
4110 (("Gnus" visible)
4111 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4112 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4113 (("Misc" visible)))
4114 @end lisp
4115
4116 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4117 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4118 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4119 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4120 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4121 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4122
4123 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4124 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4125 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4126
4127
4128 @node Topic Parameters
4129 @subsection Topic Parameters
4130 @cindex topic parameters
4131
4132 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4133 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4134 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4135 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4136 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4137
4138 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4139 parameters:
4140
4141 @table @code
4142 @item subscribe
4143 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4144 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4145 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4146 topic.
4147
4148 @item subscribe-level
4149 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4150 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4151 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4152
4153 @end table
4154
4155 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4156 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4157 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4158 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4159
4160 @example
4161 @group
4162 Gnus
4163 Emacs
4164 3: comp.emacs
4165 2: alt.religion.emacs
4166 452: alt.sex.emacs
4167 Relief
4168 452: alt.sex.emacs
4169 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4170 Misc
4171 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4172 13: comp.sources.unix
4173 452: alt.sex.emacs
4174 @end group
4175 @end example
4176
4177 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4178 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4179 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4180 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4181 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4182 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4183
4184 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4185 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4186 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4187 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4188 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4189
4190 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4191 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4192 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4193 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4194 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4195 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4196 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4197 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4198
4199
4200 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4201 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4202 @cindex non-ascii group names
4203
4204 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4205 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4206 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4207 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4208 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4209 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4210 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4211 back end.
4212
4213 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4214 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4215 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4216 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4217 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4218 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4219 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4220 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4221
4222 @table @code
4223 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4224 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4225 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4226 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4227 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4228
4229 @lisp
4230 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4231 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4232 @end lisp
4233
4234 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4235 ones specified for the same groups with the
4236 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4237
4238 A select method can be very long, like:
4239
4240 @lisp
4241 (nntp "gmane"
4242 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4243 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4244 (nntp-open-connection-function
4245 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4246 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4247 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4248 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4249 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4250 @end lisp
4251
4252 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4253 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4254 the server name.
4255
4256 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4257 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4258 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4259 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4260 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4261 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4262
4263 @lisp
4264 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4265 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4266 (".*" . utf-8)))
4267 @end lisp
4268
4269 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4270 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4271 @end table
4272
4273 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4274 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4275 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4276 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4277 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4278 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4279
4280 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4281 names:
4282
4283 @table @code
4284 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4285 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4286 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4287 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4288 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4289 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4290
4291 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4292 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4293 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4294 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4295 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4296
4297 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4298 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4299 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4300 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4301 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4302 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4303
4304 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4305 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4306 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4307 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4308
4309 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4310 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4311 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4312 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4313
4314 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4315 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4316 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4317 typical case where you have to customize
4318 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4319 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4320 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4321 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4322 @end table
4323
4324 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4325 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4326 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4327 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4328
4329
4330 @node Misc Group Stuff
4331 @section Misc Group Stuff
4332
4333 @menu
4334 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4335 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4336 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4337 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4338 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4339 @end menu
4340
4341 @table @kbd
4342
4343 @item v
4344 @kindex v (Group)
4345 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4346 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4347 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4348
4349 @lisp
4350 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4351 (lambda ()
4352 (interactive)
4353 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4354 @end lisp
4355
4356 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4357 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4358
4359 @item ^
4360 @kindex ^ (Group)
4361 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4362 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4363 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4364
4365 @item a
4366 @kindex a (Group)
4367 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4368 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4369 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4370 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4371 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4372 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4373 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4374
4375 @item m
4376 @kindex m (Group)
4377 @findex gnus-group-mail
4378 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4379 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4380 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4381 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4382
4383 @item i
4384 @kindex i (Group)
4385 @findex gnus-group-news
4386 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4387 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4388 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4389
4390 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4391 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4392 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4393 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4394 for this to work though.
4395
4396 @item G z
4397 @kindex G z (Group)
4398 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4399
4400 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4401 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4402 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4403 count.
4404
4405 @end table
4406
4407 Variables for the group buffer:
4408
4409 @table @code
4410
4411 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4412 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4413 is called after the group buffer has been
4414 created.
4415
4416 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4417 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4418 is called after the group buffer is
4419 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4420 unnatural way.
4421
4422 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4423 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4424 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4425 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4426
4427 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4428 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4429 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4430 whether they are empty or not.
4431
4432 @end table
4433
4434 @node Scanning New Messages
4435 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4436 @cindex new messages
4437 @cindex scanning new news
4438
4439 @table @kbd
4440
4441 @item g
4442 @kindex g (Group)
4443 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4444 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4445 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4446 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4447 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4448 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4449 back end(s).
4450
4451 @item M-g
4452 @kindex M-g (Group)
4453 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4454 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4455 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4456 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4457 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4458 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4459 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4460
4461 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4462 @cindex activating groups
4463 @item C-c M-g
4464 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4465 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4466
4467 @item R
4468 @kindex R (Group)
4469 @cindex restarting
4470 @findex gnus-group-restart
4471 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4472 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4473 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4474
4475 @end table
4476
4477 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4478 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4479
4480 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4481 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4482 news.
4483
4484
4485 @node Group Information
4486 @subsection Group Information
4487 @cindex group information
4488 @cindex information on groups
4489
4490 @table @kbd
4491
4492
4493 @item H d
4494 @itemx C-c C-d
4495 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4496 @kindex H d (Group)
4497 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4498 @cindex describing groups
4499 @cindex group description
4500 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4501 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4502 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4503
4504 @item M-d
4505 @kindex M-d (Group)
4506 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4507 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4508 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4509
4510 @item H v
4511 @itemx V
4512 @kindex V (Group)
4513 @kindex H v (Group)
4514 @cindex version
4515 @findex gnus-version
4516 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4517
4518 @item ?
4519 @kindex ? (Group)
4520 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4521 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4522
4523 @item C-c C-i
4524 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4525 @cindex info
4526 @cindex manual
4527 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4528 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4529 @end table
4530
4531
4532 @node Group Timestamp
4533 @subsection Group Timestamp
4534 @cindex timestamps
4535 @cindex group timestamps
4536
4537 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4538 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4539 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4540
4541 @lisp
4542 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4543 @end lisp
4544
4545 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4546
4547 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4548 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4549
4550 @lisp
4551 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4552 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4553 @end lisp
4554
4555 This will result in lines looking like:
4556
4557 @example
4558 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4559 0: custom 19961002T012713
4560 @end example
4561
4562 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4563 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4564 something like:
4565
4566 @lisp
4567 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4568 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4569 @end lisp
4570
4571 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4572 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4573 trick:
4574
4575 @lisp
4576 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4577 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4578 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4579 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4580 (if time
4581 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4582 "")))
4583 @end lisp
4584
4585 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4586 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4587 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4588 either.
4589
4590
4591 @node File Commands
4592 @subsection File Commands
4593 @cindex file commands
4594
4595 @table @kbd
4596
4597 @item r
4598 @kindex r (Group)
4599 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4600 @vindex gnus-init-file
4601 @cindex reading init file
4602 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4603 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4604
4605 @item s
4606 @kindex s (Group)
4607 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4608 @cindex saving .newsrc
4609 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4610 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4611 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4612
4613 @c @item Z
4614 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4615 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4616 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4617
4618 @end table
4619
4620
4621 @node Sieve Commands
4622 @subsection Sieve Commands
4623 @cindex group sieve commands
4624
4625 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4626 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4627 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4628 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4629 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4630
4631 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4632 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4633 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4634 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4635 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4636 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4637 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4638 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4639 regenerate the Sieve script.
4640
4641 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4642 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4643 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4644 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4645 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4646 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4647 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4648 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4649 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4650 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4651
4652 @example
4653 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4654 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4655 stop;
4656 @}
4657 @end example
4658
4659 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4660
4661 @table @kbd
4662
4663 @item D g
4664 @kindex D g (Group)
4665 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4666 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4667 @cindex generating sieve script
4668 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4669 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4670
4671 @item D u
4672 @kindex D u (Group)
4673 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4674 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4675 @cindex updating sieve script
4676 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4677 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4678 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4679
4680 @end table
4681
4682
4683 @node Summary Buffer
4684 @chapter Summary Buffer
4685 @cindex summary buffer
4686
4687 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4688 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4689
4690 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4691 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4692
4693 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4694
4695 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4696 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4697 available in Emacs.
4698
4699 @kindex v (Summary)
4700 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4701 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4702 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4703 @lisp
4704 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4705 @end lisp
4706
4707 @menu
4708 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4709 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4710 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4711 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4712 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4713 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4714 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4715 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4716 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4717 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4718 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4719 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4720 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4721 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4722 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4723 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4724 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4725 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4726 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4727 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4728 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4729 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4730 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4731 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4732 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4733 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4734 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4735 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4736 or reselecting the current group.
4737 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4738 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4739 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4740 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4741 @end menu
4742
4743
4744 @node Summary Buffer Format
4745 @section Summary Buffer Format
4746 @cindex summary buffer format
4747
4748 @iftex
4749 @iflatex
4750 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4751 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4752 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4753 }
4754 @end iflatex
4755 @end iftex
4756
4757 @menu
4758 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4759 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4760 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4761 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4762 @end menu
4763
4764 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4765 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4766 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4767 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4768 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4769 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4770 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4771 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4772 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4773 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4774 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4775
4776 @lisp
4777 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4778 'mail-extract-address-components)
4779 @end lisp
4780
4781 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4782 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4783 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4784 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4785
4786
4787 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4788 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4789
4790 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4791 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4792 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4793 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4794 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4795
4796 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4797 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4798 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4799 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4800 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4801 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4802
4803 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4804
4805 The following format specification characters and extended format
4806 specification(s) are understood:
4807
4808 @table @samp
4809 @item N
4810 Article number.
4811 @item S
4812 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4813 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4814 @item s
4815 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4816 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4817 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4818 @item F
4819 Full @code{From} header.
4820 @item n
4821 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4822 @item f
4823 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4824 From Newsgroups}).
4825 @item a
4826 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4827 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4828 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4829 may be more thorough.
4830 @item A
4831 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4832 the @code{a} spec.
4833 @item L
4834 Number of lines in the article.
4835 @item c
4836 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4837 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4838 @item k
4839 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4840 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4841 @item I
4842 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4843 @item B
4844 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4845 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4846
4847 @example
4848 >
4849 +->
4850 | +->
4851 | | \->
4852 | | \->
4853 | \->
4854 +->
4855 \->
4856 @end example
4857
4858 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4859 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4860 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4861 line-drawing glyphs.
4862 @table @code
4863 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4864 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4865 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4866 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4867
4868 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4869 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4870 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4871 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4872
4873 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4874 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4875 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4876 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4877
4878 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4879 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4880 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4881
4882 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4883 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4884 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4885
4886 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4887 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4888 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4889
4890 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4891 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4892 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4893
4894 @end table
4895
4896 @item T
4897 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4898 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4899 @item [
4900 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4901 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4902 @item ]
4903 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4904 for adopted articles.
4905 @item >
4906 One space for each thread level.
4907 @item <
4908 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4909 @item U
4910 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4911
4912 @item R
4913 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4914 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4915 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4916
4917 @item i
4918 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4919 @item z
4920 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4921 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4922 default level. If the difference between
4923 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4924 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4925 @item V
4926 Total thread score.
4927 @item x
4928 @code{Xref}.
4929 @item D
4930 @code{Date}.
4931 @item d
4932 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4933 @item o
4934 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4935 @item M
4936 @code{Message-ID}.
4937 @item r
4938 @code{References}.
4939 @item t
4940 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4941 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4942 @item e
4943 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4944 article has any children.
4945 @item P
4946 The line number.
4947 @item O
4948 Download mark.
4949 @item *
4950 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4951 @item &user-date;
4952 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4953 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4954 @item u
4955 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4956 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4957 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4958 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4959 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4960 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4961 @end table
4962
4963 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4964 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4965 There can only be one such area.
4966
4967 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4968 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4969 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4970 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4971 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4972 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4973
4974 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4975 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4976
4977 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4978
4979
4980 @node To From Newsgroups
4981 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4982 @cindex To
4983 @cindex Newsgroups
4984
4985 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4986 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4987 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4988 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4989 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4990
4991 @enumerate
4992 @item
4993 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4994 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4995 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4996 instance:
4997
4998 @lisp
4999 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5000 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5001 @end lisp
5002
5003 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5004 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5005
5006 @item
5007 @findex gnus-extra-header
5008 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5009 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5010 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5011
5012 @example
5013 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5014 @end example
5015
5016 @item
5017 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5018 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5019 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5020 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5021 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5022 headers are used instead.
5023
5024 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5025 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5026 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5027 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5028 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5029 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5030
5031 @end enumerate
5032
5033 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5034 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5035 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5036 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5037 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5038 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5039 regeneration.
5040
5041 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5042 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5043 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5044 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5045
5046 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5047 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5048
5049 @lisp
5050 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5051 '(To Newsgroups))
5052 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5053 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5054 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5055 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5056 "Your Name Here")
5057 @end lisp
5058
5059 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5060 to fit your needs.)
5061
5062 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5063 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5064 support:
5065
5066 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5067 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5068 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5069
5070 @example
5071 Newsgroups:full
5072 @end example
5073
5074 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5075 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5076
5077
5078 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5079 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5080
5081 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5082 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5083 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5084 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5085
5086 Here are the elements you can play with:
5087
5088 @table @samp
5089 @item G
5090 Group name.
5091 @item p
5092 Unprefixed group name.
5093 @item A
5094 Current article number.
5095 @item z
5096 Current article score.
5097 @item V
5098 Gnus version.
5099 @item U
5100 Number of unread articles in this group.
5101 @item e
5102 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5103 summary buffer.
5104 @item Z
5105 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5106 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5107 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5108 and no unselected ones.
5109 @item g
5110 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5111 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5112 @item S
5113 Subject of the current article.
5114 @item u
5115 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5116 @item s
5117 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5118 @item d
5119 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5120 @item t
5121 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5122 @item r
5123 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5124 @item E
5125 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5126 @end table
5127
5128
5129 @node Summary Highlighting
5130 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5131
5132 @table @code
5133
5134 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5135 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5136 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5137 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5138 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5139
5140 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5141 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5142 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5143 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5144
5145 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5146 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5147 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5148 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5149
5150 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5151 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5152 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5153 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5154 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5155 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5156 to something like
5157 @lisp
5158 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5159 ((> score default) . bold))
5160 @end lisp
5161 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5162 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5163 @end table
5164
5165
5166 @node Summary Maneuvering
5167 @section Summary Maneuvering
5168 @cindex summary movement
5169
5170 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5171 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5172
5173 None of these commands select articles.
5174
5175 @table @kbd
5176 @item G M-n
5177 @itemx M-n
5178 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5179 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5180 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5181 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5182 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5183
5184 @item G M-p
5185 @itemx M-p
5186 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5187 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5188 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5189 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5190 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5191
5192 @item G g
5193 @kindex G g (Summary)
5194 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5195 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5196 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5197 @end table
5198
5199 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5200 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5201 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5202 to the group buffer.
5203
5204 Variables related to summary movement:
5205
5206 @table @code
5207
5208 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5209 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5210 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5211 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5212 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5213 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5214 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5215 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5216 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5217 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5218 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5219 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5220 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5221 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5222
5223 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5224 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5225 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5226 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5227 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5228 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5229 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5230
5231 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5232
5233 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5234 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5235 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5236 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5237 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5238
5239 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5240 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5241 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5242 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5243 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5244 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5245 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5246 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5247 threads.
5248
5249 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5250 the given number of lines from the top.
5251
5252 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5253 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5254 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5255 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5256
5257 @end table
5258
5259
5260 @node Choosing Articles
5261 @section Choosing Articles
5262 @cindex selecting articles
5263
5264 @menu
5265 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5266 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5267 @end menu
5268
5269
5270 @node Choosing Commands
5271 @subsection Choosing Commands
5272
5273 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5274 and they all select and display an article.
5275
5276 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5277 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5278
5279 @table @kbd
5280 @item SPACE
5281 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5282 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5283 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5284 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5285
5286 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5287 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5288 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5289
5290 @item G n
5291 @itemx n
5292 @kindex n (Summary)
5293 @kindex G n (Summary)
5294 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5295 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5296 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5297
5298 @item G p
5299 @itemx p
5300 @kindex p (Summary)
5301 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5302 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5303 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5304
5305 @item G N
5306 @itemx N
5307 @kindex N (Summary)
5308 @kindex G N (Summary)
5309 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5310 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5311
5312 @item G P
5313 @itemx P
5314 @kindex P (Summary)
5315 @kindex G P (Summary)
5316 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5317 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5318
5319 @item G C-n
5320 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5321 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5322 Go to the next article with the same subject
5323 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5324
5325 @item G C-p
5326 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5327 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5328 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5329 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5330
5331 @item G f
5332 @itemx .
5333 @kindex G f (Summary)
5334 @kindex . (Summary)
5335 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5336 Go to the first unread article
5337 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5338
5339 @item G b
5340 @itemx ,
5341 @kindex G b (Summary)
5342 @kindex , (Summary)
5343 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5344 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5345 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5346 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5347
5348 @item G l
5349 @itemx l
5350 @kindex l (Summary)
5351 @kindex G l (Summary)
5352 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5353 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5354
5355 @item G o
5356 @kindex G o (Summary)
5357 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5358 @cindex history
5359 @cindex article history
5360 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5361 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5362 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5363 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5364 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5365 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5366
5367 @item G j
5368 @itemx j
5369 @kindex j (Summary)
5370 @kindex G j (Summary)
5371 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5372 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5373 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5374
5375 @end table
5376
5377
5378 @node Choosing Variables
5379 @subsection Choosing Variables
5380
5381 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5382
5383 @table @code
5384 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5385 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5386 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5387 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5388 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5389 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5390
5391 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5392 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5393 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5394 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5395 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5396 hook will do so.
5397
5398 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5399 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5400 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5401 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5402 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5403 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5404 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5405 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5406 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5407 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5408 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5409 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5410 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5411 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5412
5413 @end table
5414
5415
5416 @node Paging the Article
5417 @section Scrolling the Article
5418 @cindex article scrolling
5419
5420 @table @kbd
5421
5422 @item SPACE
5423 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5424 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5425 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5426 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5427 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5428
5429 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5430 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5431 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5432 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5433 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5434 what is considered uninteresting with
5435 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5436 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5437
5438 @item DEL
5439 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5440 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5441 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5442
5443 @item RET
5444 @kindex RET (Summary)
5445 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5446 Scroll the current article one line forward
5447 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5448
5449 @item M-RET
5450 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5451 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5452 Scroll the current article one line backward
5453 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5454
5455 @item A g
5456 @itemx g
5457 @kindex A g (Summary)
5458 @kindex g (Summary)
5459 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5460 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5461 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5462 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5463 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5464 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5465 treatment functions.
5466
5467 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5468 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5469 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5470 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5471
5472 @lisp
5473 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5474 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5475 (2 . big5)))
5476 @end lisp
5477
5478 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5479
5480 @item A <
5481 @itemx <
5482 @kindex < (Summary)
5483 @kindex A < (Summary)
5484 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5485 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5486 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5487
5488 @item A >
5489 @itemx >
5490 @kindex > (Summary)
5491 @kindex A > (Summary)
5492 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5493 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5494
5495 @item A s
5496 @itemx s
5497 @kindex A s (Summary)
5498 @kindex s (Summary)
5499 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5500 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5501 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5502
5503 @item h
5504 @kindex h (Summary)
5505 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5506 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5507
5508 @end table
5509
5510
5511 @node Reply Followup and Post
5512 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5513
5514 @menu
5515 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5516 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5517 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5518 * Canceling and Superseding::
5519 @end menu
5520
5521
5522 @node Summary Mail Commands
5523 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5524 @cindex mail
5525 @cindex composing mail
5526
5527 Commands for composing a mail message:
5528
5529 @table @kbd
5530
5531 @item S r
5532 @itemx r
5533 @kindex S r (Summary)
5534 @kindex r (Summary)
5535 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5536 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5537 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5538 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5539 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5540
5541 @item S R
5542 @itemx R
5543 @kindex R (Summary)
5544 @kindex S R (Summary)
5545 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5546 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5547 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5548 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5549 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5550
5551 @item S w
5552 @kindex S w (Summary)
5553 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5554 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5555 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5556 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5557 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5558 present, that's used instead.
5559
5560 @item S W
5561 @kindex S W (Summary)
5562 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5563 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5564 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5565 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5566 first article to determine the recipients.
5567
5568 @item S L
5569 @kindex S L (Summary)
5570 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5571 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5572 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5573 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5574
5575 @item S v
5576 @kindex S v (Summary)
5577 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5578 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5579 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5580 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5581 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5582 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5583
5584 @item S V
5585 @kindex S V (Summary)
5586 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5587 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5588 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5589 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5590
5591 @item S B r
5592 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5593 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5594 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5595 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5596 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5597 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5598 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5599 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5600
5601 @item S B R
5602 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5603 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5604 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5605 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5606 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5607
5608 @item S o m
5609 @itemx C-c C-f
5610 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5611 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5612 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5613 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5614 Forward the current article to some other person
5615 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5616 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5617 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5618 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5619 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5620 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5621 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5622 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5623 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5624 section.
5625
5626 @item S m
5627 @itemx m
5628 @kindex m (Summary)
5629 @kindex S m (Summary)
5630 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5631 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5632 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5633 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5634 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5635
5636 @item S i
5637 @kindex S i (Summary)
5638 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5639 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5640 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5641 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5642
5643 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5644 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5645 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5646 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5647 for this to work though.
5648
5649 @item S D b
5650 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5651 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5652 @cindex bouncing mail
5653 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5654 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5655 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5656 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5657 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5658 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5659 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5660 very well fail, though.
5661
5662 @item S D r
5663 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5664 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5665 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5666 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5667 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5668 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5669 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5670 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5671 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5672 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5673
5674 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5675 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5676 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5677 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5678 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5679
5680 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5681 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5682
5683 @item S D e
5684 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5685 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5686
5687 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5688 if it were a new message before resending.
5689
5690 @item S O m
5691 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5692 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5693 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5694 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5695 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5696
5697 @item S M-c
5698 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5699 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5700 @cindex crossposting
5701 @cindex excessive crossposting
5702 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5703 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5704
5705 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5706 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5707 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5708 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5709 command understands the process/prefix convention
5710 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5711
5712 @end table
5713
5714 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5715 Manual}, for more information.
5716
5717
5718 @node Summary Post Commands
5719 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5720 @cindex post
5721 @cindex composing news
5722
5723 Commands for posting a news article:
5724
5725 @table @kbd
5726 @item S p
5727 @itemx a
5728 @kindex a (Summary)
5729 @kindex S p (Summary)
5730 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5731 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5732 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5733 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5734 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5735
5736 @item S f
5737 @itemx f
5738 @kindex f (Summary)
5739 @kindex S f (Summary)
5740 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5741 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5742 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5743
5744 @item S F
5745 @itemx F
5746 @kindex S F (Summary)
5747 @kindex F (Summary)
5748 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5749 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5750 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5751 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5752 process/prefix convention.
5753
5754 @item S n
5755 @kindex S n (Summary)
5756 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5757 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5758 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5759
5760 @item S N
5761 @kindex S N (Summary)
5762 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5763 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5764 message through mail and include the original message
5765 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5766 the process/prefix convention.
5767
5768 @item S o p
5769 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5770 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5771 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5772 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5773 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5774 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5775 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5776 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5777 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5778 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5779 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5780 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5781 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5782
5783 @item S O p
5784 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5785 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5786 @cindex digests
5787 @cindex making digests
5788 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5789 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5790 process/prefix convention.
5791
5792 @item S u
5793 @kindex S u (Summary)
5794 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5795 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5796 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5797 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5798 @end table
5799
5800 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5801 Manual}, for more information.
5802
5803
5804 @node Summary Message Commands
5805 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5806
5807 @table @kbd
5808 @item S y
5809 @kindex S y (Summary)
5810 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5811 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5812 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5813 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5814 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5815
5816 @end table
5817
5818
5819 @node Canceling and Superseding
5820 @subsection Canceling Articles
5821 @cindex canceling articles
5822 @cindex superseding articles
5823
5824 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5825 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5826
5827 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5828
5829 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5830 @kindex C (Summary)
5831 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5832 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5833 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5834 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5835 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5836 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5837
5838 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5839 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5840 question.
5841
5842 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5843 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5844 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5845
5846 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5847 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5848 message, Message Manual}).
5849
5850 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5851 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5852 your original article.
5853
5854 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5855 @kindex S (Summary)
5856 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5857 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5858 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5859 usual way.
5860
5861 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5862 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5863 have posted almost the same article twice.
5864
5865 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5866 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5867 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5868 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5869 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5870 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5871 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5872 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5873 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5874 canceled/superseded.
5875
5876 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5877
5878 @node Delayed Articles
5879 @section Delayed Articles
5880 @cindex delayed sending
5881 @cindex send delayed
5882
5883 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5884 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5885 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5886 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5887
5888 @lisp
5889 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5890 @end lisp
5891
5892 @findex gnus-delay-article
5893 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5894 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5895 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5896 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5897
5898 @itemize @bullet
5899 @item
5900 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5901 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5902 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5903 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5904
5905 @item
5906 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5907 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5908 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5909
5910 @item
5911 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5912 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5913 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5914 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5915 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5916 that means a time tomorrow.
5917 @end itemize
5918
5919 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5920 couple of variables:
5921
5922 @table @code
5923 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5924 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5925 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5926 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5927
5928 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5929 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5930 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5931 formats described above.
5932
5933 @item gnus-delay-group
5934 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5935 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5936 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5937 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5938
5939 @item gnus-delay-header
5940 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5941 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5942 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5943 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5944 @end table
5945
5946 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5947 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5948 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5949 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5950 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5951
5952 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5953 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5954 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5955 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5956 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5957 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5958 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5959
5960 @table @code
5961 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5962 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5963 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5964 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5965 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5966 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5967 argument is ignored.
5968
5969 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5970 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5971 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5972 @end table
5973
5974 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5975 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5976 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5977 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5978 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5979
5980
5981 @node Marking Articles
5982 @section Marking Articles
5983 @cindex article marking
5984 @cindex article ticking
5985 @cindex marks
5986
5987 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5988
5989 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5990 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5991 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5992
5993 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5994
5995 @ifinfo
5996 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5997 @end ifinfo
5998
5999 @menu
6000 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6001 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6002 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6003 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6004 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6005 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6006 @end menu
6007
6008
6009 @node Unread Articles
6010 @subsection Unread Articles
6011
6012 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6013 other.
6014
6015 @table @samp
6016 @item !
6017 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6018 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6019
6020 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6021 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6022 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6023 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6024 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6025 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6026 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6027
6028 @item ?
6029 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6030 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6031
6032 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6033 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6034 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6035 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6036 messages.
6037
6038 @item SPACE
6039 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6040 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6041
6042 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6043 @end table
6044
6045
6046 @node Read Articles
6047 @subsection Read Articles
6048 @cindex expirable mark
6049
6050 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6051
6052 @table @samp
6053
6054 @item r
6055 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6056 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6057 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6058
6059 @item R
6060 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6061 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6062
6063 @item O
6064 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6065 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6066 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6067
6068 @item K
6069 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6070 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6071
6072 @item X
6073 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6074 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6075
6076 @item Y
6077 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6078 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6079
6080 @item C
6081 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6082 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6083
6084 @item G
6085 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6086 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6087
6088 @item Q
6089 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6090 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6091 Threading}.
6092
6093 @item M
6094 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6095 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6096 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6097
6098 @end table
6099
6100 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6101 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6102
6103 One more special mark, though:
6104
6105 @table @samp
6106 @item E
6107 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6108 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6109
6110 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6111 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6112 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6113 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6114 any time.
6115 @end table
6116
6117
6118 @node Other Marks
6119 @subsection Other Marks
6120 @cindex process mark
6121 @cindex bookmarks
6122
6123 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6124 read or not.
6125
6126 @itemize @bullet
6127
6128 @item
6129 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6130 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6131 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6132 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6133 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6134
6135 @item
6136 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6137 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6138 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6139 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6140
6141 @item
6142 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6143 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6144 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6145
6146 @item
6147 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6148 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6149 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6150
6151 @item
6152 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6153 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6154 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6155 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6156
6157 @item
6158 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6159 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6160 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6161
6162 @item
6163 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6164 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6165 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6166 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6167 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6168 use.)
6169
6170 @item
6171 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6172 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6173 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6174 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6175 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6176 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6177
6178 @item
6179 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6180 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6181 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6182 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6183 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6184 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6185 use.)
6186
6187 @item
6188 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6189 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6190 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6191 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6192 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6193
6194 @item
6195 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6196 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6197 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6198 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6199 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6200 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6201
6202 @end itemize
6203
6204 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6205 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6206 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6207
6208 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6209 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6210 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6211
6212
6213 @node Setting Marks
6214 @subsection Setting Marks
6215 @cindex setting marks
6216
6217 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6218
6219 @table @kbd
6220 @item M c
6221 @itemx M-u
6222 @kindex M c (Summary)
6223 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6224 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6225 @cindex mark as unread
6226 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6227 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6228 article as unread.
6229
6230 @item M t
6231 @itemx !
6232 @kindex ! (Summary)
6233 @kindex M t (Summary)
6234 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6235 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6236 @xref{Article Caching}.
6237
6238 @item M ?
6239 @itemx ?
6240 @kindex ? (Summary)
6241 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6242 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6243 Mark the current article as dormant
6244 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6245
6246 @item M d
6247 @itemx d
6248 @kindex M d (Summary)
6249 @kindex d (Summary)
6250 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6251 Mark the current article as read
6252 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6253
6254 @item D
6255 @kindex D (Summary)
6256 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6257 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6258 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6259
6260 @item M k
6261 @itemx k
6262 @kindex k (Summary)
6263 @kindex M k (Summary)
6264 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6265 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6266 and then select the next unread article
6267 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6268
6269 @item M K
6270 @itemx C-k
6271 @kindex M K (Summary)
6272 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6273 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6274 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6275 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6276
6277 @item M C
6278 @kindex M C (Summary)
6279 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6280 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6281 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6282
6283 @item M C-c
6284 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6286 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6287 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6288
6289 @item M H
6290 @kindex M H (Summary)
6291 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6292 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6293 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6294
6295 @item M h
6296 @kindex M h (Summary)
6297 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6298 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6299 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6300
6301 @item C-w
6302 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6303 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6304 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6305 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6306
6307 @item M V k
6308 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6309 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6310 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6311 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6312
6313 @item M e
6314 @itemx E
6315 @kindex M e (Summary)
6316 @kindex E (Summary)
6317 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6318 Mark the current article as expirable
6319 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6320
6321 @item M b
6322 @kindex M b (Summary)
6323 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6324 Set a bookmark in the current article
6325 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6326
6327 @item M B
6328 @kindex M B (Summary)
6329 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6330 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6331 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6332
6333 @item M V c
6334 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6335 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6336 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6337 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6338
6339 @item M V u
6340 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6341 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6342 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6343 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6344
6345 @item M V m
6346 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6347 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6348 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6349 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6350 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6351 @end table
6352
6353 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6354 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6355 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6356 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6357 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6358 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6359 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6360 The default is @code{t}.
6361
6362
6363 @node Generic Marking Commands
6364 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6365
6366 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6367 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6368 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6369 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6370 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6371 well.
6372
6373 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6374 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6375 command should do.
6376
6377 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6378 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6379 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6380 to list in this manual.
6381
6382 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6383 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6384 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6385 article, you could say something like:
6386
6387 @lisp
6388 @group
6389 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6390 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6391 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6392 @end group
6393 @end lisp
6394
6395 @noindent
6396 or
6397
6398 @lisp
6399 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6400 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6401 @end lisp
6402
6403
6404 @node Setting Process Marks
6405 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6406 @cindex setting process marks
6407
6408 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6409 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6410 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6411 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6412 articles into the cache. For more information,
6413 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6414
6415 @table @kbd
6416
6417 @item M P p
6418 @itemx #
6419 @kindex # (Summary)
6420 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6421 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6422 Mark the current article with the process mark
6423 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6424 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6425
6426 @item M P u
6427 @itemx M-#
6428 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6429 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6430 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6431 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6432
6433 @item M P U
6434 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6435 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6436 Remove the process mark from all articles
6437 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6438
6439 @item M P i
6440 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6441 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6442 Invert the list of process marked articles
6443 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6444
6445 @item M P R
6446 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6447 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6448 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6449 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6450
6451 @item M P G
6452 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6453 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6454 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6455 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6456
6457 @item M P r
6458 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6459 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6460 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6461
6462 @item M P g
6463 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6464 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6465 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6466
6467 @item M P t
6468 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6470 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6471 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6472
6473 @item M P T
6474 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6475 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6476 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6477 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6478
6479 @item M P v
6480 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6481 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6482 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6483 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6484
6485 @item M P s
6486 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6487 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6488 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6489
6490 @item M P S
6491 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6492 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6493 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6494 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6495
6496 @item M P a
6497 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6498 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6499 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6500
6501 @item M P b
6502 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6503 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6504 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6505 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6506
6507 @item M P k
6508 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6509 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6510 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6511 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6512
6513 @item M P y
6514 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6515 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6516 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6517 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6518
6519 @item M P w
6520 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6521 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6522 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6523 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6524
6525 @end table
6526
6527 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6528 set process marks based on article body contents.
6529
6530
6531 @node Limiting
6532 @section Limiting
6533 @cindex limiting
6534
6535 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6536 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6537 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6538 buffer.
6539
6540 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6541 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6542 articles.
6543
6544 @table @kbd
6545
6546 @item / /
6547 @itemx / s
6548 @kindex / / (Summary)
6549 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6550 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6551 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6552 matching articles.
6553
6554 @item / a
6555 @kindex / a (Summary)
6556 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6557 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6558 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6559 matching articles.
6560
6561 @item / R
6562 @kindex / R (Summary)
6563 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6564 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6565 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6566 matching articles.
6567
6568 @item / A
6569 @kindex / A (Summary)
6570 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6571 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6572 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6573 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6574
6575 @item / S
6576 @kindex / S (Summary)
6577 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6578 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6579 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6580 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6581
6582 @item / x
6583 @kindex / x (Summary)
6584 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6585 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6586 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6587 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6588 matching articles.
6589
6590 @item / u
6591 @itemx x
6592 @kindex / u (Summary)
6593 @kindex x (Summary)
6594 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6595 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6596 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6597 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6598 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6599
6600 @item / m
6601 @kindex / m (Summary)
6602 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6603 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6604 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6605
6606 @item / t
6607 @kindex / t (Summary)
6608 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6609 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6610 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6611 articles younger than that number of days.
6612
6613 @item / n
6614 @kindex / n (Summary)
6615 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6616 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6617 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6618 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6619
6620 @item / w
6621 @kindex / w (Summary)
6622 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6623 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6624 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6625 the stack.
6626
6627 @item / .
6628 @kindex / . (Summary)
6629 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6630 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6631 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6632
6633 @item / v
6634 @kindex / v (Summary)
6635 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6636 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6637 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6638
6639 @item / p
6640 @kindex / p (Summary)
6641 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6642 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6643 group parameter predicate
6644 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6645 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6646
6647 @item / r
6648 @kindex / r (Summary)
6649 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6650 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6651 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6652 replied articles.
6653
6654 @item / E
6655 @itemx M S
6656 @kindex M S (Summary)
6657 @kindex / E (Summary)
6658 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6659 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6660 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6661
6662 @item / D
6663 @kindex / D (Summary)
6664 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6665 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6666 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6667
6668 @item / *
6669 @kindex / * (Summary)
6670 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6671 Include all cached articles in the limit
6672 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6673
6674 @item / d
6675 @kindex / d (Summary)
6676 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6677 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6678 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6679
6680 @item / M
6681 @kindex / M (Summary)
6682 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6683 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6684
6685 @item / T
6686 @kindex / T (Summary)
6687 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6688 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6689
6690 @item / c
6691 @kindex / c (Summary)
6692 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6693 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6694 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6695
6696 @item / C
6697 @kindex / C (Summary)
6698 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6699 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6700 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6701 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6702
6703 @item / b
6704 @kindex / b (Summary)
6705 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6706 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6707 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6708 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6709 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6710
6711 @item / h
6712 @kindex / h (Summary)
6713 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6714 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6715 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6716
6717 @end table
6718
6719
6720 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6721 prefix as well.
6722
6723 @table @kbd
6724 @item / N
6725 @kindex / N (Summary)
6726 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6727 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6728 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6729
6730 @item / o
6731 @kindex / o (Summary)
6732 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6733 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6734 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6735
6736 @end table
6737
6738
6739 @node Threading
6740 @section Threading
6741 @cindex threading
6742 @cindex article threading
6743
6744 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6745 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6746 hierarchical fashion.
6747
6748 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6749 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6750 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6751 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6752 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6753 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6754 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6755
6756 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6757
6758 @table @dfn
6759 @item root
6760 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6761
6762 @item thread
6763 A tree-like article structure.
6764
6765 @item sub-thread
6766 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6767
6768 @item loose threads
6769 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6770 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6771 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6772 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6773 called loose threads.
6774
6775 @item thread gathering
6776 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6777
6778 @item sparse threads
6779 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6780 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6781
6782 @end table
6783
6784
6785 @menu
6786 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6787 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6788 @end menu
6789
6790
6791 @node Customizing Threading
6792 @subsection Customizing Threading
6793 @cindex customizing threading
6794
6795 @menu
6796 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6797 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6798 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6799 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6800 @end menu
6801
6802
6803 @node Loose Threads
6804 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6805 @cindex <
6806 @cindex >
6807 @cindex loose threads
6808
6809 @table @code
6810 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6811 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6812 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6813 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6814 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6815 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6816
6817 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6818 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6819 There are four possible values:
6820
6821 @iftex
6822 @iflatex
6823 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6824 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6825 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6826 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6827 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6828 }
6829 @end iflatex
6830 @end iftex
6831
6832 @cindex adopting articles
6833
6834 @table @code
6835
6836 @item adopt
6837 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6838 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6839 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6840 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6841
6842 @item dummy
6843 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6844 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6845 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6846 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6847 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6848 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6849 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6850 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6851 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6852 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6853
6854 @item empty
6855 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6856 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6857 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6858 Buffer Format}).)
6859
6860 @item none
6861 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6862 display them after one another.
6863
6864 @item nil
6865 Don't gather loose threads.
6866 @end table
6867
6868 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6869 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6870 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6871 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6872 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6873 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6874 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6875 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6876 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6877 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6878 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6879
6880 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6881 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6882 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6883 Matching}).
6884
6885 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6886 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6887 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6888 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6889 simplification is used.
6890
6891 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6892 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6893 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6894 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6895
6896 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6897 @lisp
6898 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6899 (concat
6900 "\\`\\[?\\("
6901 (mapconcat
6902 'identity
6903 '("looking"
6904 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6905 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6906 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6907 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6908 ;; ...
6909 )
6910 "\\|")
6911 "\\)\\s *\\("
6912 (mapconcat 'identity
6913 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6914 "\\|")
6915 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6916 @end lisp
6917
6918 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6919 subjects.
6920
6921 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6922 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6923 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6924 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6925 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6926 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6927
6928 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6929
6930 @table @code
6931 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6932 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6933 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6934
6935 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6936 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6937 Simplify fuzzily.
6938
6939 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6940 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6941 Remove excessive whitespace.
6942
6943 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6944 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6945 Remove all whitespace.
6946 @end table
6947
6948 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6949
6950
6951 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6952 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6953 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6954 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6955 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6956 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6957 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6958 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6959
6960 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6961 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6962 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6963 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6964 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6965 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6966 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6967 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6968 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6969 cholera:
6970
6971 @table @code
6972 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6973 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6974 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6975 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6976
6977 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6978 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6979 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6980 @end table
6981
6982 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6983 something like:
6984
6985 @lisp
6986 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6987 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6988 @end lisp
6989
6990 @end table
6991
6992
6993 @node Filling In Threads
6994 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6995
6996 @table @code
6997 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6998 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6999 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7000 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7001 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7002 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7003 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7004 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7005 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7006 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7007 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7008 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7009 do about that.
7010
7011 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7012 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7013 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7014
7015 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7016
7017 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7018 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7019 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7020 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7021 slow summary generation.
7022
7023 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7024 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7025 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7026 newsgroups.
7027
7028 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7029 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7030 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7031 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7032 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7033 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7034 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7035 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7036 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7037 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7038 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7039 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7040 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7041 @code{nil} by default.
7042
7043 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7044 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7045 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7046 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7047 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7048 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7049 web-based groups.
7050
7051 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7052 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7053 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7054
7055 @end table
7056
7057
7058 @node More Threading
7059 @subsubsection More Threading
7060
7061 @table @code
7062 @item gnus-show-threads
7063 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7064 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7065 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7066 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7067 slower and more awkward.
7068
7069 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7070 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7071 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7072 generated.
7073
7074 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7075 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7076 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7077
7078 Here's an example:
7079
7080 @lisp
7081 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7082 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7083 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7084 @end lisp
7085
7086 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7087 unread, but you get my drift.)
7088
7089
7090 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7091 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7092 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7093 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7094 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7095 threads are expunged.
7096
7097 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7098 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7099 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7100 will be hidden.
7101
7102 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7103 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7104 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7105 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7106 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7107 result in a new thread.
7108
7109 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7110 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7111 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7112 The default is 4.
7113
7114 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7115 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7116 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7117 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7118 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7119 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7120 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7121 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7122 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7123 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7124 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7125
7126 @end table
7127
7128
7129 @node Low-Level Threading
7130 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7131
7132 @table @code
7133
7134 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7135 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7136 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7137
7138 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7139 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7140 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7141 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7142 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7143 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7144 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7145 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7146 meaningful. Here's one example:
7147
7148 @lisp
7149 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7150
7151 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7152 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7153 (when (string-match
7154 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7155 (mail-header-set-id
7156 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7157 header))))
7158 @end lisp
7159
7160 @end table
7161
7162
7163 @node Thread Commands
7164 @subsection Thread Commands
7165 @cindex thread commands
7166
7167 @table @kbd
7168
7169 @item T k
7170 @itemx C-M-k
7171 @kindex T k (Summary)
7172 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7173 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7174 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7175 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7176 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7177 articles instead.
7178
7179 @item T l
7180 @itemx C-M-l
7181 @kindex T l (Summary)
7182 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7183 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7184 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7185 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7186
7187 @item T i
7188 @kindex T i (Summary)
7189 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7190 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7191 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7192
7193 @item T #
7194 @kindex T # (Summary)
7195 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7196 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7197 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7198
7199 @item T M-#
7200 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7201 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7202 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7203 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7204
7205 @item T T
7206 @kindex T T (Summary)
7207 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7208 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7209
7210 @item T s
7211 @kindex T s (Summary)
7212 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7213 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7214 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7215
7216 @item T h
7217 @kindex T h (Summary)
7218 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7219 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7220
7221 @item T S
7222 @kindex T S (Summary)
7223 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7224 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7225
7226 @item T H
7227 @kindex T H (Summary)
7228 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7229 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7230
7231 @item T t
7232 @kindex T t (Summary)
7233 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7234 Re-thread the current article's thread
7235 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7236 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7237
7238 @item T ^
7239 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7240 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7241 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7242 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7243
7244 @item T M-^
7245 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7246 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7247 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7248 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7249
7250 @end table
7251
7252 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7253 understand the numeric prefix.
7254
7255 @table @kbd
7256
7257 @item T n
7258 @kindex T n (Summary)
7259 @itemx C-M-f
7260 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7261 @itemx M-down
7262 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7263 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7264 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7265
7266 @item T p
7267 @kindex T p (Summary)
7268 @itemx C-M-b
7269 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7270 @itemx M-up
7271 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7272 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7273 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7274
7275 @item T d
7276 @kindex T d (Summary)
7277 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7278 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7279
7280 @item T u
7281 @kindex T u (Summary)
7282 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7283 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7284
7285 @item T o
7286 @kindex T o (Summary)
7287 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7288 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7289 @end table
7290
7291 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7292 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7293 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7294 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7295 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7296 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7297 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7298 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7299 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7300 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7301 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7302 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7303 Matching}).
7304
7305
7306 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7307 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7308
7309 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7310 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7311 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7312 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7313 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7314 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7315 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7316 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7317 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7318 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7319 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7320 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7321 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7322 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7323 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7324
7325 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7326 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7327 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7328 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7329 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7330 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7331 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7332 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7333 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7334 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7335
7336 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7337 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7338 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7339 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7340 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7341
7342 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7343 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7344 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7345 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7346 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7347 ascending article order.
7348
7349 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7350 by number, you could do something like:
7351
7352 @lisp
7353 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7354 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7355 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7356 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7357 @end lisp
7358
7359 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7360 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7361 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7362 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7363 which the articles arrived.
7364
7365 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7366 say something like:
7367
7368 @lisp
7369 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7370 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7371 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7372 @end lisp
7373
7374 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7375 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7376 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7377 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7378 tickles your fancy.
7379
7380 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7381 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7382 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7383 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7384 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7385 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7386 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7387 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7388 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7389 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7390 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7391 variable. It is very similar to the
7392 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7393 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7394 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7395 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7396 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7397 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7398 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7399
7400 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7401 say something like:
7402
7403 @lisp
7404 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7405 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7406 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7407 @end lisp
7408
7409 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7410 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7411
7412
7413 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7414 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7415 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7416 @cindex article pre-fetch
7417 @cindex pre-fetch
7418
7419 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7420 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7421 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7422 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7423 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7424
7425 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7426 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7427
7428 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7429 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7430 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7431 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7432 connection is blocked.
7433
7434 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7435 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7436 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7437 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7438
7439 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7440 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7441 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7442 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7443 extra connection.
7444
7445 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7446 you really want to.
7447
7448 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7449 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7450 happen automatically.
7451
7452 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7453 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7454 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7455 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7456 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7457 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7458 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7459
7460 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7461 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7462 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7463 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7464 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7465 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7466 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7467 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7468 article data structure as the only parameter.
7469
7470 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7471 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7472
7473 @lisp
7474 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7475 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7476 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7477 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7478 100)))
7479
7480 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7481 @end lisp
7482
7483 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7484 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7485 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7486
7487 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7488 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7489 After an article has been prefetched, this
7490 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7491 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7492 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7493 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7494 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7495 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7496
7497 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7498 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7499 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7500 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7501
7502 @table @code
7503 @item read
7504 Remove articles when they are read.
7505
7506 @item exit
7507 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7508 @end table
7509
7510 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7511
7512 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7513 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7514 @c from the next group.
7515
7516
7517 @node Article Caching
7518 @section Article Caching
7519 @cindex article caching
7520 @cindex caching
7521
7522 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7523 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7524 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7525 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7526 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7527
7528 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7529
7530 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7531 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7532 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7533 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7534 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7535 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7536 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7537 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7538
7539 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7540 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7541 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7542 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7543 as dormant, and don't worry.
7544
7545 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7546
7547 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7548 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7549 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7550 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7551 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7552 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7553 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7554 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7555 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7556 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7557
7558 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7559 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7560 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7561 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7562 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7563 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7564 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7565 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7566 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7567 not then be downloaded by this command.
7568
7569 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7570 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7571 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7572 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7573 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7574 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7575
7576 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7577 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7578 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7579 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7580 variables, the group is not cached.
7581
7582 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7583 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7584 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7585 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7586 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7587 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7588 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7589 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7590 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7591 file.
7592
7593 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7594 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7595 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7596 where, isn't that cool?
7597
7598 @node Persistent Articles
7599 @section Persistent Articles
7600 @cindex persistent articles
7601
7602 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7603 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7604 useful in my opinion.
7605
7606 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7607 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7608 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7609 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7610 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7611 the expiry going on at the news server.
7612
7613 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7614 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7615 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7616
7617 @table @kbd
7618
7619 @item *
7620 @kindex * (Summary)
7621 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7622 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7623
7624 @item M-*
7625 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7626 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7627 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7628 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7629 article.
7630 @end table
7631
7632 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7633
7634 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7635 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7636 interested in persistent articles:
7637
7638 @lisp
7639 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7640 @end lisp
7641
7642 @node Sticky Articles
7643 @section Sticky Articles
7644 @cindex sticky articles
7645
7646 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7647 according to the value of the variable
7648 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7649 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7650 has its own article buffer.
7651
7652 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7653 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7654 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7655 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7656
7657 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7658 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7659 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7660
7661 @table @kbd
7662 @item A S
7663 @kindex A S (Summary)
7664 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7665 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7666 name for this sticky article buffer.
7667 @end table
7668
7669 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7670
7671 @table @kbd
7672 @item q
7673 @kindex q (Article)
7674 @findex bury-buffer
7675 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7676
7677 @item k
7678 @kindex k (Article)
7679 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7680 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7681 @end table
7682
7683 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7684
7685 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7686 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7687 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7688 @end defun
7689
7690 @node Article Backlog
7691 @section Article Backlog
7692 @cindex backlog
7693 @cindex article backlog
7694
7695 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7696 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7697 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7698 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7699 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7700 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7701 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7702 increase memory usage some.
7703
7704 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7705 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7706 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7707 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7708 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7709 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7710 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7711
7712 The default value is 20.
7713
7714
7715 @node Saving Articles
7716 @section Saving Articles
7717 @cindex saving articles
7718
7719 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7720 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7721 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7722 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7723 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7724
7725 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7726 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7727 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7728
7729 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7730 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7731 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7732
7733 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7734 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7735 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7736 deleted before saving.
7737
7738 @table @kbd
7739
7740 @item O o
7741 @itemx o
7742 @kindex O o (Summary)
7743 @kindex o (Summary)
7744 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7745 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7746 Save the current article using the default article saver
7747 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7748
7749 @item O m
7750 @kindex O m (Summary)
7751 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7752 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7753 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7754
7755 @item O r
7756 @kindex O r (Summary)
7757 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7758 Save the current article in Rmail format
7759 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7760 Babyl in older versions.
7761
7762 @item O f
7763 @kindex O f (Summary)
7764 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7765 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7766 Save the current article in plain file format
7767 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7768
7769 @item O F
7770 @kindex O F (Summary)
7771 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7772 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7773 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7774
7775 @item O b
7776 @kindex O b (Summary)
7777 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7778 Save the current article body in plain file format
7779 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7780
7781 @item O h
7782 @kindex O h (Summary)
7783 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7784 Save the current article in mh folder format
7785 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7786
7787 @item O v
7788 @kindex O v (Summary)
7789 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7790 Save the current article in a VM folder
7791 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7792
7793 @item O p
7794 @itemx |
7795 @kindex O p (Summary)
7796 @kindex | (Summary)
7797 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7798 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7799 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7800 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7801 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7802 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7803 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7804 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7805 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7806 @code{nil}).
7807
7808 @item O P
7809 @kindex O P (Summary)
7810 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7811 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7812 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7813 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7814 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7815 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7816 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7817
7818 @end table
7819
7820 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7821 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7822 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7823 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7824 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7825 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7826 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7827 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7828 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7829 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7830 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7831 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7832 files.
7833
7834
7835 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7836 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7837 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7838 functions below, or you can create your own.
7839
7840 @table @code
7841
7842 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7843 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7844 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7845 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7846 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7847 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7848 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7849 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7850 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7851 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7852 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7853
7854 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7855 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7856 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7857 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7858 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7859 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7860
7861 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7862 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7863 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7864 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7865 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7866 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7867 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7868
7869 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7870 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7871 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7872 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7873 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7874 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7875
7876 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7877 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7878 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7879 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7880 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7881
7882 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7883 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7884 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7885 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7886 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7887 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7888
7889 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7890 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7891 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7892 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7893 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7894 @cindex rcvstore
7895 @cindex MH folders
7896 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7897 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7898 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7899 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7900 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7901
7902 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7903 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7904 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7905 reader to use this setting.
7906
7907 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7908 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7909 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7910 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7911
7912 @itemize @bullet
7913 @item a string@*
7914 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7915 @item @code{nil}@*
7916 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7917 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7918 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7919 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7920 last used for saving.
7921 @end itemize
7922
7923 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7924 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7925 headers will be piped.
7926 @end table
7927
7928 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7929
7930 @table @code
7931 @item :decode
7932 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7933 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7934 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7935 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7936 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7937 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7938
7939 @item :function
7940 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7941 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7942 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7943 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7944 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7945 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7946
7947 @item :headers
7948 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7949 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7950 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7951 headers should be saved.
7952 @end table
7953
7954 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7955 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7956 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7957 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7958 default.
7959
7960 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7961 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7962 available functions that generate names:
7963
7964 @table @code
7965
7966 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7967 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7968 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7969
7970 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7971 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7972 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7973
7974 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7975 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7976 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7977
7978 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7979 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7980 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7981
7982 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7983 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7984 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7985 @end table
7986
7987 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7988 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7989 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7990 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7991 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7992 like:
7993
7994 @lisp
7995 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7996 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7997 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7998 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7999 @end lisp
8000
8001 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8002 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8003 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8004 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8005 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8006 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8007 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8008 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8009 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8010
8011 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8012 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8013 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8014 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8015
8016 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8017 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8018 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8019 name.
8020
8021 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8022 lots of mail groups called things like
8023 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8024 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8025 following will do just that:
8026
8027 @lisp
8028 (defun my-save-name (group)
8029 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8030 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8031
8032 (setq gnus-split-methods
8033 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8034 (my-save-name)))
8035 @end lisp
8036
8037
8038 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8039 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8040 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8041 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8042 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8043 all the files in the top level directory
8044 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8045 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8046 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8047 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8048
8049 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8050 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8051 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8052 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8053 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8054 for kill files.
8055
8056 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8057 a spool, you could
8058
8059 @lisp
8060 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8061 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8062 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8063 @end lisp
8064
8065 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8066 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8067 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8068 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8069
8070
8071 @node Decoding Articles
8072 @section Decoding Articles
8073 @cindex decoding articles
8074
8075 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8076 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8077
8078 @menu
8079 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8080 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8081 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8082 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8083 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8084 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8085 @end menu
8086
8087 @cindex series
8088 @cindex article series
8089 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8090 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8091 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8092 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8093 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8094
8095 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8096 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8097 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8098
8099 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8100 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8101 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8102
8103 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8104 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8105 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8106
8107
8108 @node Uuencoded Articles
8109 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8110 @cindex uudecode
8111 @cindex uuencoded articles
8112
8113 @table @kbd
8114
8115 @item X u
8116 @kindex X u (Summary)
8117 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8118 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8119 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8120
8121 @item X U
8122 @kindex X U (Summary)
8123 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8124 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8125 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8126
8127 @item X v u
8128 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8129 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8130 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8131
8132 @item X v U
8133 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8134 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8135 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8136 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8137
8138 @end table
8139
8140 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8141 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8142 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8143 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8144 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8145
8146 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8147 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8148 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8149 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8150 @kbd{X u}.
8151
8152 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8153 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8154 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8155 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8156 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8157 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8158 off.
8159
8160
8161 @node Shell Archives
8162 @subsection Shell Archives
8163 @cindex unshar
8164 @cindex shell archives
8165 @cindex shared articles
8166
8167 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8168 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8169 some commands to deal with these:
8170
8171 @table @kbd
8172
8173 @item X s
8174 @kindex X s (Summary)
8175 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8176 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8177
8178 @item X S
8179 @kindex X S (Summary)
8180 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8181 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8182
8183 @item X v s
8184 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8185 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8186 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8187
8188 @item X v S
8189 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8190 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8191 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8192 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8193 @end table
8194
8195
8196 @node PostScript Files
8197 @subsection PostScript Files
8198 @cindex PostScript
8199
8200 @table @kbd
8201
8202 @item X p
8203 @kindex X p (Summary)
8204 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8205 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8206
8207 @item X P
8208 @kindex X P (Summary)
8209 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8210 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8211 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8212
8213 @item X v p
8214 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8215 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8216 View the current PostScript series
8217 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8218
8219 @item X v P
8220 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8221 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8222 View and save the current PostScript series
8223 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8224 @end table
8225
8226
8227 @node Other Files
8228 @subsection Other Files
8229
8230 @table @kbd
8231 @item X o
8232 @kindex X o (Summary)
8233 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8234 Save the current series
8235 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8236
8237 @item X b
8238 @kindex X b (Summary)
8239 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8240 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8241 doesn't really work yet.
8242
8243 @item X Y
8244 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8245 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8246 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8247 @end table
8248
8249
8250 @node Decoding Variables
8251 @subsection Decoding Variables
8252
8253 Adjective, not verb.
8254
8255 @menu
8256 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8257 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8258 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8259 @end menu
8260
8261
8262 @node Rule Variables
8263 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8264 @cindex rule variables
8265
8266 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8267 variables are of the form
8268
8269 @lisp
8270 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8271 '(regexp2 command2)
8272 ...)
8273 @end lisp
8274
8275 @table @code
8276
8277 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8278 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8279 @cindex sox
8280 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8281 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8282 say something like:
8283 @lisp
8284 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8285 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8286 @end lisp
8287
8288 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8289 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8290 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8291 user and default view rules.
8292
8293 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8294 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8295 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8296 archives.
8297 @end table
8298
8299
8300 @node Other Decode Variables
8301 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8302
8303 @table @code
8304 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8305
8306 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8307 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8308 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8309 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8310 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8311
8312 @table @code
8313
8314 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8315 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8316 View the file.
8317
8318 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8319 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8320 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8321 @end table
8322
8323 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8324 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8325 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8326 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8327 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8328 time.
8329
8330 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8331 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8332 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8333
8334 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8335 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8336 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8337 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8338 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8339 kludgy.
8340
8341 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8342 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8343 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8344
8345 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8346 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8347 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8348 looking for files to display.
8349
8350 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8351 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8352 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8353 after viewing it.
8354
8355 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8356 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8357 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8358 rules.
8359
8360 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8361 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8362 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8363 unpacking commands.
8364
8365 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8366 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8367 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8368 from articles.
8369
8370 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8371 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8372 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8373 decoded articles as unread.
8374
8375 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8376 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8377 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8378 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8379
8380 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8381 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8382 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8383
8384 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8385 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8386 @cindex metamail
8387 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8388 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8389 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8390 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8391
8392 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8393 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8394 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8395 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8396 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8397 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8398 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8399 simply dropped them.
8400
8401 @end table
8402
8403
8404 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8405 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8406
8407 @table @code
8408
8409 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8410 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8411 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8412 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8413 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8414 for you when you post the article.
8415
8416 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8417 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8418 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8419 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8420
8421 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8422 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8423 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8424 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8425 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8426 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8427 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8428
8429 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8430 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8431 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8432 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8433 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8434 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8435 Default is @code{t}.
8436
8437 @end table
8438
8439
8440 @node Viewing Files
8441 @subsection Viewing Files
8442 @cindex viewing files
8443 @cindex pseudo-articles
8444
8445 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8446 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8447 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8448 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8449 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8450 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8451 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8452
8453 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8454 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8455 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8456 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8457
8458 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8459 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8460 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8461
8462 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8463 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8464 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8465 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8466 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8467
8468 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8469 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8470 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8471 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8472 a list of parameters to that command.
8473
8474 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8475 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8476 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8477
8478 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8479 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8480 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8481
8482
8483 @node Article Treatment
8484 @section Article Treatment
8485
8486 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8487 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8488 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8489 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8490 these articles easier.
8491
8492 @menu
8493 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8494 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8495 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8496 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8497 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8498 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8499 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8500 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8501 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8502 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8503 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8504 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8505 @end menu
8506
8507
8508 @node Article Highlighting
8509 @subsection Article Highlighting
8510 @cindex highlighting
8511
8512 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8513 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8514
8515 @table @kbd
8516
8517 @item W H a
8518 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8519 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8520 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8521 Do much highlighting of the current article
8522 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8523 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8524
8525 @item W H h
8526 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8527 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8528 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8529 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8530 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8531 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8532 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8533 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8534 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8535 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8536 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8537 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8538
8539 @item W H c
8540 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8541 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8542 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8543
8544 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8545
8546 @table @code
8547 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8548
8549 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8550 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8551 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8552
8553 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8554 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8555 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8556
8557 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8558 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8559 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8560 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8561 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8562 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8563
8564 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8565 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8566 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8567
8568 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8569 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8570 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8571
8572 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8573 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8574 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8575 that it's a citation.
8576
8577 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8578 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8579 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8580
8581 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8582 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8583 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8586 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8587 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8588 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8589
8590 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8591 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8592 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8593 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8594 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8595 is @code{t}.
8596
8597 @end table
8598
8599
8600 @item W H s
8601 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8602 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8603 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8604 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8605 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8606 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8607 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8608 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8609 default.
8610
8611 @end table
8612
8613 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8614
8615
8616 @node Article Fontisizing
8617 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8618 @cindex emphasis
8619 @cindex article emphasis
8620
8621 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8622 @kindex W e (Summary)
8623 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8624 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8625 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8626 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8627
8628 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8629 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8630 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8631 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8632 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8633 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8634 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8635 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8636 highlighting.
8637
8638 @lisp
8639 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8640 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8641 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8642 @end lisp
8643
8644 @cindex slash
8645 @cindex asterisk
8646 @cindex underline
8647 @cindex /
8648 @cindex *
8649
8650 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8651 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8652 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8653 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8654 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8655 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8656 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8657 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8658 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8659 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8660 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8661 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8662 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8663
8664 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8665 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8666 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8667 say something like:
8668
8669 @lisp
8670 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8671 @end lisp
8672
8673 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8674
8675 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8676 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8677 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8678 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8679
8680 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8681
8682
8683 @node Article Hiding
8684 @subsection Article Hiding
8685 @cindex article hiding
8686
8687 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8688 too much cruft in most articles.
8689
8690 @table @kbd
8691
8692 @item W W a
8693 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8694 @findex gnus-article-hide
8695 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8696 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8697 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8698
8699 @item W W h
8700 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8701 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8702 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8703 Headers}.
8704
8705 @item W W b
8706 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8707 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8708 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8709 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8710
8711 @item W W s
8712 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8713 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8714 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8715 Signature}.
8716
8717 @item W W l
8718 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8719 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8720 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8721 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8722 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8723 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8724 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8725 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8726
8727 @table @code
8728
8729 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8730 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8731 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8732 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8733
8734 @end table
8735
8736 @item W W P
8737 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8738 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8739 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8740 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8741
8742 @item W W B
8743 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8744 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8745 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8746 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8747 @cindex banner
8748 @cindex OneList
8749 @cindex stripping advertisements
8750 @cindex advertisements
8751 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8752 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8753 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8754 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8755 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8756 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8757 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8758 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8759 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8760 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8761 used.
8762
8763 For instance:
8764
8765 @lisp
8766 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8767 ((googleGroups .
8768 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8769 @end lisp
8770
8771 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8772 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8773 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8774
8775 @table @code
8776
8777 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8778 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8779 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8780 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8781 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8782 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8783 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8784 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8785 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8786 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8787 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8788
8789 @lisp
8790 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8791 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8792 @end lisp
8793
8794 @end table
8795
8796 @item W W c
8797 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8798 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8799 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8800 customizing the hiding:
8801
8802 @table @code
8803
8804 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8805 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8806 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8807 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8808 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8809 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8810 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8811 specs are valid:
8812
8813 @table @samp
8814 @item b
8815 Starting point of the hidden text.
8816 @item e
8817 Ending point of the hidden text.
8818 @item l
8819 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8820 @item n
8821 Number of lines of hidden text.
8822 @end table
8823
8824 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8825 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8826 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8827 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8828 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8829
8830 @end table
8831
8832 @item W W C-c
8833 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8834 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8835
8836 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8837 following two variables:
8838
8839 @table @code
8840 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8841 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8842 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8843 50), hide the cited text.
8844
8845 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8846 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8847 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8848 is hidden.
8849 @end table
8850
8851 @item W W C
8852 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8853 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8854 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8855 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8856 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8857 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8858
8859 @end table
8860
8861 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8862 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8863 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8864
8865 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8866 citation customization.
8867
8868 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8869 automatically.
8870
8871
8872 @node Article Washing
8873 @subsection Article Washing
8874 @cindex washing
8875 @cindex article washing
8876
8877 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8878 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8879
8880 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8881 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8882 Cleaner, perhaps.
8883
8884 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8885 articles by default.
8886
8887 @table @kbd
8888
8889 @item C-u g
8890 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8891 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8892 the server.
8893
8894 @item g
8895 Force redisplaying of the current article
8896 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8897 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8898 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8899 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8900
8901 @item W l
8902 @kindex W l (Summary)
8903 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8904 Remove page breaks from the current article
8905 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8906 delimiters.
8907
8908 @item W r
8909 @kindex W r (Summary)
8910 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8911 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8912 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8913 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8914 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8915 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8916
8917 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8918 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8919 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8920 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8921
8922 @item W m
8923 @kindex W m (Summary)
8924 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8925 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8926
8927 @item W i
8928 @kindex W i (Summary)
8929 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8930 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8931 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8932 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8933 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8934 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8935 to work.
8936
8937 @item W t
8938 @item t
8939 @kindex W t (Summary)
8940 @kindex t (Summary)
8941 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8942 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8943 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8944
8945 @item W v
8946 @kindex W v (Summary)
8947 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8948 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8949 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8950
8951 @item W o
8952 @kindex W o (Summary)
8953 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8954 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8955
8956 @item W d
8957 @kindex W d (Summary)
8958 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8959 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8960 @cindex Smartquotes
8961 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8962 @cindex Latin 1
8963 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8964 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8965 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8966 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8967 interactively.
8968
8969 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8970 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8971 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8972 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8973
8974 @item W U
8975 @kindex W U (Summary)
8976 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8977 @cindex Unicode
8978 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8979 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8980 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8981 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8982 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8983 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8984
8985 @item W Y f
8986 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8987 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8988 @cindex Outlook Express
8989 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8990 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8991 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8992
8993 @item W Y u
8994 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8995 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8996 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8997 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8998 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8999 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9000 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9001 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9002 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9003 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9004
9005 @item W Y a
9006 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9007 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9008 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9009 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9010
9011 @item W Y c
9012 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9013 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9014 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9015 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9016
9017 @item W w
9018 @kindex W w (Summary)
9019 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9020 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9021
9022 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9023 when filling.
9024
9025 @item W Q
9026 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9027 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9028 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9029
9030 @item W C
9031 @kindex W C (Summary)
9032 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9033 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9034 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9035
9036 @item W c
9037 @kindex W c (Summary)
9038 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9039 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9040 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9041 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9042 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9043
9044 @item W q
9045 @kindex W q (Summary)
9046 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9047 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9048 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9049 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9050 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9051 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9052 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9053 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9054 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9055
9056 @item W 6
9057 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9058 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9059 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9060 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9061 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9062 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9063 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9064 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9065
9066 @item W Z
9067 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9068 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9069 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9070 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9071 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9072
9073 @item W A
9074 @kindex W A (Summary)
9075 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9076 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9077 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9078 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9079 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9080
9081 @item W u
9082 @kindex W u (Summary)
9083 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9084 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9085 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9086 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9087 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9088
9089 @item W h
9090 @kindex W h (Summary)
9091 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9092 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9093 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9094 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9095
9096 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9097 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9098 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9099
9100 The default is to use the function specified by
9101 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9102 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9103 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9104
9105 @table @code
9106 @item shr
9107 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9108
9109 @item gnus-w3m
9110 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9111
9112 @item w3
9113 Use Emacs/W3.
9114
9115 @item w3m
9116 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9117
9118 @item w3m-standalone
9119 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9120
9121 @item links
9122 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9123
9124 @item lynx
9125 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9126
9127 @item html2text
9128 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9129
9130 @end table
9131
9132 @item W b
9133 @kindex W b (Summary)
9134 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9135 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9136 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9137
9138 @item W B
9139 @kindex W B (Summary)
9140 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9141 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9142 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9143
9144 @item W p
9145 @kindex W p (Summary)
9146 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9147 Verify a signed control message
9148 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9149 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9150 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9151 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9152 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9153 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9154
9155 @item W s
9156 @kindex W s (Summary)
9157 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9158 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9159 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9160 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9161
9162 @item W a
9163 @kindex W a (Summary)
9164 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9165 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9166 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9167
9168 @item W E l
9169 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9170 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9171 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9172 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9173
9174 @item W E m
9175 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9176 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9177 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9178 lines with a single empty line.
9179 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9180
9181 @item W E t
9182 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9183 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9184 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9185 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9186
9187 @item W E a
9188 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9189 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9190 Do all the three commands above
9191 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9192
9193 @item W E A
9194 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9195 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9196 Remove all blank lines
9197 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9198
9199 @item W E s
9200 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9201 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9202 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9203 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9204
9205 @item W E e
9206 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9207 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9208 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9209 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9210
9211 @end table
9212
9213 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9214
9215
9216 @node Article Header
9217 @subsection Article Header
9218
9219 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9220
9221 @table @kbd
9222
9223 @item W G u
9224 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9225 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9226 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9227
9228 @item W G n
9229 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9230 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9231 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9232 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9233
9234 @item W G f
9235 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9236 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9237 Fold all the message headers
9238 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9239
9240 @item W E w
9241 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9242 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9243 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9244 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9245
9246 @end table
9247
9248
9249 @node Article Buttons
9250 @subsection Article Buttons
9251 @cindex buttons
9252
9253 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9254 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9255 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9256 button on these references.
9257
9258 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9259 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9260 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9261 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9262 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9263
9264 @table @code
9265
9266 @item gnus-button-alist
9267 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9268 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9269
9270 @lisp
9271 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9272 @end lisp
9273
9274 @table @var
9275
9276 @item regexp
9277 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9278 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9279 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9280 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9281 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9282
9283 @item button-par
9284 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9285 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9286 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9287
9288 @item use-p
9289 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9290 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9291 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9292 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9293 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9294
9295 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9296
9297 @item function
9298 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9299
9300 @item data-par
9301 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9302 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9303
9304 @end table
9305
9306 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9307
9308 @lisp
9309 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9310 @end lisp
9311
9312 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9313 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9314 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9315 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9316 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9317
9318 @lisp
9319 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9320 @end lisp
9321
9322 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9323 @end table
9324
9325 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9326
9327 @table @code
9328 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9329 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9330
9331 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9332
9333 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9334 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9335 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9336 default values of the variables above.
9337
9338 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9339
9340 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9341 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9342 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9343 argument with a string naming the man page.
9344
9345 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9346
9347 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9348 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9349 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9350
9351 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9352 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9353 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9354 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9355 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9356 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9357 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9358 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9359 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9360 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9361 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9362 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9363
9364 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9365 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9366 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9367 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9368 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9369 string is invalid.
9370
9371 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9372 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9373 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9374 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9375
9376 @c Misc stuff
9377
9378 @item gnus-article-button-face
9379 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9380 Face used on buttons.
9381
9382 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9383 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9384 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9385
9386 @end table
9387
9388 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9389
9390
9391 @node Article Button Levels
9392 @subsection Article button levels
9393 @cindex button levels
9394 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9395 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9396 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9397 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9398 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9399 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9400 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9401 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9402
9403 @lisp
9404 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9405 (setq gnus-parameters
9406 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9407 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9408 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9409 @end lisp
9410
9411 @table @code
9412
9413 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9414 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9415 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9416 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9417 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9418 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9419
9420 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9421 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9422 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9423 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9424 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9425 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9426 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9427 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9428 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9429 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9430 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9431 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9432 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9433
9434 @item gnus-button-man-level
9435 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9436 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9437 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9438
9439 @item gnus-button-message-level
9440 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9441 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9442 Related variables and functions include
9443 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9444 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9445 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9446 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9447
9448 @end table
9449
9450
9451 @node Article Date
9452 @subsection Article Date
9453
9454 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9455 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9456 when the article was sent.
9457
9458 @table @kbd
9459
9460 @item W T u
9461 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9462 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9463 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9464 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9465
9466 @item W T i
9467 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9468 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9469 @cindex ISO 8601
9470 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9471 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9472
9473 @item W T l
9474 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9475 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9476 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9477
9478 @item W T p
9479 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9480 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9481 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9482 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9483
9484 @item W T s
9485 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9486 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9487 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9488 @findex format-time-string
9489 Display the date using a user-defined format
9490 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9491 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9492 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9493 for a list of possible format specs.
9494
9495 @item W T e
9496 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9497 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9498 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9499 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9500 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9501 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9502
9503 @example
9504 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9505 @end example
9506
9507 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9508 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9509 variable.
9510
9511 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9512
9513 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9514 @lisp
9515 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9516 @end lisp
9517
9518 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9519
9520 @item W T o
9521 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9522 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9523 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9524 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9525 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9526 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9527 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9528
9529 @end table
9530
9531 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9532 preferred format automatically.
9533
9534
9535 @node Article Display
9536 @subsection Article Display
9537 @cindex picons
9538 @cindex x-face
9539 @cindex smileys
9540 @cindex gravatars
9541
9542 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9543 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9544
9545 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9546 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9547
9548 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9549 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9550
9551 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9552 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9553
9554 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9555 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9556
9557 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9558 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9559
9560 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9561 they'll be removed.
9562
9563 @table @kbd
9564 @item W D x
9565 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9566 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9567 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9568 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9569
9570 @item W D d
9571 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9572 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9573 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9574 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9575
9576 @item W D s
9577 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9578 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9579 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9580
9581 @item W D f
9582 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9583 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9584 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9585
9586 @item W D m
9587 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9588 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9589 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9590 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9591
9592 @item W D n
9593 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9594 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9595 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9596 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9597
9598 @item W D g
9599 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9600 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9601 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9602
9603 @item W D h
9604 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9605 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9606 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9607 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9608
9609 @item W D D
9610 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9611 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9612 Remove all images from the article buffer
9613 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9614
9615 @item W D W
9616 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9617 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9618 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9619 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9620 the buffer with this command.
9621 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9622
9623 @end table
9624
9625
9626
9627 @node Article Signature
9628 @subsection Article Signature
9629 @cindex signatures
9630 @cindex article signature
9631
9632 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9633 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9634 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9635 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9636 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9637 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9638 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9639 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9640 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9641
9642 @lisp
9643 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9644 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9645 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9646 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9647 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9648 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9649 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9650 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9651 @end lisp
9652
9653 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9654 positives.
9655
9656 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9657 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9658 signature when displaying articles.
9659
9660 @enumerate
9661 @item
9662 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9663 that integer.
9664 @item
9665 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9666 than that number.
9667 @item
9668 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9669 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9670 @item
9671 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9672 in question is not a signature.
9673 @end enumerate
9674
9675 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9676 listed above. Here's an example:
9677
9678 @lisp
9679 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9680 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9681 @end lisp
9682
9683 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9684 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9685 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9686 signature after all.
9687
9688
9689 @node Article Miscellanea
9690 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9691
9692 @table @kbd
9693 @item A t
9694 @kindex A t (Summary)
9695 @findex gnus-article-babel
9696 Translate the article from one language to another
9697 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9698
9699 @end table
9700
9701
9702 @node MIME Commands
9703 @section MIME Commands
9704 @cindex MIME decoding
9705 @cindex attachments
9706 @cindex viewing attachments
9707
9708 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9709 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9710
9711 @table @kbd
9712 @item b
9713 @itemx K v
9714 @kindex b (Summary)
9715 @kindex K v (Summary)
9716 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9717
9718 @item K o
9719 @kindex K o (Summary)
9720 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9721
9722 @item K O
9723 @kindex K O (Summary)
9724 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9725 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9726 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9727
9728 @item K r
9729 @kindex K r (Summary)
9730 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9731
9732 @item K d
9733 @kindex K d (Summary)
9734 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9735 removed part.
9736
9737 @item K c
9738 @kindex K c (Summary)
9739 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9740
9741 @item K e
9742 @kindex K e (Summary)
9743 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9744
9745 @item K i
9746 @kindex K i (Summary)
9747 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9748
9749 @item K |
9750 @kindex K | (Summary)
9751 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9752 @end table
9753
9754 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9755 the same manner:
9756
9757 @table @kbd
9758 @item K H
9759 @kindex K H (Summary)
9760 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9761 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9762 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9763 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9764 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9765 unless the prefix argument is given.
9766
9767 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9768 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9769 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9770 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9771 trusted senders.
9772
9773 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9774 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9775
9776 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9777 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9778 the group (if you want).
9779
9780 @item K b
9781 @kindex K b (Summary)
9782 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9783 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9784 parts.
9785
9786 @item K m
9787 @kindex K m (Summary)
9788 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9789 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9790 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9791 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9792 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9793
9794 @item X m
9795 @kindex X m (Summary)
9796 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9797 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9798 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9799 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9800
9801 @item M-t
9802 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9803 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9804 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9805 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9806
9807 @item W M w
9808 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9809 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9810 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9811 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9812
9813 @item W M c
9814 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9815 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9816 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9817 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9818
9819 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9820 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9821 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9822 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9823 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9824 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9825
9826 @item W M v
9827 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9828 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9829 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9830 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9831
9832 @end table
9833
9834 Relevant variables:
9835
9836 @table @code
9837 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9838 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9839 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9840 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9841 @code{nil}.
9842
9843 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9844
9845 @lisp
9846 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9847 '("text/x-vcard"))
9848 @end lisp
9849
9850 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9851 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9852 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9853 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9854 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9855 default is @code{t}.
9856
9857 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9858 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9859 @cindex uuencode
9860 @cindex yEnc
9861 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9862 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9863 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9864 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9865 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9866 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9867 for encoding in Gnus.
9868
9869 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9870 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9871 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9872 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9873 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9874 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9875 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9876 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9877
9878 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9879 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9880 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9881 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9882 displayed. This variable overrides
9883 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9884 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9885 is @code{nil}.
9886
9887 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9888 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9889 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9890
9891 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9892 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9893 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9894 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9895 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9896
9897 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9898 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9899 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9900 default value is @code{nil}.
9901
9902 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9903 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9904 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9905 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9906 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9907 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9908 save all jpegs into some directory).
9909
9910 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9911
9912 @lisp
9913 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9914 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9915 (with-temp-buffer
9916 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9917 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9918 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9919 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9920 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9921 @end lisp
9922
9923 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9924 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9925 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9926
9927 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9928 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9929 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9930
9931 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9932 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9933 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9934
9935 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9936 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9937 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9938 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9939 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9940
9941 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9942 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9943 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9944 overrides @code{nil} values of
9945 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9946 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9947
9948 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9949 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9950 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9951 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9952
9953 Ready-made functions include@*
9954 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9955 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9956 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9957 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9958 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9959 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9960 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9961 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9962 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9963 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9964 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9965 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9966
9967 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9968 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9969
9970 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9971 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9972 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9973
9974 @lisp
9975 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9976 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9977 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9978 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9979 @end lisp
9980
9981 @noindent
9982 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9983
9984 @end table
9985
9986
9987 @node Charsets
9988 @section Charsets
9989 @cindex charsets
9990
9991 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9992 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9993 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9994 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9995 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9996 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9997 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9998
9999 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10000 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10001 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10002 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10003
10004 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10005 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10006 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10007 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10008 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10009 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10010 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10011 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10012 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10013
10014 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10015 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10016 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10017 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10018 quoted-printable header encoding.
10019
10020 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10021 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10022 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10023
10024 @table @var
10025 @item test
10026 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10027 variable to query,
10028 @item header
10029 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10030 means encode all charsets),
10031 @item body-list
10032 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10033 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10034 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10035 @end table
10036
10037 @cindex Russian
10038 @cindex koi8-r
10039 @cindex koi8-u
10040 @cindex iso-8859-5
10041 @cindex coding system aliases
10042 @cindex preferred charset
10043
10044 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10045 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10046 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10047
10048 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10049
10050 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10051 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10052
10053 @lisp
10054 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10055 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10056 @end lisp
10057
10058 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10059 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10060
10061 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10062
10063 @lisp
10064 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10065 @end lisp
10066
10067 This will almost do the right thing.
10068
10069 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10070 something like
10071
10072 @lisp
10073 (codepage-setup 1251)
10074 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10075 @end lisp
10076
10077
10078 @node Article Commands
10079 @section Article Commands
10080
10081 @table @kbd
10082
10083 @item A P
10084 @cindex PostScript
10085 @cindex printing
10086 @kindex A P (Summary)
10087 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10088 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10089 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10090 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10091 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10092 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10093
10094 @item A C
10095 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10096 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10097 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10098 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10099 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10100 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10101 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10102 do so.
10103
10104 @end table
10105
10106
10107 @node Summary Sorting
10108 @section Summary Sorting
10109 @cindex summary sorting
10110
10111 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10112 can't really see why you'd want that.
10113
10114 @table @kbd
10115
10116 @item C-c C-s C-n
10117 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10118 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10119 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10120
10121 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10122 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10123 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10124 Sort by most recent article number
10125 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10126
10127 @item C-c C-s C-a
10128 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10129 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10130 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10131
10132 @item C-c C-s C-t
10133 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10134 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10135 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10136
10137 @item C-c C-s C-s
10138 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10139 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10140 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10141
10142 @item C-c C-s C-d
10143 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10144 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10145 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10146
10147 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10148 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10149 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10150 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10151
10152 @item C-c C-s C-l
10153 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10154 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10155 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10156
10157 @item C-c C-s C-c
10158 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10159 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10160 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10161
10162 @item C-c C-s C-i
10163 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10164 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10165 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10166
10167 @item C-c C-s C-r
10168 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10169 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10170 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10171
10172 @item C-c C-s C-o
10173 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10174 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10175 Sort using the default sorting method
10176 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10177 @end table
10178
10179 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10180 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10181 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10182 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10183 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10184 Commands}).
10185
10186 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10187
10188
10189 @node Finding the Parent
10190 @section Finding the Parent
10191 @cindex parent articles
10192 @cindex referring articles
10193
10194 @table @kbd
10195 @item ^
10196 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10197 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10198 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10199 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10200 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10201 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10202 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10203 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10204 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10205 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10206
10207 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10208 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10209 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10210 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10211 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10212 article.
10213
10214 @item A R (Summary)
10215 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10216 @kindex A R (Summary)
10217 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10218 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10219
10220 @item A T (Summary)
10221 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10222 @kindex A T (Summary)
10223 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10224 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10225 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10226 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10227 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10228 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10229 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10230
10231 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10232 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10233 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10234 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10235 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10236 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10237
10238 @item M-^ (Summary)
10239 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10240 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10241 @cindex Message-ID
10242 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10243 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10244 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10245 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10246 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10247 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10248
10249 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10250 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10251 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10252 @end table
10253
10254 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10255 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10256 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10257 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10258 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10259 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10260 necessary.
10261
10262 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10263 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10264 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10265 match.
10266
10267 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10268 then ask Google if that fails:
10269
10270 @lisp
10271 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10272 '(current
10273 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10274 @end lisp
10275
10276 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10277 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10278 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10279 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10280 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10281 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10282
10283 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10284 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10285 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10286 registry}).
10287
10288 @node Alternative Approaches
10289 @section Alternative Approaches
10290
10291 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10292 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10293
10294 @menu
10295 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10296 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10297 @end menu
10298
10299
10300 @node Pick and Read
10301 @subsection Pick and Read
10302 @cindex pick and read
10303
10304 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10305 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10306 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10307 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10308
10309 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10310 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10311 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10312 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10313 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10314 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10315
10316 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10317
10318 @table @kbd
10319 @item .
10320 @kindex . (Pick)
10321 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10322 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10323 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10324 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10325 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10326 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10327 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10328 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10329
10330 @item SPACE
10331 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10332 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10333 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10334 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10335
10336 @item u
10337 @kindex u (Pick)
10338 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10339 Unpick the thread or article
10340 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10341 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10342 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10343 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10344 the thread or article at that line.
10345
10346 @item RET
10347 @kindex RET (Pick)
10348 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10349 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10350 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10351 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10352 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10353 will still be visible when you are reading.
10354
10355 @end table
10356
10357 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10358 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10359 which is mapped to the same function
10360 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10361
10362 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10363
10364 @lisp
10365 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10366 @end lisp
10367
10368 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10369 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10370
10371 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10372 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10373 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10374
10375 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10376 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10377 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10378 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10379 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10380 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10381 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10382
10383
10384 @node Binary Groups
10385 @subsection Binary Groups
10386 @cindex binary groups
10387
10388 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10389 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10390 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10391 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10392 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10393 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10394 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10395
10396 @kindex g (Binary)
10397 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10398 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10399 command, when you have turned on this mode
10400 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10401
10402 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10403 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10404
10405
10406 @node Tree Display
10407 @section Tree Display
10408 @cindex trees
10409
10410 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10411 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10412 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10413 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10414 in the tree buffer.
10415
10416 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10417
10418 @table @code
10419 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10420 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10421 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10422
10423 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10424 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10425 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10426 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10427 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10428
10429 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10430 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10431 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10432 default is @code{modeline}.
10433
10434 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10435 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10436 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10437 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10438 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10439 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10440 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10441
10442 Valid specs are:
10443
10444 @table @samp
10445 @item n
10446 The name of the poster.
10447 @item f
10448 The @code{From} header.
10449 @item N
10450 The number of the article.
10451 @item [
10452 The opening bracket.
10453 @item ]
10454 The closing bracket.
10455 @item s
10456 The subject.
10457 @end table
10458
10459 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10460
10461 Variables related to the display are:
10462
10463 @table @code
10464 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10465 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10466 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10467 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10468 @example
10469 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10470 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10471 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10472 @end example
10473 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10474
10475 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10476 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10477 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10478 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10479
10480 @end table
10481
10482 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10483 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10484 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10485 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10486 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10487 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10488 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10489 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10490 other windows displayed next to it.
10491
10492 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10493 at all times:
10494
10495 @lisp
10496 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10497 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10498 @end lisp
10499
10500 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10501 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10502 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10503 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10504 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10505 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10506 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10507
10508 @end table
10509
10510 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10511
10512 @example
10513 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10514 | \[Jan]
10515 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10516 | \(***)-[Eri]
10517 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10518 \[Bjo]
10519 \[Gun]
10520 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10521 @end example
10522
10523 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10524
10525 @example
10526 @group
10527 @{***@}
10528 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10529 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10530 |--\-----\-----\ |
10531 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10532 | | |--\
10533 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10534 |
10535 [Paa]
10536 @end group
10537 @end example
10538
10539 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10540 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10541 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10542
10543 @lisp
10544 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10545 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10546 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10547 (gnus-add-configuration
10548 '(article
10549 (vertical 1.0
10550 (horizontal 0.25
10551 (summary 0.75 point)
10552 (tree 1.0))
10553 (article 1.0))))
10554 @end lisp
10555
10556 @xref{Window Layout}.
10557
10558
10559 @node Mail Group Commands
10560 @section Mail Group Commands
10561 @cindex mail group commands
10562
10563 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10564 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10565
10566 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10567 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10568
10569 @table @kbd
10570
10571 @item B e
10572 @kindex B e (Summary)
10573 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10574 @cindex expiring mail
10575 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10576 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10577 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10578 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10579
10580 @item B C-M-e
10581 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10582 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10583 @cindex expiring mail
10584 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10585 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10586 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10587 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10588
10589 @item B DEL
10590 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10591 @cindex deleting mail
10592 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10593 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10594 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10595 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10596 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10597
10598 @item B m
10599 @kindex B m (Summary)
10600 @cindex move mail
10601 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10602 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10603 Move the article from one mail group to another
10604 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10605 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10606
10607 @item B c
10608 @kindex B c (Summary)
10609 @cindex copy mail
10610 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10611 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10612 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10613 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10614 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10615
10616 @item B B
10617 @kindex B B (Summary)
10618 @cindex crosspost mail
10619 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10620 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10621 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10622 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10623 be properly updated.
10624
10625 @item B i
10626 @kindex B i (Summary)
10627 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10628 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10629 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10630 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10631
10632 @item B I
10633 @kindex B I (Summary)
10634 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10635 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10636 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10637 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10638
10639 @item B r
10640 @kindex B r (Summary)
10641 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10642 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10643 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10644 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10645 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10646 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10647 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10648 (which is the default).
10649
10650 @item B w
10651 @itemx e
10652 @kindex B w (Summary)
10653 @kindex e (Summary)
10654 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10655 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10656 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10657 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10658 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10659 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10660 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10661
10662 @item B q
10663 @kindex B q (Summary)
10664 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10665 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10666 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10667 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10668
10669 @item B t
10670 @kindex B t (Summary)
10671 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10672 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10673 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10674
10675 @item B p
10676 @kindex B p (Summary)
10677 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10678 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10679 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10680 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10681 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10682 article from your news server (or rather, from
10683 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10684 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10685 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10686 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10687 just not have arrived yet.
10688
10689 @item K E
10690 @kindex K E (Summary)
10691 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10692 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10693 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10694 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10695 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10696
10697 @end table
10698
10699 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10700 @cindex moving articles
10701 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10702 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10703 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10704 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10705 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10706 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10707 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10708
10709 @lisp
10710 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10711 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10712 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10713 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10714 @end lisp
10715
10716
10717 @node Various Summary Stuff
10718 @section Various Summary Stuff
10719
10720 @menu
10721 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10722 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10723 * Summary Generation Commands::
10724 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10725 @end menu
10726
10727 @table @code
10728 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10729 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10730 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10731 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10732 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10733 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10734
10735 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10736 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10737 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10738 current article.
10739
10740 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10741 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10742 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10743
10744 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10745 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10746 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10747 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10748 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10749 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10750 have been set.
10751
10752 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10753 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10754 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10755 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10756 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10757
10758 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10759 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10760 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10761 generated.
10762
10763 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10764 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10765 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10766 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10767 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10768 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10769 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10770 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10771 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10772 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10773
10774 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10775 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10776 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10777 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10778 list of articles to be selected.
10779
10780 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10781 the list in one particular group:
10782
10783 @lisp
10784 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10785 (if (string= group "some.group")
10786 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10787 articles))
10788 @end lisp
10789
10790 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10791 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10792 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10793 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10794 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10795 buffer is active.
10796
10797 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10798 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10799 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10800 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10801 variable will be used instead.
10802
10803 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10804 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10805 buffers. For example:
10806
10807 @lisp
10808 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10809 '(message-use-followup-to
10810 (gnus-visible-headers .
10811 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10812 @end lisp
10813
10814 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10815
10816 @end table
10817
10818
10819 @node Summary Group Information
10820 @subsection Summary Group Information
10821
10822 @table @kbd
10823
10824 @item H d
10825 @kindex H d (Summary)
10826 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10827 Give a brief description of the current group
10828 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10829 rereading the description from the server.
10830
10831 @item H h
10832 @kindex H h (Summary)
10833 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10834 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10835 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10836
10837 @item H i
10838 @kindex H i (Summary)
10839 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10840 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10841 @end table
10842
10843
10844 @node Searching for Articles
10845 @subsection Searching for Articles
10846
10847 @table @kbd
10848
10849 @item M-s
10850 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10851 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10852 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10853 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10854
10855 @item M-r
10856 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10857 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10858 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10859 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10860
10861 @item M-S
10862 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10863 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10864 Repeat the previous search forwards
10865 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10866
10867 @item M-R
10868 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10869 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10870 Repeat the previous search backwards
10871 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10872
10873 @item &
10874 @kindex & (Summary)
10875 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10876 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10877 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10878 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10879 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10880 search backward instead.
10881
10882 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10883 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10884
10885 @item M-&
10886 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10887 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10888 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10889 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10890 @end table
10891
10892 @node Summary Generation Commands
10893 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10894
10895 @table @kbd
10896
10897 @item Y g
10898 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10899 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10900 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10901
10902 @item Y c
10903 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10904 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10905 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10906 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10907
10908 @item Y d
10909 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10910 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10911 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10912 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10913
10914 @item Y t
10915 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10916 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10917 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10918 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10919
10920 @end table
10921
10922
10923 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10924 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10925
10926 @table @kbd
10927
10928 @item A D
10929 @itemx C-d
10930 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10931 @kindex A D (Summary)
10932 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10933 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10934 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10935 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10936 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10937 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10938 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10939 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10940 fashion.
10941
10942 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10943 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10944 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10945 include:
10946
10947 @table @code
10948 @item next
10949 Select the next article.
10950
10951 @item next-unread
10952 Select the next unread article.
10953
10954 @item next-noselect
10955 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10956
10957 @item next-unread-noselect
10958 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10959 @end table
10960
10961 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10962 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10963
10964 @item C-M-d
10965 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10966 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10967 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10968 several documents into one biiig group
10969 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10970 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10971 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10972 command understands the process/prefix convention
10973 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10974
10975 @item C-t
10976 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10977 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10978 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10979 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10980 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10981 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10982
10983 @item =
10984 @kindex = (Summary)
10985 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10986 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10987 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10988
10989 @item C-M-e
10990 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10991 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10992 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10993 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10994
10995 @item C-M-a
10996 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10997 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10998 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10999 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11000
11001 @end table
11002
11003
11004 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11005 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11006 @cindex summary exit
11007 @cindex exiting groups
11008
11009 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11010 group and return you to the group buffer.
11011
11012 @table @kbd
11013
11014 @item Z Z
11015 @itemx Z Q
11016 @itemx q
11017 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11018 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11019 @kindex q (Summary)
11020 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11021 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11022 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11023 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11024 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11025 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11026 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11027 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11028 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11029 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11030 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11031 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11032
11033 @item Z E
11034 @itemx Q
11035 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11036 @kindex Q (Summary)
11037 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11038 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11039 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11040
11041 @item Z c
11042 @itemx c
11043 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11044 @kindex c (Summary)
11045 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11046 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11047 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11048 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11049
11050 @item Z C
11051 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11052 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11053 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11054 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11055
11056 @item Z n
11057 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11058 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11059 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11060 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11061
11062 @item Z p
11063 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11064 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11065 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11066 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11067
11068 @item Z R
11069 @itemx C-x C-s
11070 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11071 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11072 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11073 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11074 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11075 all articles, both read and unread.
11076
11077 @item Z G
11078 @itemx M-g
11079 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11080 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11081 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11082 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11083 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11084 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11085 articles, both read and unread.
11086
11087 @item Z N
11088 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11089 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11090 Exit the group and go to the next group
11091 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11092
11093 @item Z P
11094 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11095 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11096 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11097 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11098
11099 @item Z s
11100 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11101 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11102 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11103 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11104 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11105 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11106 @end table
11107
11108 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11109 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11110 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11111 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11112
11113 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11114 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11115 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11116 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11117 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11118 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11119 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11120 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11121 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11122 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11123 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11124 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11125
11126 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11127
11128 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11129 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11130 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11131 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11132 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11133 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11134 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11135 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11136 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11137
11138
11139 @node Crosspost Handling
11140 @section Crosspost Handling
11141
11142 @cindex velveeta
11143 @cindex spamming
11144 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11145 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11146 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11147 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11148 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11149 heinous crime.
11150
11151 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11152 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11153 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11154 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11155 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11156
11157 @cindex cross-posting
11158 @cindex Xref
11159 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11160 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11161 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11162 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11163 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11164 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11165 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11166 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11167 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11168 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11169 the cross reference mechanism.
11170
11171 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11172 @cindex overview.fmt
11173 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11174 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11175 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11176 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11177 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11178 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11179 overview files.
11180
11181 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11182 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11183 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11184
11185 C'est la vie.
11186
11187 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11188
11189
11190 @node Duplicate Suppression
11191 @section Duplicate Suppression
11192
11193 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11194 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11195 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11196 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11197 reasons.
11198
11199 @enumerate
11200 @item
11201 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11202 is evil and not very common.
11203
11204 @item
11205 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11206 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11207
11208 @item
11209 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11210 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11211
11212 @item
11213 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11214 @end enumerate
11215
11216 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11217 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11218
11219 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11220 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11221 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11222 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11223 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11224 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11225 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11226 once.
11227
11228 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11229 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11230 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11231 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11232 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11233 saw the article in.
11234
11235 @table @code
11236 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11237 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11238 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11239
11240 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11241 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11242 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11243 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11244 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11245 session are suppressed.
11246
11247 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11248 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11249 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11250 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11251
11252 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11253 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11254 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11255 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11256 @end table
11257
11258 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11259 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11260 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11261 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11262 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11263 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11264 to you to figure out, I think.
11265
11266 @node Security
11267 @section Security
11268
11269 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11270 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11271 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11272 things to work:
11273
11274 @enumerate
11275 @item
11276 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11277 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11278 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11279 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11280 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11281
11282 @item
11283 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11284 or newer is recommended.
11285
11286 @end enumerate
11287
11288 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11289 messages include:
11290
11291 @table @code
11292 @item mm-verify-option
11293 @vindex mm-verify-option
11294 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11295 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11296 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11297
11298 @item mm-decrypt-option
11299 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11300 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11301 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11302 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11303
11304 @item mm-sign-option
11305 @vindex mm-sign-option
11306 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11307 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11308
11309 @item mm-encrypt-option
11310 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11311 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11312 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11313 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11314
11315 @item mml1991-use
11316 @vindex mml1991-use
11317 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11318 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11319 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11320 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11321 this order.
11322
11323 @item mml2015-use
11324 @vindex mml2015-use
11325 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11326 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11327 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11328 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11329 interface in this order.
11330
11331 @end table
11332
11333 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11334 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11335 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11336 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11337 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11338 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11339 how to customize these variables to always display security
11340 information.
11341
11342 @cindex snarfing keys
11343 @cindex importing PGP keys
11344 @cindex PGP key ring import
11345 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11346 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11347 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11348 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11349 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11350 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11351 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11352 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11353 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11354
11355 @example
11356 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11357 @end example
11358 @noindent
11359 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11360 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11361
11362 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11363 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11364 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11365
11366 @node Mailing List
11367 @section Mailing List
11368 @cindex mailing list
11369 @cindex RFC 2396
11370
11371 @kindex A M (summary)
11372 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11373 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11374 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11375 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11376 summary buffer.
11377
11378 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11379
11380 @table @kbd
11381
11382 @item C-c C-n h
11383 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11384 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11385 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11386
11387 @item C-c C-n s
11388 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11389 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11390 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11391
11392 @item C-c C-n u
11393 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11394 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11395 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11396 field exists.
11397
11398 @item C-c C-n p
11399 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11400 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11401 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11402
11403 @item C-c C-n o
11404 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11405 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11406 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11407
11408 @item C-c C-n a
11409 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11410 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11411 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11412
11413 @end table
11414
11415
11416 @node Article Buffer
11417 @chapter Article Buffer
11418 @cindex article buffer
11419
11420 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11421 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11422 tell Gnus otherwise.
11423
11424 @menu
11425 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11426 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11427 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11428 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11429 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11430 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11431 @end menu
11432
11433
11434 @node Hiding Headers
11435 @section Hiding Headers
11436 @cindex hiding headers
11437 @cindex deleting headers
11438
11439 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11440 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11441
11442 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11443 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11444 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11445 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11446 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11447 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11448 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11449 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11450 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11451
11452 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11453
11454 @table @code
11455
11456 @item gnus-visible-headers
11457 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11458 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11459 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11460 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11461
11462 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11463 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11464
11465 @lisp
11466 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11467 @end lisp
11468
11469 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11470 remain visible.
11471
11472 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11473 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11474 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11475 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11476 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11477 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11478
11479 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11480 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11481
11482 @lisp
11483 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11484 @end lisp
11485
11486 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11487 be removed.
11488
11489 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11490 variable will have no effect.
11491
11492 @end table
11493
11494 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11495 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11496 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11497 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11498 the headers are to be displayed.
11499
11500 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11501 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11502
11503 @lisp
11504 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11505 @end lisp
11506
11507 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11508 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11509
11510 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11511 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11512 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11513 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11514 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11515 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11516 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11517 from sight.
11518
11519 These conditions are:
11520 @table @code
11521 @item empty
11522 Remove all empty headers.
11523 @item followup-to
11524 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11525 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11526 @item reply-to
11527 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11528 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11529 parameter is set.
11530 @item newsgroups
11531 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11532 name.
11533 @item to-address
11534 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11535 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11536 @item to-list
11537 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11538 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11539 @item cc-list
11540 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11541 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11542 @item date
11543 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11544 old.
11545 @item long-to
11546 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11547 @item many-to
11548 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11552
11553 @lisp
11554 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11555 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11556 @end lisp
11557
11558 This is also the default value for this variable.
11559
11560
11561 @node Using MIME
11562 @section Using MIME
11563 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11564
11565 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11566 while people stand around yawning.
11567
11568 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11569 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11570
11571 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11572 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11573 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11574
11575 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11576 @findex gnus-display-mime
11577 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11578 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11579 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11580 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11581
11582 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11583 @acronym{MIME} button:
11584
11585 @table @kbd
11586 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11587 @item RET (Article)
11588 @kindex RET (Article)
11589 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11590 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11591 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11592 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11593 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11594 object is displayed inline.
11595
11596 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11597 @item M-RET (Article)
11598 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11599 @itemx v (Article)
11600 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11601 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11602
11603 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11604 @item t (Article)
11605 @kindex t (Article)
11606 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11607 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11608
11609 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11610 @item C (Article)
11611 @kindex C (Article)
11612 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11613 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11614
11615 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11616 @item o (Article)
11617 @kindex o (Article)
11618 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11619 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11620
11621 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11622 @item C-o (Article)
11623 @kindex C-o (Article)
11624 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11625 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11626 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11627 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11628 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11629 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11630
11631 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11632 @item r (Article)
11633 @kindex r (Article)
11634 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11635 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11636 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11637
11638 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11639 @item d (Article)
11640 @kindex d (Article)
11641 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11642 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11643 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11644
11645 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11646
11647 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11648 @item c (Article)
11649 @kindex c (Article)
11650 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11651 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11652 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11653 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11654 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11655 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11656 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11657 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11658
11659 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11660 @item p (Article)
11661 @kindex p (Article)
11662 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11663 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11664 @file{.mailcap} file.
11665
11666 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11667 @item i (Article)
11668 @kindex i (Article)
11669 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11670 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11671 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11672 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11673 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11674 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11675 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11676 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11677 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11678
11679 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11680 @item E (Article)
11681 @kindex E (Article)
11682 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11683 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11684 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11685
11686 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11687 @item e (Article)
11688 @kindex e (Article)
11689 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11690 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11691
11692 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11693 @item | (Article)
11694 @kindex | (Article)
11695 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11696
11697 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11698 @item . (Article)
11699 @kindex . (Article)
11700 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11701 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11702
11703 @end table
11704
11705 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11706 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11707 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11708
11709 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11710 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11711 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11712 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11713 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11714 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11715 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11716 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11717 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11718
11719 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11720
11721 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11722
11723
11724 @node HTML
11725 @section @acronym{HTML}
11726 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11727
11728 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11729 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11730 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11731 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11732
11733 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11734 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11735 section only describes the default method.
11736
11737 @table @code
11738 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11739 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11740 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11741 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11742
11743 @item gnus-blocked-images
11744 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11745 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11746 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11747 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11748
11749 @lisp
11750 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11751 @end lisp
11752
11753 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11754 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11755 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11756 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11757 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11758 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11759
11760 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11761
11762 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11763 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11764 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11765 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11766 this directory.
11767
11768 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11769 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11770 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11771 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11772
11773 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11774 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11775 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11776
11777 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11778 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11779 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11780 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11781 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11782 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11783 fit these criteria.
11784
11785 @end table
11786
11787 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11788 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11789 automatically.
11790
11791
11792
11793 @node Customizing Articles
11794 @section Customizing Articles
11795 @cindex article customization
11796
11797 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11798 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11799 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11800 called automatically when you select the articles.
11801
11802 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11803 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11804 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11805 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11806
11807 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11808 for sensible values.
11809
11810 @enumerate
11811 @item
11812 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11813
11814 @item
11815 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11816
11817 @item
11818 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11819
11820 @item
11821 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11822
11823 @item
11824 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11825
11826 @item
11827 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11828 than this number.
11829
11830 @item
11831 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11832 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11833 regexps in the list.
11834
11835 @item
11836 A list where the first element is not a string:
11837
11838 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11839 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11840 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11841
11842 @lisp
11843 (or last
11844 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11845 @end lisp
11846
11847 @end enumerate
11848
11849 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11850 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11851 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11852 considered to contain just a single part.
11853
11854 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11855 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11856 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11857 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11858 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11859 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11860 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11861
11862 @ifinfo
11863 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11864 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11865 @c `i foo-bar'.
11866 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11867 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11868 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11869 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11870 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11871 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11872 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11873 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11874 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11875 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11876 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11877 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11878 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11907 @end ifinfo
11908
11909 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11910 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11911 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11912 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11913
11914 @table @code
11915 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11916 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11917
11918 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11919
11920 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11921 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11922 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11923 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11924 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11925 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11926 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11927 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11928 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11930
11931 @xref{Article Washing}.
11932
11933 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11934
11935 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11936 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11937 headers to display. The formats available are:
11938
11939 @table @code
11940 @item ut
11941 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11942
11943 @item local
11944 The user's local time zone.
11945
11946 @item english
11947 A semi-readable English sentence.
11948
11949 @item lapsed
11950 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11951
11952 @item combined-lapsed
11953 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11954
11955 @item original
11956 The original date header.
11957
11958 @item iso8601
11959 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11960
11961 @item user-defined
11962 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11963 variable.
11964
11965 @end table
11966
11967 @xref{Article Date}.
11968
11969 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11970 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11971 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11972
11973 @xref{Picons}.
11974
11975 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11976 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11977
11978 @xref{Gravatars}.
11979
11980 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11981
11982 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11983
11984 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11985 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11986 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11987
11988 @xref{Smileys}.
11989
11990 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11991 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11992
11993 @xref{X-Face}.
11994
11995 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11996 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11997
11998 @xref{Face}.
11999
12000 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12001 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12002 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12003 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12004 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12005 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12006 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12007 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12008 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12009 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12010 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12011 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12012 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12013 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12014 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12015 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12016 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12017 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12018 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12019 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12020
12021 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12022
12023 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12024 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12025 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12026 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12027 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12028 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12029
12030 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12031
12032 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12033 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12034 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12035 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12036 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12037
12038 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12039 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12040 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12041 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12042 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12043 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12044 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12045 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12046
12047 @xref{Article Header}.
12048
12049
12050 @end table
12051
12052 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12053 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12054 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12055 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12056 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12057 everything.
12058
12059
12060 @node Article Keymap
12061 @section Article Keymap
12062
12063 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12064 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12065 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12066 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12067 buffer.
12068
12069 @kindex v (Article)
12070 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12071 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12072 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12073
12074 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12075
12076 @table @kbd
12077
12078 @item SPACE
12079 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12080 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12081 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12082 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12083
12084 @item DEL
12085 @kindex DEL (Article)
12086 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12087 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12088 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12089
12090 @item C-c ^
12091 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12092 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12093 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12094 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12095 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12096
12097 @item C-c C-m
12098 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12099 @findex gnus-article-mail
12100 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12101 given a prefix, include the mail.
12102
12103 @item s
12104 @kindex s (Article)
12105 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12106 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12107 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12108
12109 @item ?
12110 @kindex ? (Article)
12111 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12112 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12113 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12114
12115 @item TAB
12116 @kindex TAB (Article)
12117 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12118 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12119 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12120
12121 @item M-TAB
12122 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12123 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12124 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12125
12126 @item R
12127 @kindex R (Article)
12128 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12129 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12130 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12131 only yank the text in the region.
12132
12133 @item S W
12134 @kindex S W (Article)
12135 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12136 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12137 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12138 active, only yank the text in the region.
12139
12140 @item F
12141 @kindex F (Article)
12142 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12143 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12144 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12145 only yank the text in the region.
12146
12147
12148 @end table
12149
12150
12151 @node Misc Article
12152 @section Misc Article
12153
12154 @table @code
12155
12156 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12157 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12158 @cindex article buffers, several
12159 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12160 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12161 article buffer.
12162
12163 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12164 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12165 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12166 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12167
12168 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12169 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12170 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12171 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12172 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12173
12174 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12175 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12176 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12177 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12178 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12179 the contents of the article buffer.
12180
12181 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12182 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12183 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12184
12185 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12186 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12187 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12188 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12189
12190 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12191 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12192 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12193 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12194
12195 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12196 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12197 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12198 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12199 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12200 with two extensions:
12201
12202 @table @samp
12203
12204 @item w
12205 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12206 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12207 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12208
12209 @table @samp
12210
12211 @item c
12212 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12213
12214 @item h
12215 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12216
12217 @item p
12218 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12219 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12220 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12221
12222 @item s
12223 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12224
12225 @item o
12226 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12227
12228 @item e
12229 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12230
12231 @end table
12232
12233 @item m
12234 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12235
12236 @end table
12237
12238 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12239
12240 @item gnus-break-pages
12241 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12242 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12243 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12244 paging will not be done.
12245
12246 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12247 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12248 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12249 (formfeed).
12250
12251 @cindex IDNA
12252 @cindex internationalized domain names
12253 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12254 @item gnus-use-idna
12255 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12256 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12257 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12258 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12259 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12260 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12261
12262 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12263 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12264 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12265 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12266 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12267 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12268 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12269 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12270
12271 @end table
12272
12273
12274 @node Composing Messages
12275 @chapter Composing Messages
12276 @cindex composing messages
12277 @cindex messages
12278 @cindex mail
12279 @cindex sending mail
12280 @cindex reply
12281 @cindex followup
12282 @cindex post
12283 @cindex using gpg
12284 @cindex using s/mime
12285 @cindex using smime
12286
12287 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12288 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12289 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12290 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12291 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12292 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12293
12294 @menu
12295 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12296 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12297 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12298 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12299 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12300 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12301 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12302 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12303 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12304 @end menu
12305
12306 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12307 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12308
12309
12310 @node Mail
12311 @section Mail
12312
12313 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12314
12315 @table @code
12316 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12317 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12318 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12319 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12320 @code{nil} include all headers.
12321
12322 @item gnus-add-to-list
12323 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12324 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12325 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12326
12327 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12328 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12329 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12330 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12331 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12332 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12333 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12334 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12335
12336 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12337 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12338
12339 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12340 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12341 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12342 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12343 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12344
12345 @end table
12346
12347
12348 @node Posting Server
12349 @section Posting Server
12350
12351 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12352 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12353
12354 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12355
12356 It can be quite complicated.
12357
12358 @vindex gnus-post-method
12359 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12360 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12361 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12362 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12363 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12364 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12365 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12366 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12367 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12368
12369 @lisp
12370 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12371 @end lisp
12372
12373 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12374 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12375 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12376 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12377
12378 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12379 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12380
12381 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12382 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12383 for posting.
12384
12385 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12386 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12387
12388 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12389 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12390 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12391 value suitable for your system.
12392 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12393 information.
12394
12395
12396 @node POP before SMTP
12397 @section POP before SMTP
12398 @cindex pop before smtp
12399 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12400
12401 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12402 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12403 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12404 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12405
12406 @lisp
12407 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12408 @end lisp
12409
12410 @noindent
12411 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12412 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12413 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12414
12415 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12416 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12417 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12418 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12419 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12420 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12421
12422 @lisp
12423 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12424 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12425 :password "secret"))
12426 @end lisp
12427
12428 @noindent
12429 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12430 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12431
12432 @lisp
12433 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12434 (lambda ()
12435 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12436 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12437 :password "secret")))
12438 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12439 @end lisp
12440
12441
12442 @node Mail and Post
12443 @section Mail and Post
12444
12445 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12446 posting:
12447
12448 @table @code
12449 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12450 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12451 @cindex mailing lists
12452
12453 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12454 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12455 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12456 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12457 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12458 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12459 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12460 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12461 still a pain, though.
12462
12463 @item gnus-user-agent
12464 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12465 @cindex User-Agent
12466
12467 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12468 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12469 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12470 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12471 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12472 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12473 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12474
12475 @end table
12476
12477 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12478 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12479 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12480
12481 @cindex ispell
12482 @findex ispell-message
12483 @lisp
12484 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12485 @end lisp
12486
12487 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12488 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12489
12490 @lisp
12491 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12492 (lambda ()
12493 (cond
12494 ((string-match
12495 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12496 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12497 (t
12498 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12499 @end lisp
12500
12501 Modify to suit your needs.
12502
12503 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12504 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12505 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12506 mode buffers.
12507
12508 @node Archived Messages
12509 @section Archived Messages
12510 @cindex archived messages
12511 @cindex sent messages
12512
12513 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12514 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12515 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12516 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12517 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12518
12519 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12520 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12521 Group Commands}).
12522
12523 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12524 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12525 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12526 actually being used it is expanded into:
12527
12528 @lisp
12529 (nnfolder "archive"
12530 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12531 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12532 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12533 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12534 @end lisp
12535
12536 @quotation
12537 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12538 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12539 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12540 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12541 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12542 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12543 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12544 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12545 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12546 saved method to reflect always the value of
12547 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12548 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12549 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12550 @end quotation
12551
12552 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12553 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12554 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12555 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12556
12557 @lisp
12558 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12559 '(nnfolder "archive"
12560 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12561 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12562 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12563 @end lisp
12564
12565 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12566 @cindex Gcc
12567 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12568 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12569 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12570
12571 This variable can be used to do the following:
12572
12573 @table @asis
12574 @item a string
12575 Messages will be saved in that group.
12576
12577 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12578 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12579 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12580 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12581 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12582 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12583 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12584 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12585 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12586
12587 @item a list of strings
12588 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12589
12590 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12591 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12592
12593 @item @code{nil}
12594 No message archiving will take place.
12595 @end table
12596
12597 Let's illustrate:
12598
12599 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12600 @lisp
12601 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12602 @end lisp
12603
12604 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12605 @lisp
12606 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12607 @end lisp
12608
12609 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12610 @lisp
12611 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12612 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12613 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12614 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12615 @end lisp
12616
12617 More complex stuff:
12618 @lisp
12619 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12620 '((if (message-news-p)
12621 "misc-news"
12622 "misc-mail")))
12623 @end lisp
12624
12625 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12626 messages in one file per month:
12627
12628 @lisp
12629 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12630 '((if (message-news-p)
12631 "misc-news"
12632 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12633 @end lisp
12634
12635 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12636 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12637 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12638 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12639 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12640 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12641 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12642 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12643 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12644 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12645
12646 @table @code
12647 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12648 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12649 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12650
12651 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12652 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12653 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12654 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12655 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12656 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12657 changed in the future.
12658
12659 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12660 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12661 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12662 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12663 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12664 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12665
12666 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12667 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12668 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12669 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12670 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12671 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12672 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12673 except for the current group.
12674
12675 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12676 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12677 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12678 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12679
12680 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12681 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12682 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12683 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12684 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12685 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12686 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12687
12688 @end table
12689
12690
12691 @node Posting Styles
12692 @section Posting Styles
12693 @cindex posting styles
12694 @cindex styles
12695
12696 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12697
12698 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12699 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12700 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12701 on?
12702
12703 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12704 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12705 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12706 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12707 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12708 variable:
12709
12710 @lisp
12711 ((".*"
12712 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12713 (organization "What me?"))
12714 ("^comp"
12715 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12716 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12717 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12718 @end lisp
12719
12720 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12721 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12722 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12723 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12724 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12725 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12726 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12727 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12728
12729 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12730 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12731 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12732 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12733 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12734 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12735 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12736 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12737 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12738 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12739 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12740 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12741 said to @dfn{match}.
12742
12743 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12744 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12745 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12746 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12747 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12748 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12749 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12750 name can be one of:
12751
12752 @itemize @bullet
12753 @item @code{signature}
12754 @item @code{signature-file}
12755 @item @code{x-face-file}
12756 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12757 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12758 @item @code{body}
12759 @end itemize
12760
12761 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12762 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12763
12764 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12765 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12766 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12767 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12768 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12769
12770 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12771 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12772 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12773 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12774 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12775 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12776 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12777 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12778
12779 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12780 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12781 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12782 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12783 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12784
12785 @vindex message-reply-headers
12786
12787 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12788 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12789 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12790
12791 @findex message-mail-p
12792 @findex message-news-p
12793
12794 So here's a new example:
12795
12796 @lisp
12797 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12798 '((".*"
12799 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12800 (name "User Name")
12801 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12802 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12803 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12804 ("^rec.humor"
12805 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12806 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12807 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12808 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12809 (signature my-news-signature))
12810 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12811 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12812 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12813 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12814 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12815 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12816 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12817 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12818 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12819 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12820 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12821 ("nnml:.*"
12822 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12823 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12824 ("^nn.+:"
12825 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12826 @end lisp
12827
12828 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12829 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12830 if you fill many roles.
12831 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12832 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12833
12834 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12835 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12836 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12837 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12838 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12839
12840
12841 @node Drafts
12842 @section Drafts
12843 @cindex drafts
12844
12845 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12846 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12847 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12848 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12849 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12850
12851 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12852 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12853 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12854 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12855 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12856 group.)
12857
12858 @cindex nndraft
12859 @vindex nndraft-directory
12860 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12861 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12862 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12863 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12864 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12865 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12866
12867 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12868 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12869 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12870 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12871 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12872 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12873 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12874 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12875 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12876
12877 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12878 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12879 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12880 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12881 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12882 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12883 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12884 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12885 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12886 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12887 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12888 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12889 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12890 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12891 @c
12892 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12893 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12894 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12895
12896 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12897 @kindex D e (Draft)
12898 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12899 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12900 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12901
12902 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12903 Articles}).
12904
12905 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12906 @kindex D s (Draft)
12907 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12908 @kindex D S (Draft)
12909 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12910 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12911 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12912 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12913 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12914 in the buffer.
12915
12916 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12917 @kindex D t (Draft)
12918 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12919 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12920 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12921
12922 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12923 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12924
12925
12926 @node Rejected Articles
12927 @section Rejected Articles
12928 @cindex rejected articles
12929
12930 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12931 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12932 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12933 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12934
12935 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12936 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12937 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12938 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12939 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12940
12941 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12942 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12943 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12944
12945 @node Signing and encrypting
12946 @section Signing and encrypting
12947 @cindex using gpg
12948 @cindex using s/mime
12949 @cindex using smime
12950
12951 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12952 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12953 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12954 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12955
12956 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12957 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12958 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12959 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12960 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12961 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12962 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12963 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12964 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12965 automatically encrypted messages.
12966
12967 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12968 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12969 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12970
12971 @table @kbd
12972
12973 @item C-c C-m s s
12974 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12975 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12976
12977 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12978
12979 @item C-c C-m s o
12980 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12981 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12982
12983 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12984
12985 @item C-c C-m s p
12986 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12987 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12988
12989 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12990
12991 @item C-c C-m c s
12992 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12993 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12994
12995 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12996
12997 @item C-c C-m c o
12998 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12999 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13000
13001 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13002
13003 @item C-c C-m c p
13004 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13005 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13006
13007 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13008
13009 @item C-c C-m C-n
13010 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13011 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13012 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13013
13014 @end table
13015
13016 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13017
13018 @node Select Methods
13019 @chapter Select Methods
13020 @cindex foreign groups
13021 @cindex select methods
13022
13023 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13024 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13025 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13026 personal mail group.
13027
13028 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13029 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13030 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13031 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13032 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13033 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13034
13035 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13036 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13037
13038 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13039 group as.
13040
13041 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13042 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13043 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13044 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13045 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13046
13047 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13048
13049 @menu
13050 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13051 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13052 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13053 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13054 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13055 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13056 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13057 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13058 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13059 @end menu
13060
13061
13062 @node Server Buffer
13063 @section Server Buffer
13064
13065 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13066 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13067 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13068 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13069 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13070 back end represents a virtual server.
13071
13072 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13073 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13074 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13075 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13076
13077 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13078 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13079 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13080 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13081 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13082 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13083 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13084
13085 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13086 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13087
13088 @menu
13089 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13090 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13091 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13092 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13093 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13094 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13095 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13096 @end menu
13097
13098 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13099 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13100
13101
13102 @node Server Buffer Format
13103 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13104 @cindex server buffer format
13105
13106 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13107 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13108 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13109 variable, with some simple extensions:
13110
13111 @table @samp
13112
13113 @item h
13114 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13115
13116 @item n
13117 The name of this server.
13118
13119 @item w
13120 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13121
13122 @item s
13123 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13124
13125 @item a
13126 Whether this server is agentized.
13127 @end table
13128
13129 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13130 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13131 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13132 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13133
13134 @table @samp
13135 @item S
13136 Server name.
13137
13138 @item M
13139 Server method.
13140 @end table
13141
13142 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13143
13144
13145 @node Server Commands
13146 @subsection Server Commands
13147 @cindex server commands
13148
13149 @table @kbd
13150
13151 @item v
13152 @kindex v (Server)
13153 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13154 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13155 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13156
13157 @item a
13158 @kindex a (Server)
13159 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13160 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13161
13162 @item e
13163 @kindex e (Server)
13164 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13165 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13166
13167 @item S
13168 @kindex S (Server)
13169 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13170 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13171
13172 @item SPACE
13173 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13174 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13175 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13176
13177 @item q
13178 @kindex q (Server)
13179 @findex gnus-server-exit
13180 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13181
13182 @item k
13183 @kindex k (Server)
13184 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13185 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13186
13187 @item y
13188 @kindex y (Server)
13189 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13190 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13191
13192 @item c
13193 @kindex c (Server)
13194 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13195 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13196
13197 @item l
13198 @kindex l (Server)
13199 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13200 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13201
13202 @item s
13203 @kindex s (Server)
13204 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13205 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13206 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13207 servers.
13208
13209 @item g
13210 @kindex g (Server)
13211 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13212 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13213 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13214 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13215
13216 @item z
13217 @kindex z (Server)
13218 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13219
13220 Compact all groups in the server under point
13221 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13222 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13223 hence getting a correct total article count.
13224
13225 @end table
13226
13227 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13228 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13229
13230
13231 @node Example Methods
13232 @subsection Example Methods
13233
13234 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13235
13236 @lisp
13237 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13238 @end lisp
13239
13240 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13241
13242 @lisp
13243 (nnspool "")
13244 @end lisp
13245
13246 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13247 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13248 will.
13249
13250 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13251 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13252
13253 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13254 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13255 look like then:
13256
13257 @lisp
13258 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13259 @end lisp
13260
13261 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13262 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13263
13264 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13265 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13266 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13267 your private mail:
13268
13269 @lisp
13270 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13271 @end lisp
13272
13273 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13274 that.)
13275
13276 Here's the method for a public spool:
13277
13278 @lisp
13279 (nnmh "public"
13280 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13281 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13282 @end lisp
13283
13284 @cindex proxy
13285 @cindex firewall
13286
13287 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13288 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13289 on the firewall machine and connect with
13290 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13291 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13292 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13293 should probably look something like this:
13294
13295 @lisp
13296 (nntp "firewall"
13297 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13298 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13299 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13300 @end lisp
13301
13302 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13303 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13304 configuration to the example above:
13305
13306 @lisp
13307 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13308 @end lisp
13309
13310 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13311 an indirect connection:
13312
13313 @lisp
13314 (setq gnus-select-method
13315 '(nntp "indirect"
13316 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13317 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13318 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13319 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13320 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13321 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13322 @end lisp
13323
13324 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13325 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13326
13327 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13328 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13329 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13330
13331 @lisp
13332 (nntp "outside"
13333 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13334 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13335 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13336 @end lisp
13337
13338
13339 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13340 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13341
13342 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13343 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13344
13345 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13346 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13347 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13348
13349 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13350
13351 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13352 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13353 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13354 will contain the following:
13355
13356 @lisp
13357 (nnml "cache")
13358 @end lisp
13359
13360 Change that to:
13361
13362 @lisp
13363 (nnml "cache"
13364 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13365 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13366 @end lisp
13367
13368 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13369 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13370 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13371
13372
13373 @node Server Variables
13374 @subsection Server Variables
13375 @cindex server variables
13376 @cindex server parameters
13377
13378 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13379 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13380 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13381 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13382 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13383
13384 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13385 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13386 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13387 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13388 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13389 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13390 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13391 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13392 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13393
13394 @lisp
13395 (nnml "public"
13396 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13397 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13398 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13399 @end lisp
13400
13401 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13402
13403 @node Servers and Methods
13404 @subsection Servers and Methods
13405
13406 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13407 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13408 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13409 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13410 over.
13411
13412
13413 @node Unavailable Servers
13414 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13415
13416 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13417 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13418 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13419 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13420 actually the case or not.
13421
13422 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13423 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13424 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13425 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13426 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13427 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13428 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13429 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13430
13431 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13432 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13433
13434 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13435 with the following commands:
13436
13437 @table @kbd
13438
13439 @item O
13440 @kindex O (Server)
13441 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13442 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13443 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13444
13445 @item C
13446 @kindex C (Server)
13447 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13448 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13449 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13450
13451 @item D
13452 @kindex D (Server)
13453 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13454 Mark the current server as unreachable
13455 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13456
13457 @item M-o
13458 @kindex M-o (Server)
13459 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13460 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13461 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13462
13463 @item M-c
13464 @kindex M-c (Server)
13465 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13466 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13467 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13468
13469 @item R
13470 @kindex R (Server)
13471 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13472 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13473 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13474
13475 @item c
13476 @kindex c (Server)
13477 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13478 Copy a server and give it a new name
13479 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13480 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13481 a different (physical) server.
13482
13483 @item L
13484 @kindex L (Server)
13485 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13486 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13487
13488 @end table
13489
13490
13491 @node Getting News
13492 @section Getting News
13493 @cindex reading news
13494 @cindex news back ends
13495
13496 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13497 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13498 or it can read from a local spool.
13499
13500 @menu
13501 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13502 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13503 @end menu
13504
13505
13506 @node NNTP
13507 @subsection NNTP
13508 @cindex nntp
13509
13510 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13511 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13512 server as the, uhm, address.
13513
13514 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13515 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13516 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13517 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13518
13519 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13520 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13521 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13522
13523 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13524 server:
13525
13526 @table @code
13527
13528 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13529 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13530 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13531 @cindex authinfo
13532 @cindex authentication
13533 @cindex nntp authentication
13534 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13535 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13536 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13537 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13538 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13539 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13540 present in this hook.
13541
13542 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13543 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13544 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13545 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13546 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13547 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13548 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13549 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13550 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13551 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13552 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13553 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13554
13555 @enumerate
13556 @item
13557 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13558
13559 @item
13560 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13561
13562 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13563 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13564 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13565 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13566 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13567 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13568 @samp{force} is explained below.
13569
13570 @end enumerate
13571
13572 Here's an example file:
13573
13574 @example
13575 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13576 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13577 @end example
13578
13579 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13580 have to be first, for instance.
13581
13582 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13583 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13584 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13585 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13586 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13587 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13588 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13589
13590 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13591 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13592
13593 @example
13594 default force yes
13595 @end example
13596
13597 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13598 previously mentioned.
13599
13600 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13601
13602 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13603 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13604 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13605 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13606 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13607
13608 @lisp
13609 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13610 '(("innd" (ding))))
13611 @end lisp
13612
13613 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13614
13615 The default value is
13616
13617 @lisp
13618 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13619 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13620 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13621 @end lisp
13622
13623 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13624 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13625
13626 @item nntp-maximum-request
13627 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13628 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13629 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13630 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13631 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13632 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13633 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13634
13635 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13636 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13637 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13638 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13639 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13640 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13641 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13642 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13643 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13644 no timeouts are done.
13645
13646 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13647 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13648 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13649 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13650 can be used.
13651
13652 @item nntp-xover-commands
13653 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13654 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13655 @cindex XOVER
13656 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13657 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13658 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13659
13660 @item nntp-nov-gap
13661 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13662 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13663 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13664 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13665 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13666 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13667 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13668 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13669 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13670 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13671 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13672
13673 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13674 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13675 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13676 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13677 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13678 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13679 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13680 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13681 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13682 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13683 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13684 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13685 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13686 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13687 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13688 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13689 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13690
13691 @lisp
13692 (setq gnus-select-method
13693 '(nntp "newszilla"
13694 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13695 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13696 @dots{}))
13697 @end lisp
13698
13699 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13700
13701 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13702 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13703 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13704
13705 @item nntp-record-commands
13706 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13707 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13708 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13709 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13710 that doesn't seem to work.
13711
13712 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13713 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13714 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13715 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13716 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13717 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13718 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13719 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13720
13721 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13722 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13723 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13724 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13725 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13726 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13727 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13728 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13729 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13730
13731 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13732 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13733 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13734 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13735 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13736 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13737 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13738
13739 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13740 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13741 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13742 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13743 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13744 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13745 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13746
13747 @lisp
13748 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13749 @end lisp
13750
13751 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13752 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13753
13754 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13755 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13756 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13757 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13758
13759
13760 @end table
13761
13762 @menu
13763 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13764 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13765 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13766 @end menu
13767
13768
13769 @node Direct Functions
13770 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13771 @cindex direct connection functions
13772
13773 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13774 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13775 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13776 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13777
13778 @table @code
13779 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13780 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13781 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13782 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13783 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13784 connection automatically.
13785
13786 @item network-only
13787 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13788
13789 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13790 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13791 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13792 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13793 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13794
13795 @lisp
13796 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13797 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13798 ;;
13799 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13800 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13801 (nntp-port-number 563)
13802 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13803 @end lisp
13804
13805 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13806 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13807 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13808 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13809 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13810 then define a server as follows:
13811
13812 @lisp
13813 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13814 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13815 ;;
13816 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13817 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13818 (nntp-port-number 563)
13819 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13820 @end lisp
13821
13822 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13823 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13824 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13825 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13826 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13827 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13828 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13829 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13830
13831 @lisp
13832 (nntp "socksified"
13833 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13834 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13835 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13836 @end lisp
13837
13838 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13839 session, which is not a good idea.
13840
13841 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13842 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13843 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13844 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13845 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13846 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13847
13848 @lisp
13849 (nntp "socksified"
13850 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13851 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13852 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13853 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13854 @end lisp
13855 @end table
13856
13857
13858 @node Indirect Functions
13859 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13860 @cindex indirect connection functions
13861
13862 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13863 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13864 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13865 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13866 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13867 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13868
13869 @table @code
13870 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13871 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13872 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13873 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13874 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13875
13876 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13877
13878 @table @code
13879 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13880 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13881 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13882 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13883
13884 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13885 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13886 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13887 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13888 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13889 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13890 @end table
13891
13892 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13893 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13894 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13895 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13896 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13897 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13898
13899 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13900
13901 @table @code
13902 @item nntp-telnet-command
13903 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13904 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13905 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13906
13907 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13908 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13909 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13910 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13911
13912 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13913 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13914 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13915 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13916
13917 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13918 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13919 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13920 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13921 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13922 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13923 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13924 @end table
13925
13926 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13927 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13928
13929 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13930 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13931 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13932 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13933
13934 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13935
13936 @table @code
13937 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13938 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13939 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13940 @samp{telnet}.
13941
13942 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13943 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13944 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13945 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13946
13947 @item nntp-via-user-password
13948 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13949 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13950
13951 @item nntp-via-envuser
13952 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13953 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13954 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13955 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13956
13957 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13958 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13959 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13960 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13961
13962 @end table
13963
13964 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13965 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13966 @end table
13967
13968
13969 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13970 functions:
13971
13972 @table @code
13973
13974 @item nntp-via-user-name
13975 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13976 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13977
13978 @item nntp-via-address
13979 @vindex nntp-via-address
13980 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13981
13982 @end table
13983
13984
13985 @node Common Variables
13986 @subsubsection Common Variables
13987
13988 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13989 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13990 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13991 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13992 variables individually).
13993
13994 @table @code
13995
13996 @item nntp-pre-command
13997 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13998 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13999 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14000 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14001 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14002
14003 @item nntp-address
14004 @vindex nntp-address
14005 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14006
14007 @item nntp-port-number
14008 @vindex nntp-port-number
14009 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14010 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14011 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14012 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14013 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14014 not work with named ports.
14015
14016 @item nntp-end-of-line
14017 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14018 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14019 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14020 using a non native telnet connection function.
14021
14022 @item nntp-netcat-command
14023 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14024 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14025 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14026 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14027 @samp{nc}.
14028
14029 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14030 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14031 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14032 is @samp{()}.
14033
14034 @end table
14035
14036 @node News Spool
14037 @subsection News Spool
14038 @cindex nnspool
14039 @cindex news spool
14040
14041 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14042 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14043 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14044 instance.
14045
14046 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14047 anything else) as the address.
14048
14049 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14050 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14051 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14052 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14053
14054 @table @code
14055
14056 @item nnspool-inews-program
14057 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14058 Program used to post an article.
14059
14060 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14061 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14062 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14063
14064 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14065 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14066 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14067 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14068
14069 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14070 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14071 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14072 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14073
14074 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14075 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14076 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14077
14078 @item nnspool-active-file
14079 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14080 The name of the active file.
14081
14082 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14083 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14084 The name of the group descriptions file.
14085
14086 @item nnspool-history-file
14087 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14088 The name of the news history file.
14089
14090 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14091 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14092 The name of the active date file.
14093
14094 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14095 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14096 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14097 that it finds.
14098
14099 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14100 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14101 @cindex sed
14102 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14103 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14104 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14105 there.
14106
14107 @end table
14108
14109
14110 @node Using IMAP
14111 @section Using IMAP
14112 @cindex imap
14113
14114 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14115 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14116 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14117 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14118 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14119
14120 @menu
14121 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14122 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14123 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14124 @end menu
14125
14126
14127 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14128 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14129
14130 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14131 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14132 something like:
14133
14134 @example
14135 (setq gnus-select-method
14136 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14137 @end example
14138
14139 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14140 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14141
14142 @example
14143 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14144 @end example
14145
14146 That should basically be it for most users.
14147
14148
14149 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14150 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14151
14152 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14153
14154 @example
14155 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14156 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14157 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14158 (nnimap-expunge t)
14159 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14160 @end example
14161
14162 @table @code
14163 @item nnimap-address
14164 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14165
14166 @item nnimap-server-port
14167 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14168 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14169
14170 @item nnimap-stream
14171 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14172
14173 @table @code
14174 @item undecided
14175 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14176 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14177
14178 @item ssl
14179 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14180
14181 @item network
14182 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14183 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14184 supports it.
14185
14186 @item starttls
14187 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14188
14189 @item shell
14190 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14191 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14192 what you need.
14193
14194 @end table
14195
14196 @item nnimap-authenticator
14197 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14198 this should be set to @code{anonymous}.
14199
14200 @item nnimap-expunge
14201 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14202 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14203 servers that doesn't support that command.
14204
14205 @item nnimap-streaming
14206 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14207 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14208 @code{nil}.
14209
14210 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14211 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14212 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14213 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14214 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14215
14216 @item nnimap-record-commands
14217 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14218 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14219
14220 @end table
14221
14222
14223 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14224 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14225
14226 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14227 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14228 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14229
14230 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14231 variables are relevant:
14232
14233 @table @code
14234 @item nnimap-inbox
14235 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14236
14237 @item nnimap-split-methods
14238 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14239 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14240 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14241
14242 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14243 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14244
14245 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14246 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14247 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14248 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14249
14250 @end table
14251
14252 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14253 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14254
14255 @example
14256 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14257 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14258 (nnimap-split-methods
14259 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14260 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14261 "undecided")))
14262 @end example
14263
14264
14265 @node Getting Mail
14266 @section Getting Mail
14267 @cindex reading mail
14268 @cindex mail
14269
14270 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14271 course.
14272
14273 @menu
14274 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14275 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14276 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14277 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14278 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14279 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14280 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14281 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14282 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14283 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14284 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14285 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14286 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14287 @end menu
14288
14289
14290 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14291 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14292
14293 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14294 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14295 of a culture shock.
14296
14297 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14298 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14299
14300 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14301 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14302 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14303 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14304
14305 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14306
14307 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14308 deleted? How awful!
14309
14310 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14311 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14312 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14313 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14314 Mail}.
14315
14316 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14317 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14318 they want to treat a message.
14319
14320 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14321 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14322 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14323 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14324 archived somewhere else.
14325
14326 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14327 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14328 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14329 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14330 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14331
14332 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14333 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14334 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14335
14336 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14337 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14338 differently.
14339
14340 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14341 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14342 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14343 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14344 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14345
14346 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14347 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14348 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14349 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14350 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14351 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14352 You Do.)
14353
14354
14355 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14356 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14357
14358 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14359 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14360 and things will happen automatically.
14361
14362 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14363 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14364
14365 @lisp
14366 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14367 @end lisp
14368
14369 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14370 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14371 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14372 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14373 like any other group.
14374
14375 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14376
14377 @lisp
14378 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14379 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14380 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14381 ("other" "")))
14382 @end lisp
14383
14384 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14385 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14386 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14387 last group.
14388
14389 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14390 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14391 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14392
14393
14394 @node Splitting Mail
14395 @subsection Splitting Mail
14396 @cindex splitting mail
14397 @cindex mail splitting
14398 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14399
14400 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14401 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14402 to be split into groups.
14403
14404 @lisp
14405 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14406 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14407 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14408 ("mail.other" "")))
14409 @end lisp
14410
14411 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14412 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14413 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14414 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14415 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14416 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14417 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14418
14419 @lisp
14420 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14421 @end lisp
14422
14423 @noindent
14424 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14425 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14426
14427 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14428 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14429 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14430 mail belongs in that group.
14431
14432 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14433 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14434 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14435 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14436 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14437 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14438 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14439 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14440 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14441 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14442
14443 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14444 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14445 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14446 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14447 thinks should carry this mail message.
14448
14449 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14450 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14451
14452 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14453 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14454 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14455 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14456
14457 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14458 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14459 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14460 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14461 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14462
14463 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14464 @cindex crosspost
14465 @cindex links
14466 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14467 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14468 links. If that's the case for you, set
14469 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14470 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14471
14472 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14473 @findex nnmail-split-history
14474 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14475 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14476 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14477 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14478 Group Commands}).
14479
14480 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14481 Header lines longer than the value of
14482 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14483 function.
14484
14485 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14486 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14487 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14488 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14489 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14490 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14491 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14492 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14493 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14494 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14495 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14496 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14497
14498 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14499 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14500 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14501 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14502 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14503 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14504 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14505 other kinds of entries.)
14506
14507 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14508 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14509 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14510 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14511 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14512 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14513 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14514 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14515 month's rent money.
14516
14517
14518 @node Mail Sources
14519 @subsection Mail Sources
14520
14521 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14522 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14523 maildir, for instance.
14524
14525 @menu
14526 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14527 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14528 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14529 @end menu
14530
14531
14532 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14533 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14534 @cindex POP
14535 @cindex mail server
14536 @cindex procmail
14537 @cindex mail spool
14538 @cindex mail source
14539
14540 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14541 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14542
14543 Here's an example:
14544
14545 @lisp
14546 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14547 @end lisp
14548
14549 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14550 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14551 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14552 default values.
14553
14554 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14555 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14556 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14557 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14558 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14559 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14560 group might look like this:
14561
14562 @lisp
14563 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14564 @end lisp
14565
14566 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14567 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14568
14569 The following mail source types are available:
14570
14571 @table @code
14572 @item file
14573 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14574
14575 Keywords:
14576
14577 @table @code
14578 @item :path
14579 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14580 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14581 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14582
14583 @item :prescript
14584 @itemx :postscript
14585 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14586 @end table
14587
14588 An example file mail source:
14589
14590 @lisp
14591 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14592 @end lisp
14593
14594 Or using the default file name:
14595
14596 @lisp
14597 (file)
14598 @end lisp
14599
14600 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14601 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14602 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14603 mail spool while moving the mail.
14604
14605 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14606
14607 @lisp
14608 (setq mail-sources
14609 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14610 @end lisp
14611
14612 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14613
14614 @example
14615 #!/bin/sh
14616 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14617 # flu@@iki.fi
14618
14619 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14620 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14621 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14622 @end example
14623
14624 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14625 file you want to use.
14626
14627
14628 @item directory
14629 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14630 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14631 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14632 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14633 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14634 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14635 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14636 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14637 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14638 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14639
14640 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14641 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14642 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14643 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14644
14645 Keywords:
14646
14647 @table @code
14648 @item :path
14649 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14650 value.
14651
14652 @item :suffix
14653 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14654 @samp{.spool}.
14655
14656 @item :predicate
14657 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14658 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14659 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14660 predicate are considered.
14661
14662 @item :prescript
14663 @itemx :postscript
14664 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14665
14666 @end table
14667
14668 An example directory mail source:
14669
14670 @lisp
14671 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14672 :suffix ".prcml")
14673 @end lisp
14674
14675 @item pop
14676 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14677
14678 Keywords:
14679
14680 @table @code
14681 @item :server
14682 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14683 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14684
14685 @item :port
14686 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14687 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14688 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14689 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14690 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14691
14692 @item :user
14693 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14694 name.
14695
14696 @item :password
14697 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14698 the user is prompted.
14699
14700 @item :program
14701 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14702 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14703
14704 @example
14705 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14706 @end example
14707
14708 The valid format specifier characters are:
14709
14710 @table @samp
14711 @item t
14712 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14713 included in this string.
14714
14715 @item s
14716 The name of the server.
14717
14718 @item P
14719 The port number of the server.
14720
14721 @item u
14722 The user name to use.
14723
14724 @item p
14725 The password to use.
14726 @end table
14727
14728 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14729 corresponding keywords.
14730
14731 @item :prescript
14732 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14733 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14734
14735 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14736 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14737
14738 @lisp
14739 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14740 :port 1234
14741 :user "foo"
14742 :password "secret"
14743 :prescript
14744 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14745 @end lisp
14746
14747 @item :postscript
14748 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14749 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14750
14751 @item :function
14752 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14753 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14754 mail should be moved to.
14755
14756 @item :authentication
14757 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14758 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14759 @code{password}.
14760
14761 @end table
14762
14763 @vindex pop3-movemail
14764 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14765 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14766 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
14767 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14768 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
14769 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
14770 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
14771 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
14772 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
14773
14774 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14775 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14776 name, and default fetcher:
14777
14778 @lisp
14779 (pop)
14780 @end lisp
14781
14782 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14783
14784 @lisp
14785 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14786 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14787 @end lisp
14788
14789 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14790
14791 @lisp
14792 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14793 @end lisp
14794
14795 @item maildir
14796 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14797 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14798 contains exactly one mail.
14799
14800 Keywords:
14801
14802 @table @code
14803 @item :path
14804 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14805 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14806 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14807 @item :subdirs
14808 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14809 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14810
14811 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14812 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14813 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14814 @c below.
14815
14816 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14817 from locking problems).
14818
14819 @end table
14820
14821 Two example maildir mail sources:
14822
14823 @lisp
14824 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14825 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14826 @end lisp
14827
14828 @lisp
14829 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14830 :subdirs ("new"))
14831 @end lisp
14832
14833 @item imap
14834 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14835 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14836 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14837 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14838 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14839
14840 Keywords:
14841
14842 @table @code
14843 @item :server
14844 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14845 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14846
14847 @item :port
14848 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14849 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14850
14851 @item :user
14852 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14853 name.
14854
14855 @item :password
14856 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14857 prompted.
14858
14859 @item :stream
14860 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14861 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14862 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14863 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14864
14865 @item :authentication
14866 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14867 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14868 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14869 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14870
14871 @item :program
14872 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14873 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14874 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14875
14876 @example
14877 ssh %s imapd
14878 @end example
14879
14880 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14881 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14882 specifier characters are:
14883
14884 @table @samp
14885 @item s
14886 The name of the server.
14887
14888 @item l
14889 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14890
14891 @item p
14892 The port number of the server.
14893 @end table
14894
14895 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14896 corresponding keywords.
14897
14898 @item :mailbox
14899 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14900 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14901
14902 @item :predicate
14903 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14904 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14905 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14906 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14907 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14908 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14909
14910 @item :fetchflag
14911 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14912 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14913 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14914 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14915
14916 @item :dontexpunge
14917 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14918 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14919
14920 @end table
14921
14922 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14923
14924 @lisp
14925 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14926 :stream kerberos4
14927 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14928 @end lisp
14929
14930 @item group
14931 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14932 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14933
14934 @end table
14935
14936 @table @dfn
14937 @item Common Keywords
14938 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14939
14940 Keywords:
14941
14942 @table @code
14943 @item :plugged
14944 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14945 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14946 example:
14947
14948 @lisp
14949 (setq mail-sources
14950 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14951 :suffix ""
14952 :plugged t)))
14953 @end lisp
14954
14955 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14956 useful when you use local mail and news.
14957
14958 @end table
14959 @end table
14960
14961 @subsubsection Function Interface
14962
14963 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14964 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14965 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14966 consider the following mail-source setting:
14967
14968 @lisp
14969 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14970 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14971 @end lisp
14972
14973 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14974 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14975 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14976 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14977 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14978
14979 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14980
14981
14982 @node Mail Source Customization
14983 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14984
14985 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14986 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14987 variables.
14988
14989 @table @code
14990 @item mail-source-crash-box
14991 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
14992 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14993 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14994
14995 @cindex Incoming*
14996 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
14997 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
14998 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
14999 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15000 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15001 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15002 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15003 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15004 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15005 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15006
15007 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15008 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15009 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15010 files. This variable only applies when
15011 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15012
15013 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15014 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15015 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15016
15017 @item mail-source-directory
15018 @vindex mail-source-directory
15019 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15020 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15021 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15022 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15023
15024 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15025 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15026 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15027 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15028 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15029 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15030 number.
15031
15032 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15033 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15034 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15035
15036 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15037 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15038 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15039 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15040
15041 @end table
15042
15043
15044 @node Fetching Mail
15045 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15046
15047 @vindex mail-sources
15048 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15049 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15050 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15051
15052 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15053 fetch mail by themselves.
15054
15055 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15056 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15057
15058 @lisp
15059 (setq mail-sources
15060 '((file)
15061 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15062 :password "secret")))
15063 @end lisp
15064
15065 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15066
15067 @lisp
15068 (setq mail-sources
15069 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15070 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15071 :user "user-name"
15072 :port "pop3"
15073 :password "secret")))
15074 @end lisp
15075
15076
15077 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15078 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15079 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15080 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15081 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15082 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15083
15084
15085
15086 @node Mail Back End Variables
15087 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15088
15089 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15090 mail back ends.
15091
15092 @table @code
15093 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15094 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15095 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15096 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15097
15098 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15099 @item nnmail-split-hook
15100 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15101 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15102 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15103 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15104 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15105 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15106 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15107 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15108 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15109 to this hook.
15110
15111 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15112 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15113 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15114 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15115 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15116 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15117 starting to handle the new mail) and
15118 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15119 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15120 default file modes the new mail files get:
15121
15122 @lisp
15123 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15124 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15125
15126 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15127 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15128 @end lisp
15129
15130 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15131 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15132 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15133 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15134 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15135 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15136 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15137
15138 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15139 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15140 @findex delete-file
15141 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15142
15143 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15144 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15145 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15146 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15147 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15148
15149 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15150 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15151 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15152 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15153 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15154
15155 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15156 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15157 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15158
15159 @end table
15160
15161
15162 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15163 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15164 @cindex mail splitting
15165 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15166
15167 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15168 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15169 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15170 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15171 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15172 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15173
15174 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15175
15176 @lisp
15177 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15178 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15179 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15180 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15181 "mail.misc"))
15182 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15183 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15184 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15185 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15186 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15187 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15188 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15189 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15190 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15191 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15192 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15193 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15194 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15195 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15196 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15197 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15198 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15199 "misc.misc")
15200 @end lisp
15201
15202 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15203 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15204 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15205
15206 @table @code
15207
15208 @item group
15209 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15210 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15211
15212 @c Don't fold this line.
15213 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15214 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15215 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15216 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15217 @var{split}.
15218
15219 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15220 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15221 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15222 @var{split} is processed.
15223
15224 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15225 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15226 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15227 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15228
15229 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15230 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15231 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15232 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15233 stored in one or more groups.
15234
15235 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15236 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15237 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15238
15239 @item junk
15240 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15241 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15242
15243 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15244 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15245 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15246 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15247
15248 @cindex body split
15249 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15250 body of the messages:
15251
15252 @lisp
15253 (defun split-on-body ()
15254 (save-excursion
15255 (save-restriction
15256 (widen)
15257 (goto-char (point-min))
15258 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15259 "string.group"))))
15260 @end lisp
15261
15262 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15263 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15264 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15265 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15266 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15267 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15268 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15269
15270 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15271 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15272 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15273 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15274 should return a split.
15275
15276 @item nil
15277 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15278
15279 @end table
15280
15281 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15282
15283 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15284 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15285 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15286 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15287 for example,
15288
15289 @example
15290 (any "joe" "joemail")
15291 @end example
15292
15293 @noindent
15294 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15295 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15296 of the following three ways:
15297
15298 @enumerate
15299 @item
15300 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15301 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15302 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15303 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15304 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15305 @code{nil}.
15306
15307 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15308
15309 @item
15310 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15311 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15312 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15313 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15314 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15315
15316 @item
15317 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15318 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15319 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15320 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15321 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15322 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15323 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15324 @end enumerate
15325
15326 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15327 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15328 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15329 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15330 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15331 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15332 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15333
15334 @table @code
15335 @item from
15336 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15337 @item to
15338 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15339 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15340 @item any
15341 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15342 @end table
15343
15344 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15345 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15346 when all this splitting is performed.
15347
15348 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15349 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15350 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15351
15352 @example
15353 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15354 @end example
15355
15356 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15357 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15358
15359 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15360 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15361 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15362 groupings 1 through 9.
15363
15364 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15365 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15366 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15367 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15368 groups when users send to an address using different case
15369 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15370 is @code{t}.
15371
15372 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15373 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15374 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15375 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15376 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15377 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15378 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15379 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15380 it once per thread.
15381
15382 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15383 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15384 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15385 using the colon feature, like so:
15386 @lisp
15387 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15388 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15389 nnmail-split-fancy
15390 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15391 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15392 ))
15393 @end lisp
15394
15395 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15396 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15397 in the file specified by the variable
15398 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15399 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15400 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15401 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15402 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15403 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15404 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15405 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15406 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15407 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15408 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15409 300 kBytes in size.)
15410 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15411 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15412 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15413 messages goes into the new group.
15414
15415 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15416 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15417 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15418 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15419 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15420 ``outgoing'' group.
15421
15422
15423 @node Group Mail Splitting
15424 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15425 @cindex mail splitting
15426 @cindex group mail splitting
15427
15428 @findex gnus-group-split
15429 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15430 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15431 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15432 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15433 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15434 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15435 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15436 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15437
15438 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15439 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15440 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15441 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15442
15443 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15444 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15445 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15446 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15447 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15448 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15449 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15450
15451 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15452 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15453 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15454 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15455 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15456 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15457 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15458
15459 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15460 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15461 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15462 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15463 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15464 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15465 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15466 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15467 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15468 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15469 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15470 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15471 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15472
15473 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15474 been defined:
15475
15476 @example
15477 nnml:mail.bar:
15478 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15479 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15480 nnml:mail.foo:
15481 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15482 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15483 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15484 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15485 nnml:mail.others:
15486 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15487 @end example
15488
15489 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15490 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15491 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15492
15493 @lisp
15494 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15495 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15496 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15497 "mail.others")
15498 @end lisp
15499
15500 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15501 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15502 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15503 splits like this:
15504
15505 @lisp
15506 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15507 @end lisp
15508
15509 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15510 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15511 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15512 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15513 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15514 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15515 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15516 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15517 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15518
15519 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15520 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15521 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15522 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15523 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15524 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15525 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15526 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15527 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15528
15529 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15530 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15531 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15532 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15533 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15534 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15535
15536 @lisp
15537 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15538 @end lisp
15539
15540 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15541 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15542 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15543 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15544 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15545 value.
15546
15547 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15548 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15549 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15550 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15551
15552 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15553 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15554 @cindex incorporating old mail
15555 @cindex import old mail
15556
15557 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15558 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15559 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15560 your mail groups.
15561
15562 Doing so can be quite easy.
15563
15564 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15565 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15566 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15567 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15568 your @code{nnml} groups.
15569
15570 Here's how:
15571
15572 @enumerate
15573 @item
15574 Go to the group buffer.
15575
15576 @item
15577 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15578 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15579
15580 @item
15581 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15582
15583 @item
15584 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15585 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15586
15587 @item
15588 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15589 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15590 @end enumerate
15591
15592 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15593 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15594 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15595 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15596 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15597
15598 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15599 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15600 using the new mail back end.
15601
15602
15603 @node Expiring Mail
15604 @subsection Expiring Mail
15605 @cindex article expiry
15606 @cindex expiring mail
15607
15608 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15609 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15610 different approach to mail reading.
15611
15612 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15613 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15614 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15615 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15616 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15617 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15618 course.
15619
15620 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15621 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15622 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15623 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15624 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15625 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15626 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15627 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15628 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15629
15630 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15631 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15632 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15633 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15634 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15635 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15636 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15637 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15638 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15639 these marks.
15640
15641 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15642 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15643 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15644 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15645 into its own group.)
15646
15647 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15648 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15649 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15650 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15651 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15652 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15653 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15654 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15655 scoring.
15656
15657 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15658 Groups that match the regular expression
15659 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15660 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15661 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15662
15663 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15664 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15665 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15666 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15667 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15668
15669 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15670 @lisp
15671 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15672 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15673 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15674 @end lisp
15675
15676 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15677 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15678 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15679 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15680 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15681
15682 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15683 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15684
15685 @lisp
15686 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15687 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15688 @end lisp
15689
15690 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15691 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15692
15693 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15694 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15695 don't really mix very well.
15696
15697 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15698 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15699 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15700 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15701 days.
15702
15703 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15704 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15705 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15706 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15707 everywhere else:
15708
15709 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15710 @lisp
15711 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15712 (lambda (group)
15713 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15714 31)
15715 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15716 1)
15717 ((string= group "important")
15718 'never)
15719 (t
15720 6))))
15721 @end lisp
15722
15723 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15724 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15725
15726 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15727 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15728 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15729 @code{never}.
15730
15731 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15732 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15733
15734 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15735 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15736 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15737 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15738 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15739 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15740 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15741 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15742 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15743 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15744 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15745 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15746 name or @code{delete}.
15747
15748 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15749 @lisp
15750 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15751 @end lisp
15752
15753 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15754 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15755 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15756 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15757 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15758
15759 @lisp
15760 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15761 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15762 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15763 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15764 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15765 @end lisp
15766
15767 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15768 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15769 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15770 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15771 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15772 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15773
15774 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15775 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15776 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15777 easier for procmail users.
15778
15779 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15780 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15781 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15782 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15783 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15784 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15785 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15786 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15787 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15788 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15789 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15790 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15791 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15792 with! So there!
15793
15794 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15795
15796 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15797 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15798 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15799 auto-expire turned on.
15800
15801 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15802 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15803 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15804 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15805 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15806 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15807 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15808 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15809 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15810 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15811 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15812 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15813 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15814 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15815 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15816 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15817
15818
15819 @node Washing Mail
15820 @subsection Washing Mail
15821 @cindex mail washing
15822 @cindex list server brain damage
15823 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15824
15825 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15826 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15827 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15828 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15829 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15830 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15831
15832 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15833 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15834 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15835 laugh.
15836
15837 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15838 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15839 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15840 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15841
15842 @table @code
15843 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15844 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15845 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15846 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15847 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15848
15849 @table @code
15850 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15851 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15852 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15853 Emacs running on MS machines.
15854
15855 @end table
15856
15857 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15858 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15859 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15860 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15861
15862 @table @code
15863 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15864 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15865 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15866 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15867
15868 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15869 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15870 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15871 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15872 into a feature by documenting it.)
15873
15874 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15875 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15876 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15877 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15878 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15879 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15880 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15881 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15882
15883 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15884 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15885
15886 @lisp
15887 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15888 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15889 @end lisp
15890
15891 This can also be done non-destructively with
15892 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15893
15894 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15895 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15896 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15897
15898 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15899 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15900 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15901 @cindex Eudora
15902 @cindex Pegasus
15903 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15904 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15905 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15906 contain a line matching the regular expression
15907 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15908
15909 @end table
15910
15911 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15912 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15913 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15914 include:
15915
15916 @table @code
15917 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15918 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15919 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15920
15921 @end table
15922 @end table
15923
15924
15925 @node Duplicates
15926 @subsection Duplicates
15927
15928 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15929 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15930 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15931 @cindex duplicate mails
15932 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15933 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15934 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15935 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
15936 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15937 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15938 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15939 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15940 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15941 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15942 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15943 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15944 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15945
15946 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15947 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15948 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15949 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15950
15951 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15952 @code{nil}.
15953
15954 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15955 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15956 methods:
15957
15958 @lisp
15959 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15960 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15961 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15962 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15963 (any mail "mail.misc")
15964 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15965 [...] ))
15966 @end lisp
15967 @noindent
15968 Or something like:
15969 @lisp
15970 (setq nnmail-split-methods
15971 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15972 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15973 [...]))
15974 @end lisp
15975
15976 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15977 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15978 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15979 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15980 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15981
15982
15983 @node Not Reading Mail
15984 @subsection Not Reading Mail
15985
15986 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15987 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15988 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15989
15990 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15991 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15992 mail, which should help.
15993
15994 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15995 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15996 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15997 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15998 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15999 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16000 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16001 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16002 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16003 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16004 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16005
16006 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16007 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16008 incoming mail.
16009
16010
16011 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16012 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16013
16014 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16015 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16016 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16017
16018 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16019 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16020 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16021 Spool}).
16022
16023 @menu
16024 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16025 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16026 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16027 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16028 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16029 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16030 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16031 @end menu
16032
16033
16034
16035 @node Unix Mail Box
16036 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16037 @cindex nnmbox
16038 @cindex unix mail box
16039
16040 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16041 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16042 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16043 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16044 which group it belongs in.
16045
16046 Virtual server settings:
16047
16048 @table @code
16049 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16050 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16051 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16052 @file{~/mbox}.
16053
16054 @item nnmbox-active-file
16055 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16056 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16057 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16058
16059 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16060 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16061 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16062 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16063 @end table
16064
16065
16066 @node Babyl
16067 @subsubsection Babyl
16068 @cindex nnbabyl
16069
16070 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16071 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16072 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16073 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16074 group it belongs in.
16075
16076 Virtual server settings:
16077
16078 @table @code
16079 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16080 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16081 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16082
16083 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16084 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16085 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16086 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16087
16088 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16089 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16090 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16091 @code{t}
16092 @end table
16093
16094
16095 @node Mail Spool
16096 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16097 @cindex nnml
16098 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16099
16100 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16101 format. It should be used with some caution.
16102
16103 @vindex nnml-directory
16104 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16105 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16106 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16107 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16108
16109 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16110 care of all that.
16111
16112 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16113 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16114 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16115 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16116 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16117 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16118 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16119 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16120
16121 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16122 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16123 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16124 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16125
16126 Virtual server settings:
16127
16128 @table @code
16129 @item nnml-directory
16130 @vindex nnml-directory
16131 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16132 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16133 is @file{~/Mail}).
16134
16135 @item nnml-active-file
16136 @vindex nnml-active-file
16137 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16138 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16139
16140 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16141 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16142 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16143 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16144
16145 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16146 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16147 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16148 @code{t}.
16149
16150 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16151 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16152 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16153 default is @code{nil}.
16154
16155 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16156 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16157 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16158
16159 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16160 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16161 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16162
16163 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16164 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16165 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16166 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16167 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16168 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16169 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16170 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16171 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16172
16173 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16174 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16175 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16176 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16177 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16178
16179 @end table
16180
16181 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16182 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16183 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16184 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16185 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16186 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16187 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16188 Commands}).
16189
16190
16191 @node MH Spool
16192 @subsubsection MH Spool
16193 @cindex nnmh
16194 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16195
16196 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16197 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16198 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16199 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16200 for.
16201
16202 Virtual server settings:
16203
16204 @table @code
16205 @item nnmh-directory
16206 @vindex nnmh-directory
16207 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16208 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16209 @file{~/Mail})
16210
16211 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16212 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16213 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16214 @code{t}.
16215
16216 @item nnmh-be-safe
16217 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16218 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16219 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16220 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16221 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16222 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16223 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16224 @end table
16225
16226
16227 @node Maildir
16228 @subsubsection Maildir
16229 @cindex nnmaildir
16230 @cindex maildir
16231
16232 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16233 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16234 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16235 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16236 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16237 within a maildir.
16238
16239 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16240 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16241 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16242 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16243 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16244 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16245 that appear as group in Gnus.
16246
16247 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16248 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16249 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16250
16251 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16252 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16253 another, and you will keep your marks.
16254
16255 Virtual server settings:
16256
16257 @table @code
16258 @item directory
16259 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16260 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16261 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16262 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16263 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16264 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16265 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16266 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16267 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16268 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16269
16270 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16271 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16272 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16273 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16274 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16275 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16276 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16277 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16278 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16279 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16280 value.
16281
16282 @item target-prefix
16283 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16284 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16285 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16286 closed.
16287
16288 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16289 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16290 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16291 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16292 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16293 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16294 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16295 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16296 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16297
16298 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16299 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16300 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16301 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16302 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16303
16304 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16305 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16306 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16307 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16308 @code{force} argument.
16309
16310 @item directory-files
16311 This should be a function with the same interface as
16312 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16313 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16314 parameter is optional; the default is
16315 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16316 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16317 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16318 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16319 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16320 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16321
16322 @item get-new-mail
16323 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16324 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16325 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16326 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16327 value is @code{nil}.
16328
16329 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16330 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16331 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16332 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16333 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16334 @end table
16335
16336 @subsubsection Group parameters
16337
16338 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16339 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16340 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16341 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16342 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16343 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16344 another back end.
16345
16346 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16347 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16348 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16349 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16350 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16351 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16352 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16353 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16354 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16355
16356 @table @code
16357 @item expire-age
16358 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16359 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16360 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16361 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16362 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16363 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16364 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16365 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16366 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16367 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16368 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16369 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16370 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16371
16372 @item expire-group
16373 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16374 @example
16375 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16376 @end example
16377 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16378 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16379 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16380 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16381 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16382 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16383 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16384 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16385 article. So that form can refer to
16386 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16387 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16388 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16389 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16390
16391 @item read-only
16392 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16393 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16394 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16395 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16396 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16397 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16398 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16399 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16400 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16401 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16402 contain extra copies of the articles.
16403
16404 @item directory-files
16405 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16406 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16407 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16408 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16409
16410 @item distrust-Lines:
16411 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16412 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16413 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16414
16415 @item always-marks
16416 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16417 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16418 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16419 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16420 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16421 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16422
16423 @item never-marks
16424 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16425 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16426 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16427 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16428 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16429 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16430 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16431
16432 @item nov-cache-size
16433 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16434 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16435 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16436 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16437 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16438 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16439 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16440 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16441 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16442 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16443 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16444 @end table
16445
16446 @subsubsection Article identification
16447 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16448 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16449 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16450 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16451 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16452 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16453 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16454 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16455 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16456 request the article in the summary buffer.
16457
16458 @subsubsection NOV data
16459 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16460 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16461 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16462 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16463 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16464 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16465 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16466 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16467 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16468 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16469 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16470
16471 @subsubsection Article marks
16472 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16473 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16474 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16475 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16476 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16477 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16478 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16479 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16480
16481 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16482 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16483 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16484 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16485 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16486 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16487 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16488 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16489 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16490
16491
16492 @node Mail Folders
16493 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16494 @cindex nnfolder
16495 @cindex mbox folders
16496 @cindex mail folders
16497
16498 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16499 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16500 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16501 numbers and arrival dates.
16502
16503 Virtual server settings:
16504
16505 @table @code
16506 @item nnfolder-directory
16507 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16508 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16509 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16510 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16511
16512 @item nnfolder-active-file
16513 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16514 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16515
16516 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16517 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16518 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16519 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16520
16521 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16522 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16523 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16524 default is @code{t}
16525
16526 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16527 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16528 @cindex backup files
16529 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16530 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16531 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16532 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16533
16534 @lisp
16535 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16536 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16537
16538 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16539 @end lisp
16540
16541 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16542 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16543 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16544 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16545 extract some information from it before removing it.
16546
16547 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16548 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16549 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16550 default is @code{nil}.
16551
16552 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16553 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16554 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16555
16556 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16557 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16558 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16559 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16560
16561 @end table
16562
16563
16564 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16565 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16566 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16567 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16568 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16569 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16570 though.
16571
16572 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16573 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16574
16575 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16576 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16577 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16578 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16579 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16580
16581 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16582 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16583 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16584 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16585 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16586 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16587 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16588 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16589 via NFS).
16590
16591 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16592 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16593 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16594 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16595
16596 @table @code
16597 @item nnmbox
16598
16599 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16600 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16601 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16602 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16603 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16604 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16605 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16606 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16607 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16608 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16609 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16610 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16611 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16612 what's where.
16613
16614 @item nnbabyl
16615
16616 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16617 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16618 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16619 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16620 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16621 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16622 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16623 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16624 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16625 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16626 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16627 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16628 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16629 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16630 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16631
16632 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16633 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16634 look at your mail.
16635
16636 @item nnml
16637
16638 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16639 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16640 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16641 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16642 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16643 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16644 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16645 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16646 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16647 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16648 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16649 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16650 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16651 provided by the active file and overviews.
16652
16653 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16654 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16655 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16656 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16657 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16658 wins big.
16659
16660 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16661 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16662 tiny files.
16663
16664 @item nnmh
16665
16666 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16667 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16668 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16669 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16670 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16671 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16672 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16673
16674 @item nnfolder
16675
16676 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16677 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16678 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16679 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16680 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16681 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16682 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16683 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16684 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16685
16686 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16687 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16688 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16689 friendly mail back end all over.
16690
16691 @item nnmaildir
16692
16693 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16694 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16695 mail back ends.
16696
16697 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16698 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16699 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16700 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16701 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16702 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16703 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16704 file system.
16705
16706 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16707 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16708 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16709 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16710 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16711 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16712 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16713 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16714 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16715 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16716 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16717
16718 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16719 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16720 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16721 else, and still have your marks.
16722
16723 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16724 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16725 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16726 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16727 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16728 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16729 removed in the future.
16730
16731 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16732 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16733 on your file system.
16734
16735 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16736 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16737
16738 @end table
16739
16740
16741 @node Browsing the Web
16742 @section Browsing the Web
16743 @cindex web
16744 @cindex browsing the web
16745 @cindex www
16746 @cindex http
16747
16748 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16749 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16750 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16751 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16752 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16753 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16754 even know what a news group is.
16755
16756 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16757 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16758 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16759 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16760 you mad in the end.
16761
16762 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16763 to do it instead?
16764
16765 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16766 interfaces to these sources.
16767
16768 @menu
16769 * Archiving Mail::
16770 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16771 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16772 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16773 @end menu
16774
16775 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16776 alternatives to work.
16777
16778 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16779 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16780 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16781 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16782 though, you should be ok.
16783
16784 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16785 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16786 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16787 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16788 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16789
16790 @node Archiving Mail
16791 @subsection Archiving Mail
16792 @cindex archiving mail
16793 @cindex backup of mail
16794
16795 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16796 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16797 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16798 marks is fairly simple.
16799
16800 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16801 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16802 though.)
16803
16804 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16805 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16806 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16807 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16808 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16809 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16810 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16811 before you restore the data.
16812
16813 @node Web Searches
16814 @subsection Web Searches
16815 @cindex nnweb
16816 @cindex Google
16817 @cindex dejanews
16818 @cindex gmane
16819 @cindex Usenet searches
16820 @cindex searching the Usenet
16821
16822 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16823 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16824 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16825 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16826 searches without having to use a browser.
16827
16828 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16829 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16830 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16831 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16832 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16833
16834 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16835 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16836 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16837 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16838 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16839 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16840 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16841 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16842 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16843 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16844 group as read.
16845
16846 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16847 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16848 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16849 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16850 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16851 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16852
16853 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16854 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16855 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16856
16857 Virtual server variables:
16858
16859 @table @code
16860 @item nnweb-type
16861 @vindex nnweb-type
16862 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16863 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16864 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16865
16866 @item nnweb-search
16867 @vindex nnweb-search
16868 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16869
16870 @item nnweb-max-hits
16871 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16872 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16873 999.
16874
16875 @item nnweb-type-definition
16876 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16877 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16878 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16879 present:
16880
16881 @table @code
16882 @item article
16883 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16884 understands.
16885
16886 @item map
16887 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16888
16889 @item search
16890 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16891
16892 @item address
16893 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16894 to.
16895
16896 @item id
16897 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16898 @end table
16899
16900 @end table
16901
16902
16903 @node RSS
16904 @subsection RSS
16905 @cindex nnrss
16906 @cindex RSS
16907
16908 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16909 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16910 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16911 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16912 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16913
16914 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16915 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16916
16917 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16918 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16919 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16920 group names.
16921
16922 @kindex G R (Group)
16923 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16924 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16925 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16926 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16927
16928 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16929 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16930 subscribe to groups.
16931
16932 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16933 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16934 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16935 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16936 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
16937 information.
16938
16939 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16940 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16941 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16942
16943 @cindex OPML
16944 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16945 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16946 Markup Language).
16947
16948 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16949 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16950 file.
16951 @end defun
16952
16953 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16954 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16955 @acronym{OPML} format.
16956 @end defun
16957
16958 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16959
16960 @table @code
16961 @item nnrss-directory
16962 @vindex nnrss-directory
16963 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16964 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16965
16966 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16967 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16968 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16969 data files. The default is the value of
16970 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16971 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16972
16973 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16974 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16975 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
16976 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
16977 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
16978 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
16979 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
16980 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
16981
16982 @item nnrss-use-local
16983 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16984 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16985 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16986 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16987 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16988 download script using @command{wget}.
16989 @end table
16990
16991 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16992 the summary buffer.
16993
16994 @lisp
16995 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16996 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16997
16998 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16999 (let ((descr
17000 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17001 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17002 @end lisp
17003
17004 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17005 summary buffer.
17006
17007 @lisp
17008 (require 'browse-url)
17009
17010 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17011 (interactive "p")
17012 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17013 (mail-header-extra
17014 (gnus-data-header
17015 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17016 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17017 (if url
17018 (progn
17019 (browse-url (cdr url))
17020 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17021 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17022
17023 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17024 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17025 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17026 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17027 @end lisp
17028
17029 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17030 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17031 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17032 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17033 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17034 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17035 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17036 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17037 @code{nnrss} groups:
17038
17039 @lisp
17040 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17041 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17042 '(add-to-list
17043 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17044 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17045 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17046
17047 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17048 (add-to-list
17049 'gnus-parameters
17050 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17051 @end lisp
17052
17053
17054 @node Customizing W3
17055 @subsection Customizing W3
17056 @cindex W3
17057 @cindex html
17058 @cindex url
17059 @cindex Netscape
17060
17061 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17062 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17063 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17064 users.
17065
17066 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17067 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17068 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17069
17070 @lisp
17071 (eval-after-load "w3"
17072 '(progn
17073 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17074 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17075 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17076 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17077 (browse-url url)
17078 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17079 @end lisp
17080
17081 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17082 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17083 follow the link.
17084
17085
17086 @node Other Sources
17087 @section Other Sources
17088
17089 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17090 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17091 newsgroups.
17092
17093 @menu
17094 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17095 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17096 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17097 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17098 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17099 @end menu
17100
17101
17102 @node Directory Groups
17103 @subsection Directory Groups
17104 @cindex nndir
17105 @cindex directory groups
17106
17107 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17108 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17109 names, of course.
17110
17111 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17112 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17113 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17114 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17115
17116 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17117 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17118 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17119 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17120 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17121
17122 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17123
17124 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17125 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17126 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17127 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17128
17129
17130 @node Anything Groups
17131 @subsection Anything Groups
17132 @cindex nneething
17133
17134 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17135 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17136 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17137 true.
17138
17139 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17140 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17141 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17142 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17143 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17144 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17145 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17146 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17147 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17148 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17149 elements.
17150
17151 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17152 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17153 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17154 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17155
17156 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17157 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17158 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17159 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17160
17161 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17162 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17163 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17164 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17165 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17166 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17167 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17168 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17169
17170 Some variables:
17171
17172 @table @code
17173 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17174 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17175 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17176 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17177
17178 @item nneething-exclude-files
17179 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17180 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17181 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17182
17183 @item nneething-include-files
17184 @vindex nneething-include-files
17185 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17186 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17187
17188 @item nneething-map-file
17189 @vindex nneething-map-file
17190 Name of the map files.
17191 @end table
17192
17193
17194 @node Document Groups
17195 @subsection Document Groups
17196 @cindex nndoc
17197 @cindex documentation group
17198 @cindex help group
17199
17200 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17201 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17202
17203 @table @code
17204 @cindex Babyl
17205 @item babyl
17206 The Babyl format.
17207
17208 @cindex mbox
17209 @cindex Unix mbox
17210 @item mbox
17211 The standard Unix mbox file.
17212
17213 @cindex MMDF mail box
17214 @item mmdf
17215 The MMDF mail box format.
17216
17217 @item news
17218 Several news articles appended into a file.
17219
17220 @cindex rnews batch files
17221 @item rnews
17222 The rnews batch transport format.
17223
17224 @item nsmail
17225 Netscape mail boxes.
17226
17227 @item mime-parts
17228 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17229
17230 @item standard-digest
17231 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17232
17233 @item mime-digest
17234 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17235
17236 @item lanl-gov-announce
17237 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17238
17239 @cindex git commit messages
17240 @item git
17241 @code{git} commit messages.
17242
17243 @cindex forwarded messages
17244 @item rfc822-forward
17245 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17246
17247 @item outlook
17248 The Outlook mail box.
17249
17250 @item oe-dbx
17251 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17252
17253 @item exim-bounce
17254 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17255
17256 @item forward
17257 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17258
17259 @item rfc934
17260 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17261
17262 @item mailman
17263 A mailman digest.
17264
17265 @item clari-briefs
17266 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17267
17268 @item slack-digest
17269 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17270
17271 @item mail-in-mail
17272 The last resort.
17273 @end table
17274
17275 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17276 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17277 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17278 file is.
17279
17280 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17281 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17282 group. And that's it.
17283
17284 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17285 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17286 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17287 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17288 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17289 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17290 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17291 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17292 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17293 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17294
17295 Virtual server variables:
17296
17297 @table @code
17298 @item nndoc-article-type
17299 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17300 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17301 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17302 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17303 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17304 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17305
17306 @item nndoc-post-type
17307 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17308 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17309 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17310 and @code{news}.
17311 @end table
17312
17313 @menu
17314 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17315 @end menu
17316
17317
17318 @node Document Server Internals
17319 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17320
17321 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17322 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17323 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17324 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17325
17326 First, here's an example document type definition:
17327
17328 @example
17329 (mmdf
17330 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17331 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17332 @end example
17333
17334 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17335 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17336 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17337 types can be defined with very few settings:
17338
17339 @table @code
17340 @item first-article
17341 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17342 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17343 totally ignored.
17344
17345 @item article-begin
17346 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17347 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17348 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17349 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17350
17351 @item article-begin-function
17352 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17353 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17354
17355 @item head-begin
17356 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17357 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17358 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17359
17360 @item head-begin-function
17361 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17362 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17363
17364 @item head-end
17365 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17366 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17367
17368 @item body-begin
17369 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17370 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17371 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17372
17373 @item body-begin-function
17374 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17375 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17376
17377 @item body-end
17378 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17379 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17380 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17381
17382 @item body-end-function
17383 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17384 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17385
17386 @item file-begin
17387 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17388 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17389
17390 @item file-end
17391 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17392 regexp will be totally ignored.
17393
17394 @end table
17395
17396 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17397 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17398 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17399 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17400 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17401
17402 @table @code
17403 @item prepare-body-function
17404 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17405 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17406 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17407
17408 @item article-transform-function
17409 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17410 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17411 body of the article.
17412
17413 @item generate-head-function
17414 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17415 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17416 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17417 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17418
17419 @item generate-article-function
17420 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17421 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17422 parameter when requesting all articles.
17423
17424 @item dissection-function
17425 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17426 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17427 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17428 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17429 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17430 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17431
17432 @end table
17433
17434 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17435 digests:
17436
17437 @example
17438 (standard-digest
17439 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17440 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17441 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17442 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17443 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17444 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17445 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17446 (subtype digest guess))
17447 @end example
17448
17449 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17450 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17451 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17452 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17453 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17454
17455 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17456 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17457 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17458 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17459 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17460 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17461 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17462 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17463 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17464 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17465 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17466 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17467
17468
17469 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17470 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17471 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17472 @cindex gateways
17473
17474 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17475 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17476 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17477
17478 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17479 used to post with.
17480
17481 Server variables:
17482
17483 @table @code
17484 @item nngateway-address
17485 @vindex nngateway-address
17486 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17487
17488 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17489 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17490 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17491 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17492 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17493 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17494 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17495 gateway address.
17496
17497 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17498 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17499 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17500
17501 @example
17502 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17503 @end example
17504
17505 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17506
17507 @example
17508 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17509 @end example
17510
17511 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17512
17513 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17514 @table @code
17515
17516 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17517 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17518 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17519
17520 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17521
17522 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17523 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17524 @code{nngateway-address}.
17525 @end table
17526
17527 @end table
17528
17529 Here's an example:
17530
17531 @lisp
17532 (setq gnus-post-method
17533 '(nngateway
17534 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17535 (nngateway-header-transformation
17536 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17537 @end lisp
17538
17539 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17540
17541 @lisp
17542 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17543 @end lisp
17544
17545
17546 @node The Empty Backend
17547 @subsection The Empty Backend
17548 @cindex nnnil
17549
17550 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17551 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17552 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17553 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17554
17555 @lisp
17556 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17557 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17558 '((nnimap "foo")
17559 (nnml "")))
17560 @end lisp
17561
17562
17563 @node Combined Groups
17564 @section Combined Groups
17565
17566 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17567 groups.
17568
17569 @menu
17570 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17571 @end menu
17572
17573
17574 @node Virtual Groups
17575 @subsection Virtual Groups
17576 @cindex nnvirtual
17577 @cindex virtual groups
17578 @cindex merging groups
17579
17580 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17581 other groups.
17582
17583 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17584 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17585 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17586
17587 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17588 regexp to match component groups.
17589
17590 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17591 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17592 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17593 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17594 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17595 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17596 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17597 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17598
17599 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17600 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17601
17602 @lisp
17603 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17604 @end lisp
17605
17606 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17607 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17608
17609 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17610 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17611 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17612 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17613
17614 @example
17615 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17616 @end example
17617
17618 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17619 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17620 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17621
17622 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17623 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17624 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17625 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17626 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17627
17628 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17629 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17630 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17631
17632 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17633 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17634 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17635 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17636 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17637 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17638 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17639 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17640 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17641 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17642 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17643
17644 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17645 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17646 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17647 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17648 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17649 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17650 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17651
17652 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17653 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17654
17655 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17656 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17657 inherited.
17658
17659
17660 @node Email Based Diary
17661 @section Email Based Diary
17662 @cindex diary
17663 @cindex email based diary
17664 @cindex calendar
17665
17666 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17667 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17668 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17669 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17670 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17671 namely, as event reminders.
17672
17673 Here is a typical scenario:
17674
17675 @itemize @bullet
17676 @item
17677 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17678 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17679 @item
17680 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17681 @item
17682 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17683 @item
17684 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17685 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17686 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17687 @item
17688 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17689 of the night you're gonna have.
17690 @item
17691 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17692 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17693 @end itemize
17694
17695 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17696 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17697 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17698 explained in the sections below.
17699
17700 @menu
17701 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17702 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17703 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17704 @end menu
17705
17706
17707 @node The NNDiary Back End
17708 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17709 @cindex nndiary
17710 @cindex the nndiary back end
17711
17712 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17713 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17714 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17715 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17716 directory per group.
17717
17718 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17719 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17720 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17721 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17722
17723 @menu
17724 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17725 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17726 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17727 @end menu
17728
17729 @node Diary Messages
17730 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17731 @cindex nndiary messages
17732 @cindex nndiary mails
17733
17734 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17735 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17736 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17737 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17738 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17739 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17740 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17741
17742 @itemize @bullet
17743 @item
17744 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17745 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17746 (separated by a comma).
17747 @item
17748 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17749 @item
17750 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17751 @item
17752 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17753 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17754 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17755 @item
17756 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17757 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17758 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17759 @item
17760 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17761 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17762 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17763 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17764 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17765 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17766 @end itemize
17767
17768 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17769 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17770 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17771 what to do then):
17772
17773 @example
17774 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17775 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17776 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17777 X-Diary-Month: *
17778 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17779 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17780 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17781 @end example
17782
17783 @node Running NNDiary
17784 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17785 @cindex running nndiary
17786 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17787
17788 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17789 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17790 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17791 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17792 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17793 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17794
17795 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17796 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17797 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17798 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17799 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17800 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17801 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17802 mode.
17803
17804 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17805 things to do:
17806
17807 @itemize @bullet
17808 @item
17809 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17810 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17811
17812 @lisp
17813 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17814 @end lisp
17815 @item
17816 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17817 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17818 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17819 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17820 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17821
17822 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17823 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17824
17825 @example
17826 :0 HD :
17827 * ^X-Diary
17828 .nndiary
17829 @end example
17830 @end itemize
17831
17832 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17833 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17834
17835 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17836 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17837 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17838 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17839 @end defvar
17840
17841 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17842 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17843 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17844 @end defvar
17845
17846 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17847 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17848 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17849
17850 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17851 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17852 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17853 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17854 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17855
17856 @node Customizing NNDiary
17857 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17858 @cindex customizing nndiary
17859 @cindex nndiary customization
17860
17861 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17862 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17863 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17864 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17865
17866 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17867 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17868 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17869 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17870 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17871 mail.
17872 @end defvar
17873
17874 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17875 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17876 default).
17877 @end defvar
17878
17879
17880 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17881 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17882 @cindex gnus-diary
17883 @cindex the gnus diary library
17884
17885 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17886 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17887 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17888 useful things for you.
17889
17890 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17891
17892 @lisp
17893 (require 'gnus-diary)
17894 @end lisp
17895
17896 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17897 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17898 (sorry if you used them before).
17899
17900
17901 @menu
17902 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17903 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17904 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17905 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17906 @end menu
17907
17908 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17909 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17910 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17911 @cindex diary summary line format
17912
17913 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17914 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17915 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17916 see the event's date.
17917
17918 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17919 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17920 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17921 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17922 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17923
17924 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17925 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17926 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17927
17928 @example
17929 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17930 @end example
17931
17932 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
17933 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
17934
17935 @lisp
17936 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
17937 @end lisp
17938
17939 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
17940 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
17941 with the following user options:
17942
17943 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
17944 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
17945 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
17946 diary groups'parameters.
17947 @end defvar
17948
17949 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
17950 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
17951 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
17952 @end defvar
17953
17954 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
17955 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
17956 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
17957 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
17958 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
17959 @end defvar
17960
17961 @node Diary Articles Sorting
17962 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
17963 @cindex diary articles sorting
17964 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
17965 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
17966 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
17967 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
17968
17969 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
17970 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
17971 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
17972 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
17973 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
17974
17975 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
17976 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
17977 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
17978 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
17979 Parameters}).
17980
17981 @node Diary Headers Generation
17982 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
17983 @cindex diary headers generation
17984 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
17985
17986 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
17987 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
17988 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
17989 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
17990 needed.
17991
17992 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
17993 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
17994 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
17995 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
17996 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
17997
17998 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
17999 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18000 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18001 instance.
18002
18003 @node Diary Group Parameters
18004 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18005 @cindex diary group parameters
18006
18007 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18008 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18009 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18010 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18011 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18012 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18013 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18014 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18015
18016 @node Sending or Not Sending
18017 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18018
18019 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18020 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18021
18022 @itemize @bullet
18023 @item
18024 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18025 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18026 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18027 sending the diary message to them as well.
18028 @item
18029 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18030 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18031 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18032 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18033 @end itemize
18034
18035 @node Gnus Unplugged
18036 @section Gnus Unplugged
18037 @cindex offline
18038 @cindex unplugged
18039 @cindex agent
18040 @cindex Gnus agent
18041 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18042
18043 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18044 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18045 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18046 read news. Believe it or not.
18047
18048 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18049 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18050 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18051 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18052 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18053
18054 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18055 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18056 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18057 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18058 reading news on a machine.
18059
18060 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18061 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18062 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18063
18064 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18065
18066 @menu
18067 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18068 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18069 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18070 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18071 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18072 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18073 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18074 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18075 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18076 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18077 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18078 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18079 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18080 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18081 @end menu
18082
18083
18084 @node Agent Basics
18085 @subsection Agent Basics
18086
18087 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18088
18089 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18090 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18091 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18092 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18093
18094 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18095 connected to the net continuously.
18096
18097 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18098 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18099
18100 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18101 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18102 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18103 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18104 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18105
18106 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18107 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18108 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18109 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18110 they're kinda like plugged always).
18111
18112 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18113 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18114 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18115 the culprit.
18116
18117 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18118 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18119 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18120 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18121 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18122
18123 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18124
18125 @itemize @bullet
18126
18127 @item
18128 @findex gnus-unplugged
18129 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18130 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18131 already fetched while in this mode.
18132
18133 @item
18134 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18135 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18136 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18137 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18138 Source Specifiers}).
18139
18140 @item
18141 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18142 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18143 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18144 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18145 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18146
18147 @item
18148 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18149 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18150 then you read the news offline.
18151
18152 @item
18153 And then you go to step 2.
18154 @end itemize
18155
18156 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18157 the Agent.
18158
18159 @itemize @bullet
18160
18161 @item
18162 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18163 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18164 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18165 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18166 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18167 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18168 no servers are agentized.
18169
18170 @item
18171 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18172 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18173 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18174 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18175
18176 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18177 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18178 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18179 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18180 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18181 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18182 configure them.
18183
18184 @item
18185 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18186 @end itemize
18187
18188
18189 @node Agent Categories
18190 @subsection Agent Categories
18191
18192 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18193 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18194 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18195 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18196 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18197 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18198 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18199
18200 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18201 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18202 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18203 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18204 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18205
18206 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18207 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18208 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18209 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18210 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18211 sink.
18212
18213 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18214 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18215 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18216 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18217 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18218 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18219 your settings.
18220
18221 @menu
18222 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18223 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18224 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18225 @end menu
18226
18227
18228 @node Category Syntax
18229 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18230
18231 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18232 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18233 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18234 listed below.
18235
18236 @cindex Agent Parameters
18237 @table @code
18238 @item agent-groups
18239 The list of groups that are in this category.
18240
18241 @item agent-predicate
18242 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18243 are eligible for downloading; and
18244
18245 @item agent-score
18246 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18247 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18248 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18249
18250 @item agent-enable-expiration
18251 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18252 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18253 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18254 only groups that should not be expired.
18255
18256 @item agent-days-until-old
18257 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18258 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18259
18260 @item agent-low-score
18261 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18262
18263 @item agent-high-score
18264 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18265
18266 @item agent-short-article
18267 an integer that overrides the value of
18268 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18269
18270 @item agent-long-article
18271 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18272
18273 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18274 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18275 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18276 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18277 undownloaded faces.
18278 @end table
18279
18280 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18281 created.
18282
18283 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18284 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18285 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18286 category.
18287
18288 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18289 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18290 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18291 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18292
18293 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18294 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18295 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18296
18297 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18298 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18299 operators sprinkled in between.
18300
18301 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18302
18303 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18304 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18305
18306 @lisp
18307 short
18308 @end lisp
18309
18310 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18311 short (for some value of ``short'').
18312
18313 Here's a more complex predicate:
18314
18315 @lisp
18316 (or high
18317 (and
18318 (not low)
18319 (not long)))
18320 @end lisp
18321
18322 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18323 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18324 drift.
18325
18326 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18327 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18328 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18329
18330 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18331 you want to do, you can write your own.
18332
18333 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18334 bound to the value determined by calling
18335 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18336 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18337 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18338 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18339 predicate to individual groups.
18340
18341 @table @code
18342 @item short
18343 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18344 lines; default 100.
18345
18346 @item long
18347 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18348 lines; default 200.
18349
18350 @item low
18351 True if the article has a download score less than
18352 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18353
18354 @item high
18355 True if the article has a download score greater than
18356 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18357
18358 @item spam
18359 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18360 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18361 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18362
18363 @item true
18364 Always true.
18365
18366 @item false
18367 Always false.
18368 @end table
18369
18370 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18371 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18372 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18373 useful values.
18374
18375 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18376 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18377 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18378 something along the lines of the following:
18379
18380 @lisp
18381 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18382 "Say whether an article is old."
18383 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18384 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18385 @end lisp
18386
18387 with the predicate then defined as:
18388
18389 @lisp
18390 (not my-article-old-p)
18391 @end lisp
18392
18393 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18394 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18395 wherever.
18396
18397 @lisp
18398 (require 'gnus-agent)
18399 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18400 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18401 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18402 @end lisp
18403
18404 and simply specify your predicate as:
18405
18406 @lisp
18407 (not old)
18408 @end lisp
18409
18410 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18411 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18412 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18413 just don't give a damn.
18414
18415 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18416 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18417 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18418 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18419 parameters like so:
18420
18421 @lisp
18422 (agent-predicate . short)
18423 @end lisp
18424
18425 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18426 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18427 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18428
18429 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18430
18431 @lisp
18432 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18433 @end lisp
18434
18435 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18436 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18437 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18438
18439
18440 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18441 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18442 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18443 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18444 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18445 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18446
18447 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18448 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18449 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18450 if it's to be specific to that group.
18451
18452 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18453 three forms:
18454
18455 @enumerate
18456 @item
18457 Score rule
18458
18459 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18460 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18461
18462 example:
18463
18464 @itemize @bullet
18465 @item
18466 Category specification
18467
18468 @lisp
18469 (("from"
18470 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18471 ("lines"
18472 (500 -100 nil <)))
18473 @end lisp
18474
18475 @item
18476 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18477
18478 @lisp
18479 (agent-score ("from"
18480 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18481 ("lines"
18482 (500 -100 nil <)))
18483 @end lisp
18484
18485 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18486 @end itemize
18487
18488 @item
18489 Agent score file
18490
18491 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18492 keywords stated above.
18493
18494 example:
18495
18496 @itemize @bullet
18497 @item
18498 Category specification
18499
18500 @lisp
18501 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18502 @end lisp
18503
18504 or perhaps
18505
18506 @lisp
18507 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18508 @end lisp
18509
18510 @item
18511 Group Parameter specification
18512
18513 @lisp
18514 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18515 @end lisp
18516
18517 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18518 about parenthesis?
18519 @end itemize
18520
18521 @item
18522 Use @code{normal} score files
18523
18524 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18525 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18526 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18527 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18528
18529 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18530 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18531 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18532 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18533
18534 @itemize @bullet
18535 @item
18536 Category Specification
18537
18538 @lisp
18539 file
18540 @end lisp
18541
18542 @item
18543 Group Parameter specification
18544
18545 @lisp
18546 (agent-score . file)
18547 @end lisp
18548 @end itemize
18549 @end enumerate
18550
18551 @node Category Buffer
18552 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18553
18554 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18555 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18556 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18557
18558 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18559
18560 @table @kbd
18561 @item q
18562 @kindex q (Category)
18563 @findex gnus-category-exit
18564 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18565
18566 @item e
18567 @kindex e (Category)
18568 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18569 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18570 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18571
18572 @item k
18573 @kindex k (Category)
18574 @findex gnus-category-kill
18575 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18576
18577 @item c
18578 @kindex c (Category)
18579 @findex gnus-category-copy
18580 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18581
18582 @item a
18583 @kindex a (Category)
18584 @findex gnus-category-add
18585 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18586
18587 @item p
18588 @kindex p (Category)
18589 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18590 Edit the predicate of the current category
18591 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18592
18593 @item g
18594 @kindex g (Category)
18595 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18596 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18597 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18598
18599 @item s
18600 @kindex s (Category)
18601 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18602 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18603 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18604
18605 @item l
18606 @kindex l (Category)
18607 @findex gnus-category-list
18608 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18609 @end table
18610
18611
18612 @node Category Variables
18613 @subsubsection Category Variables
18614
18615 @table @code
18616 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18617 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18618 Hook run in category buffers.
18619
18620 @item gnus-category-line-format
18621 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18622 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18623 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18624
18625 @table @samp
18626 @item c
18627 The name of the category.
18628
18629 @item g
18630 The number of groups in the category.
18631 @end table
18632
18633 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18634 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18635 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18636
18637 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18638 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18639 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18640
18641 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18642 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18643 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18644
18645 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18646 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18647 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18648 0.
18649
18650 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18651 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18652 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18653 0.
18654
18655 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18656 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18657 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18658 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18659 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18660 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18661 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18662 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18663 read.
18664 Default 7.
18665
18666 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18667 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18668 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18669 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18670 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18671 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18672 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18673
18674 @end table
18675
18676
18677 @node Agent Commands
18678 @subsection Agent Commands
18679 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18680 @kindex J j (Agent)
18681
18682 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18683 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18684 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18685
18686
18687 @menu
18688 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18689 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18690 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18691 @end menu
18692
18693
18694
18695
18696 @node Group Agent Commands
18697 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18698
18699 @table @kbd
18700 @item J u
18701 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18702 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18703 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18704 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18705
18706 @item J c
18707 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18708 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18709 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18710
18711 @item J s
18712 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18713 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18714 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18715 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18716
18717 @item J S
18718 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18719 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18720 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18721 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18722
18723 @item J a
18724 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18725 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18726 Add the current group to an Agent category
18727 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18728 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18729
18730 @item J r
18731 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18732 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18733 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18734 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18735 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18736
18737 @item J Y
18738 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18739 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18740 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18741
18742
18743 @end table
18744
18745
18746 @node Summary Agent Commands
18747 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18748
18749 @table @kbd
18750 @item J #
18751 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18752 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18753 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18754
18755 @item J M-#
18756 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18757 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18758 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18759 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18760
18761 @cindex %
18762 @item @@
18763 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18764 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18765 Toggle whether to download the article
18766 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18767 default.
18768
18769 @item J c
18770 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18771 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18772 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18773
18774 @item J S
18775 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18776 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18777 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18778 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18779
18780 @item J s
18781 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18782 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18783 Download all processable articles in this group.
18784 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18785
18786 @item J u
18787 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18788 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18789 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18790 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18791
18792 @end table
18793
18794
18795 @node Server Agent Commands
18796 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18797
18798 @table @kbd
18799 @item J a
18800 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18801 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18802 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18803 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18804
18805 @item J r
18806 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18807 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18808 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18809 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18810
18811 @end table
18812
18813
18814 @node Agent Visuals
18815 @subsection Agent Visuals
18816
18817 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18818 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18819 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18820 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18821 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18822 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18823 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18824 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18825 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18826 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18827
18828 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18829 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18830 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18831 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18832 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18833 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18834 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18835 articles will be available when unplugged.
18836
18837 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18838 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18839 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18840 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18841 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18842 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18843 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18844 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18845
18846 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18847 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18848 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18849 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18850 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18851 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18852 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18853 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18854 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18855
18856 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18857 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18858 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18859 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18860 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18861 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18862 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18863 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18864 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18865 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18866
18867 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18868 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18869 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18870 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18871 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18872 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18873
18874 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18875 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18876 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18877 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18878 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18879 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18880 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18881 expiring'' articles.
18882
18883 @node Agent as Cache
18884 @subsection Agent as Cache
18885
18886 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18887 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18888 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18889 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18890 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18891 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18892 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18893 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18894 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18895
18896 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18897 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18898 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18899 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18900 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18901
18902 @node Agent Expiry
18903 @subsection Agent Expiry
18904
18905 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18906 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18907 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18908 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18909 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18910 @cindex agent expiry
18911 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18912 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18913
18914 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18915 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18916 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18917 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18918 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18919 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18920 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18921 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18922
18923 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18924 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18925
18926 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18927 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18928
18929 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18930 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18931 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18932 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18933 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18934 be kept indefinitely.
18935
18936 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18937 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18938 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18939 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18940
18941 @node Agent Regeneration
18942 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18943
18944 @cindex agent regeneration
18945 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18946 @cindex regeneration
18947
18948 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18949 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18950 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18951 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18952 internal inconsistencies.
18953
18954 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18955 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18956 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18957 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18958 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18959 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18960
18961 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18962 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18963 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18964 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18965 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18966 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18967
18968 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18969 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18970 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18971 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18972 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18973 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18974 agent as unread.
18975
18976 @node Agent and flags
18977 @subsection Agent and flags
18978
18979 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
18980 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
18981 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
18982 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
18983 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
18984 to the flags in its own files.
18985
18986 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
18987 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
18988 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18989
18990 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18991 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18992 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18993 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18994 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18995 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18996
18997 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18998 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18999 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19000 in the group buffer.
19001
19002 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19003 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19004 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19005 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19006 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19007 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19008 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19009 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19010
19011 @node Agent and IMAP
19012 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19013
19014 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19015 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19016 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19017 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19018
19019 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19020 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19021
19022 @itemize @bullet
19023
19024 @item
19025 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19026
19027 @item
19028 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19029
19030 @end itemize
19031
19032 @node Outgoing Messages
19033 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19034
19035 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19036 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19037 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19038
19039 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19040 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19041 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19042
19043 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19044 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19045 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19046 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19047 mail at any time.
19048
19049 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19050 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19051 ask you to confirm your action (see
19052 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19053
19054 @node Agent Variables
19055 @subsection Agent Variables
19056
19057 @table @code
19058 @item gnus-agent
19059 @vindex gnus-agent
19060 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19061 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19062 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19063 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19064
19065 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19066 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19067
19068
19069 @item gnus-agent-directory
19070 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19071 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19072 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19073
19074 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19075 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19076 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19077 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19078 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19079 by default.
19080
19081 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19082 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19083 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19084
19085 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19086 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19087 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19088
19089 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19090 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19091 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19092
19093 @item gnus-agent-cache
19094 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19095 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19096 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19097 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19098
19099 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19100 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19101 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19102 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19103 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19104 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19105 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19106 online status.
19107
19108 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19109 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19110 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19111 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19112 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19113 read. The default is @code{t}.
19114
19115 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19116 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19117 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19118 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19119 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19120 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19121 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19122
19123 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19124 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19125 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19126 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19127 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19128 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19129 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19130 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19131 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19132 over and over again.
19133
19134 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19135 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19136 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19137 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19138 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19139 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19140 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19141 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19142 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19143 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19144 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19145 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19146 see any cycling.
19147
19148 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19149 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19150 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19151 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19152 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19153 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19154 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19155 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19156 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19157
19158 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19159 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19160 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19161 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19162 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19163 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19164
19165 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19166 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19167 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19168 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19169 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19170
19171 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19172 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19173 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19174 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19175 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19176 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19177
19178 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19179 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19180 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19181 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19182 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19183
19184 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19185 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19186 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19187 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19188 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19189 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19190 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19191 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19192 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19193 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19194 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19195
19196 @end table
19197
19198
19199 @node Example Setup
19200 @subsection Example Setup
19201
19202 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19203 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19204 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19205
19206 @lisp
19207 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19208 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19209 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19210
19211 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19212 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19213 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19214
19215 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19216 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19217
19218 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19219 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19220 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19221 @end lisp
19222
19223 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19224 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19225 gnus}.
19226
19227 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19228 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19229 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19230 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19231 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19232 once.
19233
19234 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19235 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19236 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19237 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19238 back all the killed groups.)
19239
19240 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19241 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19242 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19243
19244
19245 @node Batching Agents
19246 @subsection Batching Agents
19247 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19248
19249 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19250 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19251 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19252
19253 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19254 following incantation:
19255
19256 @example
19257 #!/bin/sh
19258 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19259 @end example
19260
19261
19262 @node Agent Caveats
19263 @subsection Agent Caveats
19264
19265 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19266 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19267 may ask:
19268
19269 @table @dfn
19270 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19271
19272 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19273 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19274 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19275
19276 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19277 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19278
19279 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19280
19281 @end table
19282
19283 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19284 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19285 locally stored articles.
19286
19287
19288 @node Scoring
19289 @chapter Scoring
19290 @cindex scoring
19291
19292 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19293 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19294 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19295 attention!
19296
19297 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19298 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19299 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19300 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19301 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19302
19303 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19304 before generating the summary buffer.
19305
19306 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19307 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19308 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19309
19310 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19311 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19312 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19313 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19314
19315 @menu
19316 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19317 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19318 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19319 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19320 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19321 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19322 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19323 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19324 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19325 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19326 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19327 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19328 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19329 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19330 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19331 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19332 @end menu
19333
19334
19335 @node Summary Score Commands
19336 @section Summary Score Commands
19337 @cindex score commands
19338
19339 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19340 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19341 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19342 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19343 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19344
19345 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19346 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19347 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19348 score file the current one.
19349
19350 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19351
19352 @table @kbd
19353
19354 @item V s
19355 @kindex V s (Summary)
19356 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19357 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19358
19359 @item V S
19360 @kindex V S (Summary)
19361 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19362 Display the score of the current article
19363 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19364
19365 @item V t
19366 @kindex V t (Summary)
19367 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19368 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19369 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19370 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19371 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19372 score file and edit it.
19373
19374 @item V w
19375 @kindex V w (Summary)
19376 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19377 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19378
19379 @item V R
19380 @kindex V R (Summary)
19381 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19382 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19383 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19384 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19385 effect you're having.
19386
19387 @item V c
19388 @kindex V c (Summary)
19389 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19390 Make a different score file the current
19391 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19392
19393 @item V e
19394 @kindex V e (Summary)
19395 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19396 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19397 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19398 File Editing}).
19399
19400 @item V f
19401 @kindex V f (Summary)
19402 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19403 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19404 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19405
19406 @item V F
19407 @kindex V F (Summary)
19408 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19409 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19410 after editing score files.
19411
19412 @item V C
19413 @kindex V C (Summary)
19414 @findex gnus-score-customize
19415 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19416 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19417
19418 @end table
19419
19420 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19421
19422 @table @kbd
19423
19424 @item V m
19425 @kindex V m (Summary)
19426 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19427 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19428 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19429
19430 @item V x
19431 @kindex V x (Summary)
19432 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19433 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19434 expunge all articles below this score
19435 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19436 @end table
19437
19438 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19439 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19440 them.)
19441
19442 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19443 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19444
19445 @enumerate
19446 @item
19447 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19448 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19449 @item
19450 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19451 keys are available:
19452 @table @kbd
19453
19454 @item a
19455 Score on the author name.
19456
19457 @item s
19458 Score on the subject line.
19459
19460 @item x
19461 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19462
19463 @item r
19464 Score on the @code{References} line.
19465
19466 @item d
19467 Score on the date.
19468
19469 @item l
19470 Score on the number of lines.
19471
19472 @item i
19473 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19474
19475 @item e
19476 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19477 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19478
19479 @item f
19480 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19481 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19482 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19483
19484 @item b
19485 Score on the body.
19486
19487 @item h
19488 Score on the head.
19489
19490 @item t
19491 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19492 files.)
19493
19494 @end table
19495
19496 @item
19497 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19498 what headers you are scoring on.
19499
19500 @table @code
19501
19502 @item strings
19503
19504 @table @kbd
19505
19506 @item e
19507 Exact matching.
19508
19509 @item s
19510 Substring matching.
19511
19512 @item f
19513 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19514
19515 @item r
19516 Regexp matching
19517 @end table
19518
19519 @item date
19520 @table @kbd
19521
19522 @item b
19523 Before date.
19524
19525 @item a
19526 After date.
19527
19528 @item n
19529 This date.
19530 @end table
19531
19532 @item number
19533 @table @kbd
19534
19535 @item <
19536 Less than number.
19537
19538 @item =
19539 Equal to number.
19540
19541 @item >
19542 Greater than number.
19543 @end table
19544 @end table
19545
19546 @item
19547 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19548 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19549 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19550 file.
19551 @table @kbd
19552
19553 @item t
19554 Temporary score entry.
19555
19556 @item p
19557 Permanent score entry.
19558
19559 @item i
19560 Immediately scoring.
19561 @end table
19562
19563 @item
19564 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19565 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19566 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19567
19568 @end enumerate
19569
19570 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19571 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19572 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19573 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19574
19575 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19576 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19577 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19578 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19579 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19580
19581 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19582 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19583 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19584 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19585 current score file.
19586
19587 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19588 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19589 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19590
19591
19592 @node Group Score Commands
19593 @section Group Score Commands
19594 @cindex group score commands
19595
19596 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19597
19598 @table @kbd
19599
19600 @item W e
19601 @kindex W e (Group)
19602 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19603 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19604 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19605
19606 @item W f
19607 @kindex W f (Group)
19608 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19609 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19610 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19611 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19612
19613 @end table
19614
19615 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19616
19617 @findex gnus-batch-score
19618 @cindex batch scoring
19619 @example
19620 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19621 @end example
19622
19623
19624 @node Score Variables
19625 @section Score Variables
19626 @cindex score variables
19627
19628 @table @code
19629
19630 @item gnus-use-scoring
19631 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19632 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19633 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19634
19635 @item gnus-kill-killed
19636 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19637 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19638 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19639 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19640 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19641 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19642 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19643
19644 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19645 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19646 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19647 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19648 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19649
19650 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19651 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19652 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19653 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19654
19655 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19656 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19657 @cindex score cache
19658 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19659 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19660 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19661 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19662 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19663 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19664 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19665 be cached.
19666
19667 @item gnus-save-score
19668 @vindex gnus-save-score
19669 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19670 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19671 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19672
19673 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19674 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19675 across group visits.
19676
19677 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19678 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19679 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19680 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19681 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19682 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19683 manually entered data.
19684
19685 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19686 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19687 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19688
19689 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19690 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19691 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19692 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19693 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19694 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19695
19696 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19697 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19698 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19699 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19700
19701 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19702 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19703 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19704 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19705
19706 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19707 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19708 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19709 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19710
19711 Predefined functions available are:
19712 @table @code
19713
19714 @item gnus-score-find-single
19715 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19716 Only apply the group's own score file.
19717
19718 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19719 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19720 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19721 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19722 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19723 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19724 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19725 then a regexp match is done.
19726
19727 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19728 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19729
19730 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19731 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19732 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19733 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19734
19735 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19736 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19737 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19738 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19739 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19740 server.
19741
19742 @end table
19743 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19744 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19745 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19746 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19747 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19748 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19749 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19750 Phu.
19751
19752 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19753 overall score file, you could use the value
19754 @example
19755 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19756 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19757 @end example
19758
19759 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19760 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19761 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19762 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19763 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19764
19765 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19766 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19767 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19768 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19769 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19770 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19771 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19772 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19773
19774 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19775 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19776 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19777
19778 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19779 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19780 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19781 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19782 threading---according to the current value of
19783 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19784 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19785 simplified in this manner.
19786
19787 @end table
19788
19789
19790 @node Score File Format
19791 @section Score File Format
19792 @cindex score file format
19793
19794 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19795 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19796 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19797
19798 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19799
19800 @lisp
19801 (("from"
19802 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19803 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19804 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19805 ("subject"
19806 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19807 ("xref"
19808 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19809 ("lines"
19810 (2 -100 nil <))
19811 (mark 0)
19812 (expunge -1000)
19813 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19814 (read-only nil)
19815 (orphan -10)
19816 (adapt t)
19817 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19818 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19819 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19820 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19821 (eval (ding)))
19822 @end lisp
19823
19824 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19825 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19826
19827 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19828 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19829 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19830
19831 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19832
19833 @table @code
19834
19835 @item STRING
19836 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19837 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19838 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19839 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19840 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19841 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19842 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19843 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19844 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19845 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19846 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19847 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19848 to articles that matches these score entries.
19849
19850 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19851 score entry has one to four elements.
19852 @enumerate
19853
19854 @item
19855 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19856 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19857 integer.
19858
19859 @item
19860 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19861 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19862 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19863 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19864 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19865 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19866
19867 @item
19868 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19869 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19870 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19871 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19872 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19873
19874 @item
19875 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19876 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19877 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19878 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19879 @table @dfn
19880
19881 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19882 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19883 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19884 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19885 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19886 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19887 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19888 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19889 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19890 instead, if you feel like.
19891
19892 @item Extra
19893 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19894 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19895 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19896 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19897 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19898 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19899 overviews:
19900
19901 @lisp
19902 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19903 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19904 @end lisp
19905
19906 @item Lines, Chars
19907 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19908 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19909
19910 These predicates are true if
19911
19912 @example
19913 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19914 @end example
19915
19916 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19917 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19918 following form:
19919
19920 @lisp
19921 (< header-value 4)
19922 @end lisp
19923
19924 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19925 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19926 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19927 it's not. I think.)
19928
19929 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19930 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19931 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19932 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19933
19934 @item Date
19935 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19936 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19937 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19938 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19939 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19940 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19941 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19942
19943 @cindex ISO8601
19944 @cindex date
19945 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19946 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19947 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19948 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19949 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19950 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19951 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19952 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19953 whole family, eh?)
19954
19955 @item Head, Body, All
19956 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19957 header uses.
19958
19959 @item Followup
19960 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19961 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19962 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19963 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19964 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19965 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19966 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19967 files.)
19968
19969 @item Thread
19970 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19971 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19972 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19973 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19974 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19975 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19976 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19977 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19978 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19979 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19980 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19981 @end table
19982 @end enumerate
19983
19984 @cindex score file atoms
19985 @item mark
19986 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19987 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19988
19989 @item expunge
19990 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19991 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19992
19993 @item mark-and-expunge
19994 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19995 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19996 summary buffer.
19997
19998 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19999 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20000 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20001 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20002 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20003
20004 @item files
20005 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20006 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20007 this one was.
20008
20009 @item exclude-files
20010 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20011 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20012 other.
20013
20014 @item eval
20015 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20016 ignored when handling global score files.
20017
20018 @item read-only
20019 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20020 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20021 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20022 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20023
20024 @item orphan
20025 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20026 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20027 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20028 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20029
20030 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20031
20032 @example
20033 (orphan -500)
20034 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20035 @end example
20036
20037 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20038 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20039 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20040 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20041 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20042
20043 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20044 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20045 scoring rules exist.
20046
20047 @item adapt
20048 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20049 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20050 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20051 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20052 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20053 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20054 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20055 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20056 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20057 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20058 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20059 it.
20060
20061 @item adapt-file
20062 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20063 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20064 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20065 file for a number of groups.
20066
20067 @item local
20068 @cindex local variables
20069 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20070 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20071 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20072 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20073 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20074 be evaluated.
20075 @end table
20076
20077
20078 @node Score File Editing
20079 @section Score File Editing
20080
20081 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20082 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20083 with a mode for that.
20084
20085 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20086 additional commands:
20087
20088 @table @kbd
20089
20090 @item C-c C-c
20091 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20092 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20093 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20094 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20095
20096 @item C-c C-d
20097 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20098 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20099 Insert the current date in numerical format
20100 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20101 you were wondering.
20102
20103 @item C-c C-p
20104 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20105 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20106 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20107 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20108 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20109 you.
20110
20111 @end table
20112
20113 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20114
20115 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20116 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20117
20118 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20119 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20120
20121
20122 @node Adaptive Scoring
20123 @section Adaptive Scoring
20124 @cindex adaptive scoring
20125
20126 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20127 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20128 stupidity, to be precise.
20129
20130 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20131 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20132 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20133 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20134 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20135 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20136 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20137 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20138 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20139
20140 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20141 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20142 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20143 might look something like this:
20144
20145 @lisp
20146 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20147 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20148 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20149 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20150 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20151 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20152 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20153 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20154 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20155 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20156 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20157 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20158 @end lisp
20159
20160 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20161 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20162 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20163 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20164 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20165 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20166 entries.
20167
20168 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20169 will be applied to each article.
20170
20171 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20172 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20173 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20174 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20175
20176 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20177 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20178 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20179 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20180
20181 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20182 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20183 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20184 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20185
20186 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20187 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20188 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20189 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20190 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20191 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20192
20193 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20194 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20195 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20196
20197 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20198 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20199 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20200
20201 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20202 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20203 let you use different rules in different groups.
20204
20205 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20206 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20207 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20208 is @file{ADAPT}.
20209
20210 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20211 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20212 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20213 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20214
20215 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20216 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20217 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20218 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20219 the length of the match is less than
20220 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20221 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20222 this problem.
20223
20224 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20225 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20226 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20227 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20228 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20229
20230 @lisp
20231 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20232 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20233 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20234 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20235 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20236 @end lisp
20237
20238 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20239 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20240 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20241 score with 30 points.
20242
20243 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20244 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20245 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20246 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20247 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20248
20249 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20250 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20251 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20252 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20253 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20254
20255 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20256 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20257 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20258 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20259
20260 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20261 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20262 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20263 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20264
20265 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20266 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20267 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20268 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20269 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20270
20271 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20272 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20273 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20274
20275 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20276 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20277 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20278 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20279
20280
20281 @node Home Score File
20282 @section Home Score File
20283
20284 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20285 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20286 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20287 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20288
20289 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20290 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20291 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20292
20293 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20294 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20295 be:
20296
20297 @enumerate
20298 @item
20299 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20300 groups.
20301
20302 @item
20303 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20304 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20305 parameter.
20306
20307 @item
20308 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20309
20310 @enumerate
20311 @item
20312 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20313 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20314
20315 @item
20316 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20317 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20318 name of the group as the parameter.
20319
20320 @item
20321 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20322 @end enumerate
20323
20324 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20325 for matches.
20326
20327 @end enumerate
20328
20329 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20330
20331 @lisp
20332 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20333 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20334 @end lisp
20335
20336 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20337 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20338
20339 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20340 @lisp
20341 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20342 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20343 @end lisp
20344
20345 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20346 Other functions include
20347
20348 @table @code
20349 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20350 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20351 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20352 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20353
20354 @end table
20355
20356 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20357 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20358 their own home score files:
20359
20360 @lisp
20361 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20362 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20363 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20364 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20365 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20366 @end lisp
20367
20368 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20369 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20370 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20371 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20372 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20373
20374 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20375 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20376 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20377 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20378 precedence over this variable.
20379
20380
20381 @node Followups To Yourself
20382 @section Followups To Yourself
20383
20384 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20385 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20386 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20387 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20388 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20389 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20390
20391 @table @code
20392
20393 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20394 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20395 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20396 article.
20397
20398 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20399 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20400 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20401 your own article.
20402 @end table
20403
20404 @vindex message-sent-hook
20405 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20406 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20407 @lisp
20408 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20409 @end lisp
20410
20411
20412 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20413 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20414 mine:
20415
20416 @example
20417 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20418 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20419 @end example
20420
20421 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20422 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20423 myself:
20424
20425 @lisp
20426 ("references"
20427 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20428 1000 nil r))
20429 @end lisp
20430
20431 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20432 is system-dependent.
20433
20434
20435 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20436 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20437 @cindex scoring on other headers
20438
20439 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20440 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20441 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20442 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20443 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20444
20445 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20446 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20447 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20448 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20449 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20450 inhibited for all groups.
20451
20452 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20453 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20454 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20455 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20456 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20457
20458 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20459
20460 @lisp
20461 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20462 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20463 @end lisp
20464
20465 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20466 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20467 time if you have much mail.
20468
20469 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20470 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20471
20472 See? Simple.
20473
20474
20475 @node Scoring Tips
20476 @section Scoring Tips
20477 @cindex scoring tips
20478
20479 @table @dfn
20480
20481 @item Crossposts
20482 @cindex crossposts
20483 @cindex scoring crossposts
20484 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20485 the @code{Xref} header.
20486 @lisp
20487 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20488 @end lisp
20489
20490 @item Multiple crossposts
20491 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20492 more than, say, 3 groups:
20493 @lisp
20494 ("xref"
20495 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20496 -1000 nil r))
20497 @end lisp
20498
20499 @item Matching on the body
20500 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20501 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20502 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20503 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20504 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20505 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20506 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20507 the matches.
20508
20509 @item Marking as read
20510 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20511 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20512 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20513 @lisp
20514 ((mark -100))
20515 @end lisp
20516 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20517
20518 @item Negated character classes
20519 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20520 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20521 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20522 @end table
20523
20524
20525 @node Reverse Scoring
20526 @section Reverse Scoring
20527 @cindex reverse scoring
20528
20529 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20530 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20531 like this in your score file:
20532
20533 @lisp
20534 (("subject"
20535 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20536 (mark 1)
20537 (expunge 1))
20538 @end lisp
20539
20540 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20541 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20542
20543
20544 @node Global Score Files
20545 @section Global Score Files
20546 @cindex global score files
20547
20548 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20549 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20550 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20551
20552 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20553 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20554 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20555
20556 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20557 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20558 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20559 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20560 files are applicable to which group.
20561
20562 To use the score file
20563 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20564 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20565 say this:
20566
20567 @lisp
20568 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20569 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20570 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20571 @end lisp
20572
20573 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20574 @noindent
20575 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20576 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20577 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20578 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20579
20580 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20581 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20582
20583 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20584 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20585 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20586 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20587 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20588 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20589
20590 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20591 head:
20592
20593 @itemize @bullet
20594
20595 @item
20596 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20597 @item
20598 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20599 @item
20600 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20601 @item
20602 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20603 lowered out of existence.
20604 @item
20605 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20606 articles completely.
20607
20608 @item
20609 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20610 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20611 old articles for a long time.
20612 @end itemize
20613
20614 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20615 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20616 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20617 holding our breath yet?
20618
20619
20620 @node Kill Files
20621 @section Kill Files
20622 @cindex kill files
20623
20624 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20625 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20626 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20627
20628 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20629 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20630 files into score files.
20631
20632 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20633 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20634 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20635 that isn't a very good idea.
20636
20637 Normal kill files look like this:
20638
20639 @lisp
20640 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20641 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20642 (gnus-expunge "X")
20643 @end lisp
20644
20645 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20646 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20647
20648 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20649 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20650 interpreting it.
20651
20652 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20653
20654 @table @kbd
20655
20656 @item M-k
20657 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20658 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20659 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20660
20661 @item M-K
20662 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20663 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20664 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20665 @end table
20666
20667 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20668
20669 @table @kbd
20670
20671 @item M-k
20672 @kindex M-k (Group)
20673 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20674 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20675
20676 @item M-K
20677 @kindex M-K (Group)
20678 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20679 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20680 @end table
20681
20682 Kill file variables:
20683
20684 @table @code
20685 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20686 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20687 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20688 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20689 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20690 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20691 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20692
20693 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20694 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20695 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20696 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20697 kills.
20698
20699 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20700 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20701 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20702 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20703 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20704 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20705 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20706 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20707 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20708
20709 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20710 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20711 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20712
20713 @end table
20714
20715
20716 @node Converting Kill Files
20717 @section Converting Kill Files
20718 @cindex kill files
20719 @cindex converting kill files
20720
20721 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20722 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20723 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20724 by hand.
20725
20726 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20727 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20728 from
20729 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20730
20731 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20732 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20733 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20734 before.
20735
20736
20737 @node Advanced Scoring
20738 @section Advanced Scoring
20739
20740 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20741 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20742 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20743 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20744 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20745
20746 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20747 scoring patterns.
20748
20749 @menu
20750 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20751 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20752 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20753 @end menu
20754
20755
20756 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20757 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20758
20759 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20760 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20761 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20762 non-@code{nil} value.
20763
20764 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20765 operator, and various match operators.
20766
20767 Logical operators:
20768
20769 @table @code
20770 @item &
20771 @itemx and
20772 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20773 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20774 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20775 @code{true}.
20776
20777 @item |
20778 @itemx or
20779 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20780 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20781 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20782
20783 @item !
20784 @itemx not
20785 @itemx ¬
20786 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20787 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20788
20789 @end table
20790
20791 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20792 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20793 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20794 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20795 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20796 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20797 the ancestry you want to go.
20798
20799 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20800 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20801 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20802 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20803 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20804
20805
20806 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20807 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20808
20809 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20810 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20811 of parentheses.
20812
20813 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20814 when he's talking about Gnus:
20815
20816 @example
20817 @group
20818 ((&
20819 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20820 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20821 1000)
20822 @end group
20823 @end example
20824
20825 Quite simple, huh?
20826
20827 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20828
20829 @example
20830 ((&
20831 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20832 (|
20833 ("subject" "Gnus")
20834 ("lines" 100 >)))
20835 1000)
20836 @end example
20837
20838 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20839 really don't want to read what he's written:
20840
20841 @example
20842 ((&
20843 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20844 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20845 -100000)
20846 @end example
20847
20848 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20849 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20850 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20851 very interesting:
20852
20853 @example
20854 ((&
20855 (1-
20856 (&
20857 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20858 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20859 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20860 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20861 1000)
20862 @end example
20863
20864 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20865 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20866 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20867 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20868
20869 @example
20870 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20871 -200)
20872 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20873 200)
20874 @end example
20875
20876 The possibilities are endless.
20877
20878 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20879 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20880
20881 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20882 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20883 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20884 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20885 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20886 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20887 @samp{subject}) first.
20888
20889 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20890 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20891 something like:
20892
20893 @example
20894 ...
20895 (1-
20896 (1-
20897 ("from" "lars")))
20898 ...
20899 @end example
20900
20901 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20902 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20903
20904 @example
20905 (1-
20906 (&
20907 ("from" "Lars")
20908 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20909 @end example
20910
20911 than it is to say:
20912
20913 @example
20914 (&
20915 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20916 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20917 @end example
20918
20919
20920 @node Score Decays
20921 @section Score Decays
20922 @cindex score decays
20923 @cindex decays
20924
20925 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20926 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20927 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20928 use them in any sensible way.
20929
20930 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20931 @findex gnus-decay-score
20932 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20933 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20934 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20935 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20936 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20937 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
20938 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
20939 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
20940 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
20941 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
20942 function:
20943
20944 @lisp
20945 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20946 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20947 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20948 (let ((n (- score
20949 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20950 (min (abs score)
20951 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20952 (* (abs score)
20953 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20954 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20955 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
20956 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20957 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20958 (string-to-number
20959 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20960 (floor n))))
20961 @end lisp
20962
20963 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20964 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20965 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20966 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20967
20968 @enumerate
20969 @item
20970 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20971
20972 @item
20973 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20974
20975 @item
20976 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20977 score.
20978 @end enumerate
20979
20980 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20981 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20982 the new score, which should be an integer.
20983
20984 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20985 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20986
20987 @node Searching
20988 @chapter Searching
20989 @cindex searching
20990
20991 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
20992 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
20993 as well.
20994
20995 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
20996 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
20997 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
20998 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
20999
21000 @menu
21001 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21002 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21003 @end menu
21004
21005 @node nnir
21006 @section nnir
21007 @cindex nnir
21008
21009 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21010 within gnus.
21011
21012 @menu
21013 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21014 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21015 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21016 @end menu
21017
21018 @node What is nnir?
21019 @subsection What is nnir?
21020
21021 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21022 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21023 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21024 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21025 interface.
21026
21027 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21028 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21029 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21030
21031
21032 @node Basic Usage
21033 @subsection Basic Usage
21034
21035 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21036 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21037 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21038 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21039 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21040 using the usual commands.
21041
21042 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21043 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21044 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21045 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21046 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21047 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21048 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21049 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21050 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21051 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21052 whatever. Go nuts.
21053
21054 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21055 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21056 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21057 will search all the groups under that heading.
21058
21059 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21060 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21061 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21062 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21063 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21064
21065 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21066 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21067 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21068 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21069 special search features for each engine separately.
21070
21071
21072 @node Setting up nnir
21073 @subsection Setting up nnir
21074
21075 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21076 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21077 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21078 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21079 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21080 a backend.
21081
21082 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21083 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21084 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21085 query language anyway.
21086
21087 @menu
21088 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21089 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21090 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21091 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21092 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21093 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21094 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21095 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21096 @end menu
21097
21098 @node Associating Engines
21099 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21100
21101
21102 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21103 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21104 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21105 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21106 named @code{home} you can use
21107
21108 @lisp
21109 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21110 '((nnml "home"
21111 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21112 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21113 @end lisp
21114
21115 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21116 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21117 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21118 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21119 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21120 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21121 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21122 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21123 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21124 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21125 could change this to
21126
21127 @lisp
21128 '((nnimap . namazu)
21129 (nntp . gmane))
21130 @end lisp
21131
21132 @node The imap Engine
21133 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21134
21135 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21136
21137 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21138 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21139 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21140
21141 @table @samp
21142
21143 @item Boolean query operators
21144 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21145 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21146 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21147 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
21148 term.
21149
21150 @item Automatic AND queries
21151 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21152 expression intended to match all components.
21153
21154 @item Phrase searches
21155 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21156 literal string.
21157
21158 @end table
21159
21160 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21161 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21162 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21163 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21164 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21165 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21166 the query to the Message-ID header.
21167
21168 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21169 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21170 RFC3501.
21171
21172 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21173 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21174 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21175
21176 @lisp
21177 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21178 @end lisp
21179
21180 @node The gmane Engine
21181 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21182
21183 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21184
21185 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21186
21187 @table @samp
21188 @item Boolean query operators
21189 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21190 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21191 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21192 recognized.
21193
21194 @item Required and excluded terms
21195 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21196 @minus{}american
21197
21198 @item Unicode handling
21199 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21200 in any language.
21201
21202 @item Stopwords
21203 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21204 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21205 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21206
21207 @end table
21208
21209 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21210 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21211 name (or part of a name) to match.
21212
21213 @node The swish++ Engine
21214 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21215
21216 FIXME: Say something more here.
21217
21218 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21219 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21220
21221 @table @code
21222
21223 @item nnir-swish++-program
21224 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21225
21226 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21227 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21228 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21229
21230 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21231 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21232 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21233
21234 @end table
21235
21236 @node The swish-e Engine
21237 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21238
21239 FIXME: Say something more here.
21240
21241 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21242 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21243
21244 @table @code
21245
21246 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21247 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21248
21249 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21250 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21251 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21252
21253 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21254 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21255 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21256
21257 @end table
21258
21259 @node The namazu Engine
21260 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21261
21262 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21263 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21264 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21265 variable.
21266
21267 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21268 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21269 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21270 instead of `.').
21271
21272 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21273 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21274 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21275 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21276 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21277 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21278 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21279
21280 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21281 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21282 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21283 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21284 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21285 information on valid switches.
21286
21287 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21288 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21289
21290 @cartouche
21291 @example
21292 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21293
21294 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21295 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21296
21297 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21298 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21299
21300 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21301 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21302
21303 # The max length of a word.
21304 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21305
21306 # The max length of a field.
21307 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21308 @end example
21309 @end cartouche
21310
21311 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21312 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21313 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21314 the following command:
21315
21316 @example
21317 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21318 @end example
21319
21320 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21321 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21322
21323 @node The hyrex Engine
21324 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21325 This engine is obsolete.
21326
21327 @node Customizations
21328 @subsubsection Customizations
21329
21330 @table @code
21331
21332 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21333 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
21334 are
21335 @example
21336 (nnimap . imap)
21337 (nntp . gmane)
21338 @end example
21339
21340 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21341 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21342 when searching all groups on a server.
21343
21344 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21345 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21346 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21347 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21348
21349 @example
21350 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21351 %G Article original full group name (string)
21352 %g Article original short group name (string)
21353 @end example
21354
21355 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21356
21357 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21358 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21359 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21360 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21361 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21362 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21363 should return @code{nil}
21364
21365 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21366 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21367
21368
21369 @end table
21370
21371
21372 @node nnmairix
21373 @section nnmairix
21374
21375 @cindex mairix
21376 @cindex nnmairix
21377 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21378 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21379 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21380 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21381
21382 @menu
21383 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21384 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21385 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21386 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21387 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21388 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21389 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21390 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21391 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21392 @end menu
21393
21394 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21395 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21396 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21397
21398 @node About mairix
21399 @subsection About mairix
21400
21401 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21402 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21403 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21404 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21405 be found at
21406 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21407
21408 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21409 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21410 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21411 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21412 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21413 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21414 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21415 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21416 up.
21417
21418 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21419 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21420 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21421 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21422 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21423 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21424 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21425 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21426 searches.
21427
21428 @node nnmairix requirements
21429 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21430
21431 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21432 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21433 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21434 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21435
21436 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21437 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21438 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21439 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21440
21441 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21442 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21443 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21444 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21445 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21446 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21447
21448 @node What nnmairix does
21449 @subsection What nnmairix does
21450
21451 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21452 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21453 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21454 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21455 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21456 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21457 mails are in different folders.
21458
21459 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21460 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21461 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21462 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21463 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21464 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21465
21466 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21467 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21468 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21469 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21470 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21471 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21472 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21473 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21474 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21475 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21476 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21477
21478 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21479 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21480 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21481 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21482 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21483 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21484 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21485 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21486 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21487 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21488 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21489 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21490 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21491 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21492 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21493 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21494
21495 @node Setting up mairix
21496 @subsection Setting up mairix
21497
21498 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21499
21500 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21501 (at least) the following entries:
21502
21503 @example
21504 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21505 base=~/Maildir
21506 @end example
21507
21508 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21509 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21510 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21511 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21512
21513 @example
21514 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21515 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21516 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21517 @end example
21518
21519 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21520 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21521 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21522 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21523 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21524
21525 @example
21526 omit=zz_mairix-*
21527 @end example
21528
21529 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21530 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21531 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21532 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21533
21534 @example
21535 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21536 database= ... location of database file ...
21537 @end example
21538
21539 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21540 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21541 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21542
21543 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21544
21545 @example
21546 base=~/Maildir
21547 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21548 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21549 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21550 mformat=maildir
21551 omit=zz_mairix-*
21552 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21553 @end example
21554
21555 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21556 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21557 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21558 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21559 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21560 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21561 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21562 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21563 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21564 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21565 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21566 The other lines should be obvious.
21567
21568 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21569 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21570 than you are used to.
21571
21572 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21573 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21574 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21575
21576 @node Configuring nnmairix
21577 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21578
21579 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21580 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21581 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21582 server. You will have to specify the following:
21583
21584 @itemize @bullet
21585
21586 @item
21587 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21588 want.
21589
21590 @item
21591 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21592 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21593 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21594 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21595 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21596 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21597 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21598 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21599 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21600 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21601 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21602 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21603 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21604 @code{nnimap} server here.
21605
21606 @item
21607 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21608 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21609 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21610 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21611 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21612 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21613 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21614
21615 @item
21616 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21617 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21618 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21619 like.
21620
21621 @item
21622 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21623 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21624 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21625 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21626 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21627
21628 @end itemize
21629
21630 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21631 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21632
21633 In group mode:
21634
21635 @table @kbd
21636
21637 @item G b c
21638 @kindex G b c (Group)
21639 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21640 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21641 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21642 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21643
21644 @item G b s
21645 @kindex G b s (Group)
21646 @findex nnmairix-search
21647 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21648 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21649 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21650
21651 @item G b m
21652 @kindex G b m (Group)
21653 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21654 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21655 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21656 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21657
21658 @item G b i
21659 @kindex G b i (Group)
21660 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21661 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21662 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21663
21664 @item G b g
21665 @kindex G b g (Group)
21666 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21667 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21668 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21669 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21670 @kbd{M-g}.
21671
21672 @item G b q
21673 @kindex G b q (Group)
21674 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21675 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21676 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21677
21678 @item G b t
21679 @kindex G b t (Group)
21680 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21681 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21682 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21683 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21684
21685 @item G b u
21686 @kindex G b u (Group)
21687 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21688 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21689 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21690 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21691 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21692 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21693 options).
21694
21695 @item G b r
21696 @kindex G b r (Group)
21697 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21698 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21699 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21700
21701 @item G b d
21702 @kindex G b d (Group)
21703 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21704 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21705 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21706 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21707
21708 @item G b a
21709 @kindex G b a (Group)
21710 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21711 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21712 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21713 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21714 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21715 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21716 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21717 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21718 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21719
21720 @item G b p
21721 @kindex G b p (Group)
21722 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21723 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21724 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21725 marks}).
21726
21727 @item G b o
21728 @kindex G b o (Group)
21729 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21730 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21731 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21732
21733 @end table
21734
21735 In summary mode:
21736
21737 @table @kbd
21738
21739 @item $ m
21740 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21741 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21742 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21743 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21744 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21745
21746 @item $ g
21747 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21748 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21749 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21750 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21751 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21752
21753 @item $ t
21754 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21755 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21756 Searches thread for the current article
21757 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21758 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21759 current article and enabled threads.
21760
21761 @item $ f
21762 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21763 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21764 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21765 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21766 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21767
21768 @item $ o
21769 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21770 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21771 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21772 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21773 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21774 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21775 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21776 article file name as a fallback method.
21777
21778 @item $ u
21779 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21780 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21781 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21782 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21783 tips and tricks}).
21784
21785 @end table
21786
21787 @node Propagating marks
21788 @subsection Propagating marks
21789
21790 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21791 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21792 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21793
21794 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21795
21796 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21797 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21798 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21799 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21800 be useful to you.
21801
21802 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21803 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21804 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21805 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21806 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21807 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21808 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21809 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21810 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21811 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21812
21813 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21814 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21815 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21816 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21817 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21818 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21819 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21820
21821 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21822 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21823 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21824 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21825 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21826 even more cumbersome.
21827
21828 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21829 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21830 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21831
21832 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21833 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21834 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21835 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21836 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21837 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21838 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21839
21840 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21841 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21842 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21843 magically be set for the original article, too.
21844
21845 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21846
21847 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21848 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21849 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21850 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21851 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21852 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21853 details).
21854
21855 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21856 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21857 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21858 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21859 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21860 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21861 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21862
21863 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21864 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21865 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21866 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21867 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21868 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21869 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21870
21871 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21872 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21873 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21874 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21875 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21876 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21877 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21878 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21879 maildir as its file format.
21880
21881 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21882 If you work with this setup, just set
21883 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21884 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21885 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21886 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21887 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21888 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21889
21890 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21891 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21892
21893 @itemize
21894 @item
21895 Checking Mail
21896
21897 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21898 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21899 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21900 Levels}).
21901
21902 I use the following to check for mails:
21903
21904 @lisp
21905 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21906 (interactive "P")
21907 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21908 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21909 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21910 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21911
21912 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21913 @end lisp
21914
21915 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21916 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21917 details.
21918
21919 @item
21920 Example: search group for ticked articles
21921
21922 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21923 articles always stay unread:
21924
21925 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
21926 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21927
21928 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21929 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21930
21931 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21932 group? There are two options: You may simply use
21933 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
21934 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
21935 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
21936 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
21937 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
21938 e.g., by marking an article as read.
21939
21940 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
21941 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
21942 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
21943 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
21944 snippet and the doc string for details.
21945
21946 @item
21947 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
21948
21949 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
21950 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
21951 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
21952 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
21953 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
21954 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
21955 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
21956 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
21957 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
21958 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
21959 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
21960 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
21961
21962 @lisp
21963 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
21964 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
21965 @end lisp
21966
21967 @end itemize
21968
21969 @node nnmairix caveats
21970 @subsection nnmairix caveats
21971
21972 @itemize
21973 @item
21974 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
21975 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
21976 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
21977 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
21978 an example server definition:
21979
21980 @lisp
21981 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
21982 @end lisp
21983
21984 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
21985 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
21986 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
21987 mairix.)
21988
21989 @item
21990 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
21991 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
21992 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
21993 @emph{extra careful} if you use
21994 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
21995 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
21996 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
21997
21998 @item
21999 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22000 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22001
22002 @item
22003 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22004 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22005
22006 @item
22007 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22008
22009 @item
22010 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22011 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22012 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22013 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22014 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22015 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22016 folders.
22017
22018 @item
22019 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22020 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22021 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22022 it is gone for good.
22023
22024 @item
22025 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22026 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22027 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22028 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22029 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22030 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22031 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22032 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22033 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22034
22035 @item
22036 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22037 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22038
22039 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22040 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22041 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22042 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22043 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22044 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22045 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22046 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22047 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22048 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22049 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22050 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22051
22052 @end itemize
22053
22054 @iftex
22055 @iflatex
22056 @chapter Message
22057 @include message.texi
22058 @chapter Emacs MIME
22059 @include emacs-mime.texi
22060 @chapter Sieve
22061 @include sieve.texi
22062 @chapter EasyPG
22063 @include epa.texi
22064 @chapter SASL
22065 @include sasl.texi
22066 @end iflatex
22067 @end iftex
22068
22069 @node Various
22070 @chapter Various
22071
22072 @menu
22073 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22074 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22075 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22076 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22077 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22078 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22079 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22080 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22081 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22082 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22083 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22084 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22085 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22086 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22087 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22088 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22089 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22090 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22091 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22092 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22093 @end menu
22094
22095
22096 @node Process/Prefix
22097 @section Process/Prefix
22098 @cindex process/prefix convention
22099
22100 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22101 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22102
22103 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22104 command to be performed on.
22105
22106 It goes like this:
22107
22108 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22109 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22110 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22111 with the current one.
22112
22113 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22114 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22115 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22116
22117 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22118 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22119 the process mark.
22120
22121 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22122 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22123
22124 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22125 are avoided.
22126
22127 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22128 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22129 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22130 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22131
22132 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22133 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22134 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22135 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22136 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22137 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22138 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22139 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22140
22141 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22142 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22143 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22144 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22145 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22146
22147
22148 @node Interactive
22149 @section Interactive
22150 @cindex interaction
22151
22152 @table @code
22153
22154 @item gnus-novice-user
22155 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22156 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22157 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22158 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22159 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22160 default.
22161
22162 @item gnus-expert-user
22163 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22164 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22165 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22166 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22167 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22168 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22169 confirmation.
22170
22171 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22172 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22173 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22174 is @code{t} by default.
22175
22176 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22177 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22178 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22179 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22180 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22181 @end table
22182
22183
22184 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22185 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22186 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22187
22188 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22189 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22190 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22191 rule of 900 to the current article.
22192
22193 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22194 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22195 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22196 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22197 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22198 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22199 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22200
22201 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22202 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22203 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22204 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22205 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22206 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22207 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22208 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22209 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22210
22211 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22212 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22213 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22214
22215 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22216 Interactive}.
22217
22218
22219 @node Formatting Variables
22220 @section Formatting Variables
22221 @cindex formatting variables
22222
22223 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22224 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22225 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22226 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22227 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22228 be annoyed by.
22229
22230 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22231 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22232 lots of percentages everywhere.
22233
22234 @menu
22235 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22236 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22237 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22238 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22239 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22240 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22241 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22242 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22243 @end menu
22244
22245 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22246 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22247 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22248 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22249 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22250 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22251 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22252 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22253
22254 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22255 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22256
22257 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22258 @findex gnus-update-format
22259 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22260 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22261 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22262 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22263
22264
22265
22266 @node Formatting Basics
22267 @subsection Formatting Basics
22268
22269 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22270 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22271 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22272
22273 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22274 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22275 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22276 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22277 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22278 the right instead.
22279
22280 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22281 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22282 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22283 less than 4 characters wide.
22284
22285 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22286 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22287
22288
22289 @node Mode Line Formatting
22290 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22291
22292 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22293 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22294 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22295 with the following two differences:
22296
22297 @enumerate
22298
22299 @item
22300 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22301
22302 @item
22303 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22304 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22305 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22306 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22307 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22308 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22309 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22310
22311 @end enumerate
22312
22313
22314 @node Advanced Formatting
22315 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22316
22317 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22318 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22319 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22320 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22321
22322 These are the valid modifiers:
22323
22324 @table @code
22325 @item pad
22326 @itemx pad-left
22327 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22328 length.
22329
22330 @item pad-right
22331 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22332 length.
22333
22334 @item max
22335 @itemx max-left
22336 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22337
22338 @item max-right
22339 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22340 length.
22341
22342 @item cut
22343 @itemx cut-left
22344 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22345
22346 @item cut-right
22347 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22348
22349 @item ignore
22350 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22351
22352 @item form
22353 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22354 used.
22355
22356 Here's an example:
22357
22358 @lisp
22359 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22360 @end lisp
22361
22362 @end table
22363
22364 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22365 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22366 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22367 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22368 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22369 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22370 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22371
22372 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22373 last operation, padding.
22374
22375
22376 @node User-Defined Specs
22377 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22378
22379 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22380 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22381 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22382 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22383 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22384 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22385 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22386 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22387 should protect against that.
22388
22389 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22390 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22391
22392 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22393 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22394 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22395 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22396 inserted.
22397
22398
22399 @node Formatting Fonts
22400 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22401
22402 @cindex %(, %)
22403 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22404 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22405 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22406 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22407 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22408 over it.
22409
22410 @cindex %@{, %@}
22411 @vindex gnus-face-0
22412 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22413 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22414 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22415 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22416 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22417 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22418
22419 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22420 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22421 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22422 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22423 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22424 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22425 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22426 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22427 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22428 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22429 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22430 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22431 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22432 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22433 paragraph.)
22434
22435 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22436
22437 @lisp
22438 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22439 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22440 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22441
22442 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22443 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22444 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22445 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22446 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22447 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22448 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22449
22450 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22451 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22452 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22453 @end lisp
22454
22455 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22456 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22457
22458 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22459 mode-line variables.
22460
22461 @node Positioning Point
22462 @subsection Positioning Point
22463
22464 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22465 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22466 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22467
22468 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22469
22470 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22471 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22472 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22473
22474 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22475 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22476 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22477 place point there.
22478
22479
22480 @node Tabulation
22481 @subsection Tabulation
22482
22483 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22484 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22485 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22486 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22487
22488 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22489 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22490
22491 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22492 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22493 This is the soft tabulator.
22494
22495 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22496 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22497 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22498
22499
22500 @node Wide Characters
22501 @subsection Wide Characters
22502
22503 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22504 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22505 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22506
22507 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22508 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22509 these countries, that's not true.
22510
22511 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22512 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22513 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22514 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22515 for Emacs.
22516
22517
22518 @node Window Layout
22519 @section Window Layout
22520 @cindex window layout
22521
22522 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22523
22524 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22525 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22526 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22527 @code{t} by default.
22528
22529 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22530 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22531
22532 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22533 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22534 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22535
22536 @lisp
22537 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22538 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22539 (article 1.0))))
22540 @end lisp
22541
22542 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22543 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22544 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22545 possible names is listed below.
22546
22547 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22548 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22549
22550 @lisp
22551 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22552 (article 1.0)))
22553 @end lisp
22554
22555 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22556 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22557 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22558 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22559 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22560 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22561 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22562 size spec per split.
22563
22564 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22565 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22566 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22567 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22568 present) gets focus.
22569
22570 Here's a more complicated example:
22571
22572 @lisp
22573 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22574 (summary 0.25 point)
22575 (article 1.0)))
22576 @end lisp
22577
22578 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22579 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22580 occupy, not a percentage.
22581
22582 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22583 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22584 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22585 be used as a split.
22586
22587 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22588
22589 @lisp
22590 (article (horizontal 1.0
22591 (vertical 0.5
22592 (group 1.0))
22593 (vertical 1.0
22594 (summary 0.25 point)
22595 (article 1.0))))
22596 @end lisp
22597
22598 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22599 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22600
22601 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22602 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22603 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22604 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22605 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22606
22607 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22608 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22609 lines from the splits.
22610
22611 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22612 may look like:
22613
22614 @example
22615 @group
22616 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22617 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22618 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22619 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22620 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22621 size = number | frame-params
22622 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22623 @end group
22624 @end example
22625
22626 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22627 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22628 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22629 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22630
22631 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22632 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22633 @cindex window height
22634 @cindex window width
22635 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22636 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22637 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22638 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22639 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22640 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22641
22642 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22643 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22644 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22645 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22646
22647 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22648 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22649 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22650 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22651 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22652 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22653 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22654 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22655 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22656 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22657 configuration list.
22658
22659 @lisp
22660 (gnus-configure-frame
22661 '(horizontal 1.0
22662 (vertical 10
22663 (group 1.0)
22664 (article 0.3 point))
22665 (vertical 1.0
22666 (article 1.0)
22667 (horizontal 4
22668 (group 1.0)
22669 (article 10)))))
22670 @end lisp
22671
22672 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22673 @code{frame} split:
22674
22675 @lisp
22676 (gnus-configure-frame
22677 '(frame 1.0
22678 (vertical 1.0
22679 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22680 (article 1.0))
22681 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22682 (user-position . t)
22683 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22684 (picon 1.0))))
22685
22686 @end lisp
22687
22688 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22689 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22690 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22691 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22692 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22693 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22694 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22695 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22696 is such a plist.
22697 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22698 be found in its default value.
22699
22700 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22701 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22702 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22703 might be used:
22704
22705 @lisp
22706 (message (horizontal 1.0
22707 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22708 (vertical 0.24
22709 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22710 '(summary 0.5))
22711 (group 1.0))))
22712 @end lisp
22713
22714 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22715 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22716 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22717
22718 @lisp
22719 (message
22720 (frame 1.0
22721 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22722 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22723 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22724 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22725 (name . "Message"))
22726 (message 1.0 point))))
22727 @end lisp
22728
22729 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22730 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22731 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22732 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22733 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22734
22735 @lisp
22736 (gnus-add-configuration
22737 '(article (vertical 1.0
22738 (group 4)
22739 (summary .25 point)
22740 (article 1.0))))
22741 @end lisp
22742
22743 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22744 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22745 Gnus has been loaded.
22746
22747 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22748 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22749 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22750 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22751 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22752
22753 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22754 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22755 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22756 windows resized.
22757
22758 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22759
22760 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22761 and when they're used:
22762
22763 @table @code
22764 @item group
22765 The group buffer.
22766
22767 @item summary
22768 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22769
22770 @item article
22771 Selecting an article.
22772
22773 @item server
22774 The server buffer.
22775
22776 @item browse
22777 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22778
22779 @item message
22780 Composing a (new) message.
22781
22782 @item only-article
22783 Showing only the article buffer.
22784
22785 @item edit-article
22786 Editing an article.
22787
22788 @item edit-form
22789 Editing group parameters and the like.
22790
22791 @item edit-score
22792 Editing a server definition.
22793
22794 @item post
22795 Composing a news message.
22796
22797 @item reply
22798 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22799
22800 @item forward
22801 Forwarding a message.
22802
22803 @item reply-yank
22804 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22805
22806 @item mail-bound
22807 Bouncing a message.
22808
22809 @item pipe
22810 Sending an article to an external process.
22811
22812 @item bug
22813 Sending a bug report.
22814
22815 @item score-trace
22816 Displaying the score trace.
22817
22818 @item score-words
22819 Displaying the score words.
22820
22821 @item split-trace
22822 Displaying the split trace.
22823
22824 @item compose-bounce
22825 Composing a bounce message.
22826
22827 @item mml-preview
22828 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22829
22830 @end table
22831
22832
22833 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22834
22835 @itemize @bullet
22836 @item
22837 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22838 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22839
22840 @ifinfo
22841 @example
22842 +---+---------+
22843 | G | Summary |
22844 | r +---------+
22845 | o | |
22846 | u | Article |
22847 | p | |
22848 +---+---------+
22849 @end example
22850 @end ifinfo
22851
22852 @lisp
22853 (gnus-add-configuration
22854 '(article
22855 (horizontal 1.0
22856 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22857 (vertical 1.0
22858 (summary 0.16 point)
22859 (article 1.0)))))
22860
22861 (gnus-add-configuration
22862 '(summary
22863 (horizontal 1.0
22864 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22865 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22866 @end lisp
22867
22868 @end itemize
22869
22870
22871 @node Faces and Fonts
22872 @section Faces and Fonts
22873 @cindex faces
22874 @cindex fonts
22875 @cindex colors
22876
22877 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22878 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22879 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22880 interface.
22881
22882
22883 @node Mode Lines
22884 @section Mode Lines
22885 @cindex mode lines
22886
22887 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22888 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22889 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22890 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22891 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22892 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22893 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22894 quicker.
22895
22896 @cindex display-time
22897
22898 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22899 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22900 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22901 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22902 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22903 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22904 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22905 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
22906 this variable:
22907
22908 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22909 @lisp
22910 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22911 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22912 (+ 21
22913 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22914 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22915 (length display-time-string)))))
22916 @end lisp
22917
22918 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22919 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22920 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22921 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22922 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22923
22924
22925 @node Highlighting and Menus
22926 @section Highlighting and Menus
22927 @cindex visual
22928 @cindex highlighting
22929 @cindex menus
22930
22931 @vindex gnus-visual
22932 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22933 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22934 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22935 file.
22936
22937 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22938 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22939
22940 @table @code
22941 @item group-highlight
22942 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22943 @item summary-highlight
22944 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22945 @item article-highlight
22946 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22947 @item highlight
22948 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22949 @item group-menu
22950 Create menus in the group buffer.
22951 @item summary-menu
22952 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22953 @item article-menu
22954 Create menus in the article buffer.
22955 @item browse-menu
22956 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22957 @item server-menu
22958 Create menus in the server buffer.
22959 @item score-menu
22960 Create menus in the score buffers.
22961 @item menu
22962 Create menus in all buffers.
22963 @end table
22964
22965 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22966 buffers, you could say something like:
22967
22968 @lisp
22969 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22970 @end lisp
22971
22972 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
22973
22974 @lisp
22975 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
22976 @end lisp
22977
22978 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
22979 in all Gnus buffers.
22980
22981 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
22982
22983 @table @code
22984 @item gnus-mouse-face
22985 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22986 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
22987 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
22988
22989 @end table
22990
22991 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
22992
22993 @table @code
22994
22995 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
22996 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
22997 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
22998
22999 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23000 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23001 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23002
23003 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23004 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23005 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23006
23007 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23008 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23009 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23010
23011 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23012 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23013 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23014
23015 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23016 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23017 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23018
23019 @end table
23020
23021
23022 @node Daemons
23023 @section Daemons
23024 @cindex demons
23025 @cindex daemons
23026
23027 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23028 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23029 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23030 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23031 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23032
23033 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23034 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23035 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23036
23037 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23038 been idle for thirty minutes:
23039
23040 @lisp
23041 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23042 @end lisp
23043
23044 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23045 Emacs is idle:
23046
23047 @lisp
23048 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23049 @end lisp
23050
23051 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23052 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23053 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23054
23055 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23056 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23057 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23058 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23059
23060 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23061 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23062 @var{idle} minutes.
23063
23064 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23065 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23066 minutes.
23067
23068 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23069 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23070 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23071
23072 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23073 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23074 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23075 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23076
23077 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23078 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23079
23080 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23081 @lisp
23082 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23083 @end lisp
23084
23085 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23086 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23087 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23088 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23089 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23090 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23091 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23092 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23093 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23094 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23095
23096 @findex gnus-demon-init
23097 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23098 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23099 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23100 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23101 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23102
23103 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23104 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23105 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23106 behave.
23107
23108
23109 @node Undo
23110 @section Undo
23111 @cindex undo
23112
23113 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23114 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23115 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23116
23117 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23118 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23119 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23120 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23121 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23122 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23123 @code{undo} function.
23124
23125 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23126 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23127 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23128 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23129 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23130 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23131 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23132 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23133 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23134 never be totally undoable.
23135
23136 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23137 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23138 @findex gnus-undo
23139 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23140 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23141 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23142 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23143 command.
23144
23145
23146 @node Predicate Specifiers
23147 @section Predicate Specifiers
23148 @cindex predicate specifiers
23149
23150 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23151 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23152 to type all that much.
23153
23154 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23155
23156 Here's an example:
23157
23158 @lisp
23159 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23160 gnus-article-unread-p)
23161 @end lisp
23162
23163 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23164 functions all take one parameter.
23165
23166 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23167 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23168 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23169 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23170 specifier.
23171
23172
23173 @node Moderation
23174 @section Moderation
23175 @cindex moderation
23176
23177 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23178 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23179 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23180 get a copy.
23181
23182 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23183 buffers. Put
23184
23185 @lisp
23186 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23187 @end lisp
23188
23189 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23190
23191 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23192 supposed to work:
23193
23194 @enumerate
23195 @item
23196 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23197 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23198 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23199
23200 @item
23201 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23202 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23203
23204 @item
23205 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23206 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23207 @kbd{c} command.
23208 @end enumerate
23209
23210 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23211
23212 @lisp
23213 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23214 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23215 @end lisp
23216
23217
23218 @node Fetching a Group
23219 @section Fetching a Group
23220 @cindex fetching a group
23221
23222 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23223 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23224 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23225 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23226 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23227 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23228
23229
23230 @node Image Enhancements
23231 @section Image Enhancements
23232
23233 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23234 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23235 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23236
23237 @menu
23238 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23239 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23240 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23241 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23242 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23243 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23244 @end menu
23245
23246
23247 @node X-Face
23248 @subsection X-Face
23249 @cindex x-face
23250
23251 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23252 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23253 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23254 readers.
23255
23256 @cindex x-face
23257 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23258 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23259 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23260 @iftex
23261 @iflatex
23262 \include{xface}
23263 @end iflatex
23264 @end iftex
23265 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23266
23267 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23268 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23269 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23270 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23271 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23272 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23273 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23274 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23275 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23276 @code{display} program.
23277
23278 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23279 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23280 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23281 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23282 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23283 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23284 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23285 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23286
23287 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23288 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23289 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23290 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23291 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23292 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23293
23294 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23295 @code{xface}).
23296
23297 @noindent
23298 Face and variable:
23299
23300 @table @code
23301 @item gnus-x-face
23302 @vindex gnus-x-face
23303 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23304 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23305 default colors are black and white.
23306
23307 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23308 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23309 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23310 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23311 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23312 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23313
23314 @lisp
23315 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23316 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23317 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23318 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23319
23320 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23321 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23322 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23323 (png . (:relief -2))))
23324 @end lisp
23325
23326 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23327 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23328 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23329 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23330 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23331 @samp{libcompface} library.
23332 @end table
23333
23334 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23335 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23336 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23337 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23338 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23339 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23340
23341 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23342 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23343 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23344 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23345 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23346 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23347 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23348 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23349 header data as a string.
23350
23351 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23352 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23353 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23354 randomly generated data.
23355
23356 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23357 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23358 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23359 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23360 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23361
23362 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23363 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23364
23365 @lisp
23366 (setq message-required-news-headers
23367 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23368 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23369 @end lisp
23370
23371 Using the last function would be something like this:
23372
23373 @lisp
23374 (setq message-required-news-headers
23375 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23376 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23377 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23378 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23379 @end lisp
23380
23381
23382 @node Face
23383 @subsection Face
23384 @cindex face
23385
23386 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23387
23388 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23389 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23390 represent the author of the message.
23391
23392 @cindex face
23393 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23394 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23395 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23396 specifications.
23397
23398 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23399 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23400
23401 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23402 PNG images.
23403 @c Maybe add this:
23404 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23405 @c (featurep 'png)
23406 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23407
23408 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23409 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23410
23411 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23412 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23413 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23414
23415 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23416 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23417 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23418 converts the file to Face format by using the
23419 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23420
23421 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23422 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23423
23424 @lisp
23425 (setq message-required-news-headers
23426 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23427 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23428 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23429 @end lisp
23430
23431
23432 @node Smileys
23433 @subsection Smileys
23434 @cindex smileys
23435
23436 @iftex
23437 @iflatex
23438 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23439 \input{smiley}
23440 @end iflatex
23441 @end iftex
23442
23443 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23444 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23445
23446 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23447 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23448
23449 @lisp
23450 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23451 @end lisp
23452
23453 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23454 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23455 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23456 text and maps that to file names.
23457
23458 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23459 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23460 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23461 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23462 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23463 displayed.
23464
23465 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23466
23467 @table @code
23468
23469 @item smiley-style
23470 @vindex smiley-style
23471 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23472 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23473 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23474 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23475 face.
23476
23477 @item smiley-data-directory
23478 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23479 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23480 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23481
23482 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23483 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23484 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23485
23486 @end table
23487
23488
23489 @node Picons
23490 @subsection Picons
23491
23492 @iftex
23493 @iflatex
23494 \include{picons}
23495 @end iflatex
23496 @end iftex
23497
23498 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23499 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23500 over your shoulder as you read news.
23501
23502 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23503
23504 @iftex
23505 @iflatex
23506 \margindex{}
23507 @end iflatex
23508 @end iftex
23509
23510 @quotation
23511 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23512 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23513 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23514 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23515 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23516 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23517 @code{GIF} formats.
23518 @end quotation
23519
23520 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23521 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23522 point your Web browser at
23523 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23524
23525 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23526 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23527
23528 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23529 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23530 Picons databases.
23531
23532 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23533 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23534 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23535 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23536
23537 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23538 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23539 properties applied to picons.
23540
23541 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23542
23543 @table @code
23544
23545 @item gnus-picon-databases
23546 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23547 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23548 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23549 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23550 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23551
23552 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23553 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23554 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23555 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23556
23557 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23558 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23559 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23560 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23561
23562 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23563 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23564 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23565 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23566 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23567
23568 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23569 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23570 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23571 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23572
23573 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23574 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23575 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23576 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23577 interesting.
23578
23579 @end table
23580
23581 @node Gravatars
23582 @subsection Gravatars
23583
23584 @iftex
23585 @iflatex
23586 \include{gravatars}
23587 @end iflatex
23588 @end iftex
23589
23590 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23591
23592 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23593
23594 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23595
23596 @table @code
23597
23598 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23599 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23600 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23601 number for the size is enough.
23602
23603 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23604 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23605 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23606
23607 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23608 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23609 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23610 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23611 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23612
23613 @end table
23614
23615 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23616 @lisp
23617 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23618 @end lisp
23619
23620 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23621
23622 @lisp
23623 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23624 @end lisp
23625
23626
23627 @node XVarious
23628 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23629
23630 @table @code
23631 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23632 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23633 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23634 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23635 unusual directory structure.
23636
23637 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23638 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23639 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23640 default.
23641
23642 @end table
23643
23644 @subsubsection Toolbar
23645
23646 @table @code
23647
23648 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23649 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23650 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23651 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23652 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23653 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23654 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23655 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23656
23657 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23658 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23659 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23660 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23661 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23662 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23663
23664 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23665 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23666 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23667
23668 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23669 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23670 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23671
23672 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23673 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23674 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23675
23676 @end table
23677
23678 @iftex
23679 @iflatex
23680 \margindex{}
23681 @end iflatex
23682 @end iftex
23683
23684
23685 @node Fuzzy Matching
23686 @section Fuzzy Matching
23687 @cindex fuzzy matching
23688
23689 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23690 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23691
23692 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23693 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23694 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23695
23696 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23697 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23698 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23699 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23700 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23701
23702
23703 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23704 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23705 @cindex email spam
23706 @cindex spam
23707 @cindex UCE
23708 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23709
23710 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23711 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23712 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23713 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23714 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23715 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23716 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23717 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23718 in the end.
23719
23720 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23721 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23722 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23723 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23724 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23725 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23726
23727 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23728
23729 @menu
23730 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23731 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23732 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23733 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23734 @end menu
23735
23736 @node The problem of spam
23737 @subsection The problem of spam
23738 @cindex email spam
23739 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23740 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23741 @cindex UCE
23742 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23743
23744 First, some background on spam.
23745
23746 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23747 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23748 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23749 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23750 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23751 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23752 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23753 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23754 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23755
23756 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23757 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23758 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23759 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23760 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23761 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23762 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23763 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23764 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23765 and processing.
23766
23767 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23768 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23769 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23770 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23771 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23772 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23773 from Bulgarian IPs.
23774
23775 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23776 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23777 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23778 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23779
23780 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23781 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23782 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23783 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23784
23785 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23786 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23787 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23788 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23789 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23790 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23791 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23792 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23793 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23794
23795 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23796 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23797 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23798 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23799 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23800 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23801 down for some time because of the incident.
23802
23803 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23804 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23805 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23806 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23807 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23808 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23809 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23810 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23811 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23812 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23813 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23814
23815 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23816 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23817 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23818 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23819 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23820 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23821 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23822 spam plague.
23823
23824 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23825 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23826 @cindex email spam
23827 @cindex spam
23828 @cindex UCE
23829 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23830
23831 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23832 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23833
23834 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23835 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23836 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23837 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23838 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23839 part of the mail address.)
23840
23841 @lisp
23842 (setq message-default-news-headers
23843 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23844 @end lisp
23845
23846 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23847 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23848
23849 @lisp
23850 (...
23851 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23852 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23853 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23854 "spam"))
23855 ...)
23856 @end lisp
23857
23858 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23859 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23860 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23861 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23862
23863 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23864 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23865 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23866 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23867 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23868 your fancy split rule in this way:
23869
23870 @lisp
23871 (
23872 ...
23873 (to "larsi" "misc")
23874 "spam")
23875 @end lisp
23876
23877 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23878 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23879 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23880 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23881 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23882
23883 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23884 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23885 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23886 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23887
23888 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23889
23890
23891 @node SpamAssassin
23892 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23893 @cindex SpamAssassin
23894 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23895 @cindex DCC
23896
23897 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23898 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23899 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23900 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23901 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23902 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23903 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23904
23905 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23906 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23907 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23908 recipes.
23909
23910 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23911 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23912 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23913 Specifiers}) follow.
23914
23915 @lisp
23916 (setq mail-sources
23917 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23918 (pop :user "jrl"
23919 :server "pophost"
23920 :postscript
23921 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23922 @end lisp
23923
23924 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23925 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23926 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23927
23928 @lisp
23929 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23930 ...))
23931 @end lisp
23932
23933 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23934
23935 @lisp
23936 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23937 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23938 ...))
23939 @end lisp
23940
23941 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23942 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23943 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23944 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23945
23946 @lisp
23947 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23948 ...))
23949 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23950 (save-excursion
23951 (save-restriction
23952 (widen)
23953 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23954 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23955 "spam"))))
23956 @end lisp
23957
23958 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
23959 downloaded by default. You need to set
23960 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23961 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
23962
23963 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23964 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23965 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23966
23967 @lisp
23968 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23969 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23970 (interactive)
23971 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
23972 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
23973 @end lisp
23974
23975 @node Hashcash
23976 @subsection Hashcash
23977 @cindex hashcash
23978
23979 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
23980 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
23981 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
23982 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
23983 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
23984
23985 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
23986 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
23987 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
23988 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
23989 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
23990 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
23991 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
23992 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
23993 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
23994 one of them separately.
23995
23996 @cindex X-Hashcash
23997 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
23998 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
23999 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24000 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24001 need to install to use this feature, see
24002 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24003 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24004
24005 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24006 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24007 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24008
24009 @lisp
24010 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24011 @end lisp
24012
24013 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24014
24015 @table @code
24016
24017 @item hashcash-default-payment
24018 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24019 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24020 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24021 include 17 to 29.
24022
24023 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24024 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24025 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24026 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24027 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24028 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24029 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24030 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24031 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24032
24033 @item hashcash-path
24034 @vindex hashcash-path
24035 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24036 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24037 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24038 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24039 when you generate hashcash payments.
24040
24041 @end table
24042
24043 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24044 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24045 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24046 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24047 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24048 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24049 Hashcash Payments}).
24050
24051 @node Spam Package
24052 @section Spam Package
24053 @cindex spam filtering
24054 @cindex spam
24055
24056 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24057 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24058 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24059 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24060
24061 @menu
24062 * Spam Package Introduction::
24063 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24064 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24065 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24066 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24067 * Spam Back Ends::
24068 * Extending the Spam package::
24069 * Spam Statistics Package::
24070 @end menu
24071
24072 @node Spam Package Introduction
24073 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24074 @cindex spam filtering
24075 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24076 @cindex spam
24077
24078 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24079 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24080
24081 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24082 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24083
24084 @cindex spam-initialize
24085 @vindex spam-use-stat
24086 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24087 @code{spam-initialize}:
24088
24089 @example
24090 (spam-initialize)
24091 @end example
24092
24093 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24094 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24095 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24096 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24097 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24098
24099 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24100 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24101
24102 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24103 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24104
24105 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24106 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24107 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24108 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24109 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24110
24111 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24112 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24113 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24114 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24115 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24116 Groups}.
24117
24118 @cindex spam back ends
24119 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24120 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24121 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24122 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24123 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24124
24125 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24126 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24127
24128 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24129 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24130 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24131 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24132 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24133 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24134 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24135
24136 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24137 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24138 point, the Spam package does several things:
24139
24140 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24141 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24142 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24143 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24144 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24145 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24146 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24147 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24148 Ham Processors}.
24149
24150 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24151 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24152 group:
24153
24154 @table @kbd
24155 @item $
24156 @itemx M-d
24157 @itemx M s x
24158 @itemx S x
24159 @kindex $ (Summary)
24160 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24161 @kindex S x (Summary)
24162 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24163 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24164 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24165 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24166 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24167 @end table
24168
24169 @noindent
24170 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24171 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24172
24173 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24174 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24175 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24176 to be processed as ham by setting
24177 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24178 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24179
24180 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24181 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24182 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24183 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24184 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24185 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24186 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24187 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24188 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24189 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24190 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24191 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24192
24193 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24194 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24195 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24196 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24197 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24198 Configuration Examples}.
24199
24200 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24201 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24202 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24203 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24204
24205 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24206 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24207
24208 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24209 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24210 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24211
24212 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24213 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24214 @cindex spam filtering
24215 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24216 @cindex spam
24217
24218 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24219 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24220 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24221 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24222 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24223
24224 @example
24225 (: spam-split)
24226 @end example
24227
24228 @vindex spam-split-group
24229 @noindent
24230 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24231 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24232 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24233 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24234 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24235 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24236 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24237 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24238 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24239
24240 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24241
24242 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24243 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24244 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24245 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24246 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24247 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24248 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24249 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24250 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24251 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24252 IMAP Splitting}.
24253
24254 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24255 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24256 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24257 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24258 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24259 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24260 ends, and the following split rule:
24261
24262 @example
24263 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24264 (any "ding" "ding")
24265 (: spam-split)
24266 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24267 "mail")
24268 @end example
24269
24270 @noindent
24271 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24272 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24273 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24274 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24275 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24276 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24277
24278 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24279 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24280 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24281 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24282
24283 @example
24284 nnimap-split-fancy
24285 '(|
24286 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24287 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24288 (any "ding" "ding")
24289 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24290 (: spam-split)
24291 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24292 "mail")
24293 @end example
24294
24295 @noindent
24296 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24297 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24298 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24299 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24300 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24301 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24302 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24303
24304 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24305 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24306 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24307 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24308
24309 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24310 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24311 @c don't.}
24312
24313 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24314 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24315
24316 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24317 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24318 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24319 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24320
24321 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24322 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24323 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24324 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24325
24326 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24327 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24328 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24329
24330 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24331 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24332 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24333 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24334 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24335 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24336 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24337
24338 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24339 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24340 @cindex spam filtering
24341 @cindex spam filtering variables
24342 @cindex spam variables
24343 @cindex spam
24344
24345 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24346 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24347 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24348 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24349 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24350 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24351 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24352
24353 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24354 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24355 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24356 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24357
24358 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24359 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24360 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24361 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24362 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24363 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24364 by customizing the corresponding variable
24365 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24366 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24367 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24368 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24369 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24370 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24371 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24372 default.
24373
24374 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24375 @cindex $
24376 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24377 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24378 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24379 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24380 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24381 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24382 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24383 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24384 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24385 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24386 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24387 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24388 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24389
24390 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24391 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24392 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24393 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24394 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24395 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24396 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24397 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24398
24399 @defvar ham-marks
24400 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24401 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24402 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24403 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24404 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24405 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24406 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24407 happy for you.
24408 @end defvar
24409
24410 @defvar spam-marks
24411 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24412 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24413 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24414 you really want to.
24415 @end defvar
24416
24417 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24418 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24419 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24420 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24421 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24422 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24423 and nothing else.
24424
24425 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24426 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24427 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24428 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24429 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24430 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24431 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24432 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24433 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24434 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24435 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24436 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24437 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24438 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24439 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24440
24441 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24442 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24443
24444 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24445 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24446 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24447
24448 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24449 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24450
24451 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24452 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24453 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24454 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24455 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24456
24457 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24458 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24459 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24460 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24461 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24462 it there.
24463
24464 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24465 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24466 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24467 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24468 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24469 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24470 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24471 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24472 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24473 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24474 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24475 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24476 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24477
24478 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24479 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24480
24481 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24482 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24483 training} groups.
24484
24485 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24486 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24487 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24488 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24489 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24490 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24491 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24492
24493 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24494 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24495 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24496 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24497
24498 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24499 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24500 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24501 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24502 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24503 from the mail server.
24504
24505 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24506 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24507 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24508 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24509
24510 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24511 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24512 @cindex spam filtering
24513 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24514 @cindex spam configuration examples
24515 @cindex spam
24516
24517 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24518
24519 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24520 @example
24521 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24522 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24523 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24524 (spam-initialize)
24525
24526 (setq
24527 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24528 spam-use-BBDB t
24529 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24530 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24531 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24532 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24533 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24534 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24535 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24536 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24537 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24538 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24539 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24540 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24541 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24542 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24543 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24544 (any "ding" "ding")
24545 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24546 (: spam-split)
24547 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24548 "mail"))
24549
24550 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24551
24552 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24553 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24554 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24555 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24556
24557 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24558
24559 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24560 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24561 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24562 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24563 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24564
24565 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24566 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24567
24568 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24569
24570 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24571 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24572
24573 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24574 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24575 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24576
24577 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24578
24579 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24580 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24581
24582 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24583 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24584 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24585 (ham-marks
24586 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24587 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24588 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24589 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24590
24591 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24592 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24593 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24594
24595 @end example
24596
24597 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24598 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24599
24600 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24601 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24602 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24603 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24604 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24605 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24606 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24607 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24608 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24609
24610 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24611 does most of the job for me:
24612
24613 @lisp
24614 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24615 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24616 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24617 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24618 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24619 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24620 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24621 @end lisp
24622
24623 @itemize
24624
24625 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24626
24627 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24628 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24629 bogofilter or DCC).
24630
24631 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24632 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24633 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24634 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24635 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24636 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24637 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24638
24639 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24640 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24641 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24642 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24643 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24644 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24645
24646 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24647
24648 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24649 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24650 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24651 @samp{training.spam}.
24652 @end itemize
24653
24654 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24655
24656 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24657
24658 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24659 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24660 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24661
24662 @lisp
24663 ("^gmane\\."
24664 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24665 @end lisp
24666
24667 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24668 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24669 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24670 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24671 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24672
24673 @node Spam Back Ends
24674 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24675 @cindex spam back ends
24676
24677 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24678 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24679 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24680 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24681 Processors}).
24682
24683 @menu
24684 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24685 * BBDB Whitelists::
24686 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24687 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24688 * Blackholes::
24689 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24690 * Bogofilter::
24691 * SpamAssassin back end::
24692 * ifile spam filtering::
24693 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24694 * SpamOracle::
24695 @end menu
24696
24697 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24698 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24699 @cindex spam filtering
24700 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24701 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24702 @cindex spam
24703
24704 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24705
24706 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24707 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24708 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24709 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24710 be spammers.
24711
24712 @end defvar
24713
24714 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24715
24716 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24717 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24718 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24719 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24720 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24721
24722 @end defvar
24723
24724 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24725
24726 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24727 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24728 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24729
24730 @end defvar
24731
24732 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24733
24734 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24735 customizing the group parameters or the
24736 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24737 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24738 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24739
24740 @emph{WARNING}
24741
24742 Instead of the obsolete
24743 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24744 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24745 the same way, we promise.
24746
24747 @end defvar
24748
24749 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24750
24751 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24752 customizing the group parameters or the
24753 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24754 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24755 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24756 whitelist.
24757
24758 @emph{WARNING}
24759
24760 Instead of the obsolete
24761 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24762 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24763 the same way, we promise.
24764
24765 @end defvar
24766
24767 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24768 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24769 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24770 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24771 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24772
24773 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24774 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24775 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24776 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24777
24778 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24779 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24780 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24781 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24782 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24783 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24784
24785 @node BBDB Whitelists
24786 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24787 @cindex spam filtering
24788 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24789 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24790 @cindex spam
24791
24792 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24793
24794 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24795 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24796 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24797 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24798 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24799 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24800 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24801
24802 @end defvar
24803
24804 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24805
24806 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24807 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24808 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24809 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24810 classified as spammers.
24811
24812 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24813 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24814 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24815 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24816 will be exclusive.
24817
24818 @end defvar
24819
24820 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24821
24822 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24823 customizing the group parameters or the
24824 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24825 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24826 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24827 BBDB.
24828
24829 @emph{WARNING}
24830
24831 Instead of the obsolete
24832 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24833 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24834 the same way, we promise.
24835
24836 @end defvar
24837
24838 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24839 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24840 @cindex spam reporting
24841 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24842 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24843 @cindex spam
24844
24845 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24846
24847 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24848 customizing the group parameters or the
24849 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24850 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24851 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24852 HTTP request.
24853
24854 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24855
24856 @emph{WARNING}
24857
24858 Instead of the obsolete
24859 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24860 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24861 same way, we promise.
24862
24863 @end defvar
24864
24865 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24866
24867 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24868 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24869 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24870 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24871 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24872
24873 @end defvar
24874
24875 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24876
24877 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24878 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24879 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24880
24881 @end defvar
24882
24883 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24884 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24885 @cindex spam filtering
24886 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24887 @cindex spam
24888
24889 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24890
24891 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24892 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24893 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24894 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24895 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24896 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24897
24898 @end defvar
24899
24900 @node Blackholes
24901 @subsubsection Blackholes
24902 @cindex spam filtering
24903 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24904 @cindex spam
24905
24906 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24907
24908 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24909 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24910 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24911 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24912 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24913 contains outdated servers.
24914
24915 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24916 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24917 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24918 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24919 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24920 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24921
24922 @end defvar
24923
24924 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24925
24926 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24927
24928 @end defvar
24929
24930 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24931
24932 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24933 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24934
24935 @end defvar
24936
24937 @defvar spam-use-dig
24938
24939 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24940 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24941
24942 @end defvar
24943
24944 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24945 ham processor for blackholes.
24946
24947 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24948 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24949 @cindex spam filtering
24950 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24951 @cindex spam
24952
24953 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24954
24955 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24956 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24957 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24958 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24959 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24960 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24961
24962 @end defvar
24963
24964 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24965
24966 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24967 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24968
24969 @end defvar
24970
24971 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
24972
24973 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24974 the message, positively identify it as ham.
24975
24976 @end defvar
24977
24978 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
24979 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
24980
24981 @node Bogofilter
24982 @subsubsection Bogofilter
24983 @cindex spam filtering
24984 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
24985 @cindex spam
24986
24987 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
24988
24989 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24990 speedy Bogofilter.
24991
24992 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
24993 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
24994 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
24995 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
24996 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
24997 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
24998
24999 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25000 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25001 documentation.
25002
25003 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25004 processing will be turned off.
25005
25006 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25007
25008 @end defvar
25009
25010 @table @kbd
25011 @item M s t
25012 @itemx S t
25013 @kindex M s t
25014 @kindex S t
25015 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25016 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25017 @end table
25018
25019 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25020
25021 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25022 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25023 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25024 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25025 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25026 installation documents for details.
25027
25028 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25029
25030 @end defvar
25031
25032 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25033 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25034 customizing the group parameters or the
25035 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25036 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25037 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25038
25039 @emph{WARNING}
25040
25041 Instead of the obsolete
25042 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25043 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25044 the same way, we promise.
25045 @end defvar
25046
25047 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25048 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25049 customizing the group parameters or the
25050 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25051 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25052 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25053 of non-spam messages.
25054
25055 @emph{WARNING}
25056
25057 Instead of the obsolete
25058 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25059 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25060 the same way, we promise.
25061 @end defvar
25062
25063 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25064
25065 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25066 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25067 database directory.
25068
25069 @end defvar
25070
25071 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25072 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25073 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25074 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25075 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25076 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25077
25078 @node SpamAssassin back end
25079 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25080 @cindex spam filtering
25081 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25082 @cindex spam
25083
25084 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25085
25086 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25087
25088 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25089 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25090 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25091 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25092 mode.
25093
25094 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25095 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25096 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25097 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25098 instead.
25099
25100 You should not enable this if you use
25101 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25102
25103 @end defvar
25104
25105 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25106
25107 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25108 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25109
25110 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25111
25112 @end defvar
25113
25114 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25115
25116 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25117 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25118 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25119 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25120
25121 @end defvar
25122
25123 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25124 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25125 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25126 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25127 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25128 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25129 to test this functionality.
25130
25131 @node ifile spam filtering
25132 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25133 @cindex spam filtering
25134 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25135 @cindex spam
25136
25137 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25138
25139 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25140 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25141
25142 @end defvar
25143
25144 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25145
25146 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25147 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25148 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25149
25150 @end defvar
25151
25152 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25153
25154 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25155 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25156 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25157 @end defvar
25158
25159 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25160
25161 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25162 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25163
25164 @end defvar
25165
25166 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25167 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25168 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25169 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25170 functionality.
25171
25172 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25173 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25174 @cindex spam filtering
25175 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25176 @cindex spam-stat
25177 @cindex spam
25178
25179 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25180 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25181 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25182 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25183 spam-stat dictionary}.
25184
25185 @defvar spam-use-stat
25186
25187 @end defvar
25188
25189 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25190 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25191 customizing the group parameters or the
25192 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25193 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25194 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25195
25196 @emph{WARNING}
25197
25198 Instead of the obsolete
25199 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25200 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25201 the same way, we promise.
25202 @end defvar
25203
25204 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25205 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25206 customizing the group parameters or the
25207 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25208 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25209 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25210 of non-spam messages.
25211
25212 @emph{WARNING}
25213
25214 Instead of the obsolete
25215 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25216 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25217 the same way, we promise.
25218 @end defvar
25219
25220 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25221 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25222 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25223 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25224 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25225
25226 @node SpamOracle
25227 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25228 @cindex spam filtering
25229 @cindex SpamOracle
25230 @cindex spam
25231
25232 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25233 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25234 installed separately.
25235
25236 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25237 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25238 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25239 mail as a spam mail or not.
25240
25241 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25242 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25243 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25244
25245 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25246 call SpamOracle.
25247
25248 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25249 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25250 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25251 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25252 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25253 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25254 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25255 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25256
25257 @example
25258 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25259 spam-split-group "Junk"
25260 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25261 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25262 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25263 @end example
25264
25265 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25266 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25267 SpamOracle.
25268 @end defvar
25269
25270 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25271 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25272 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25273 can be customized.
25274 @end defvar
25275
25276 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25277 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25278 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25279 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25280 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25281 database to live somewhere special, set
25282 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25283 @end defvar
25284
25285 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25286 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25287 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25288 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25289 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25290 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25291 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25292 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25293 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25294 @xref{Spam Package}.
25295
25296 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25297 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25298 customizing the group parameter or the
25299 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25300 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25301 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25302
25303 @emph{WARNING}
25304
25305 Instead of the obsolete
25306 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25307 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25308 the same way, we promise.
25309 @end defvar
25310
25311 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25312 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25313 customizing the group parameter or the
25314 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25315 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25316 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25317 messages.
25318
25319 @emph{WARNING}
25320
25321 Instead of the obsolete
25322 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25323 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25324 the same way, we promise.
25325 @end defvar
25326
25327 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25328 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25329 messages.
25330 @example
25331 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25332 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25333 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25334 @end example
25335 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25336 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25337 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25338 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25339 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25340 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25341
25342 @node Extending the Spam package
25343 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25344 @cindex spam filtering
25345 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25346 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25347
25348 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25349 incoming mail, provide the following:
25350
25351 @enumerate
25352
25353 @item
25354 Code
25355
25356 @lisp
25357 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25358 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25359 @end lisp
25360
25361 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25362
25363 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25364 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25365 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25366 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25367 register/unregister spam and ham.
25368
25369 @item
25370 Functionality
25371
25372 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25373 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25374 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25375 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25376 why you aren't.
25377
25378 @end enumerate
25379
25380 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25381
25382 @enumerate
25383
25384 @item
25385 Code
25386
25387 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25388 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25389
25390 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25391 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25392 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25393 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25394
25395 @lisp
25396 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25397 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25398 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25399
25400 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25401 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25402 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25403
25404 @end lisp
25405
25406 @item
25407 Gnus parameters
25408
25409 Add
25410 @lisp
25411 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25412 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25413 @end lisp
25414 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25415 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25416 variable customization.
25417
25418 Add
25419 @lisp
25420 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25421 @end lisp
25422 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25423 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25424
25425 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25426 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25427
25428
25429 @enumerate
25430
25431 @item
25432 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25433
25434 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25435 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25436 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25437
25438 @item
25439 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25440
25441 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25442 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25443 such a back end.
25444
25445 @item
25446 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25447
25448 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25449 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25450 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25451 back ends.
25452
25453 @item
25454 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25455
25456 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25457 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25458 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25459
25460 @item
25461 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25462
25463 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25464 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25465 set up this way.
25466
25467 @item
25468 @code{spam-install-backend}
25469
25470 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25471 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25472 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25473
25474 @item
25475 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25476
25477 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25478 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25479 never install such a back end.
25480 @end enumerate
25481
25482 @end enumerate
25483
25484 @node Spam Statistics Package
25485 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25486 @cindex Paul Graham
25487 @cindex Graham, Paul
25488 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25489 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25490 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25491
25492 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25493 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25494 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25495 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25496 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25497 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25498 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25499 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25500 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25501 or not.
25502
25503 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25504 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25505 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25506 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25507 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25508 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25509 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25510 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25511
25512 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25513 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25514 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25515
25516 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25517 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25518 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25519 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25520 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25521
25522 @menu
25523 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25524 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25525 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25526 @end menu
25527
25528 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25529 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25530
25531 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25532 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25533 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25534 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25535 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25536
25537 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25538 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25539 per mail. Use the following:
25540
25541 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25542 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25543 is treated as one spam mail.
25544 @end defun
25545
25546 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25547 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25548 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25549 @end defun
25550
25551 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25552 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25553 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25554 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25555 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25556 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25557
25558 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25559 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25560 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25561 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25562 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25563
25564 @defvar spam-stat
25565 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25566 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25567 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25568 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25569 @end defvar
25570
25571 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25572 reset the dictionary.
25573
25574 @defun spam-stat-reset
25575 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25576 @end defun
25577
25578 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25579 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25580 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25581 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25582 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25583 only non-spam mails.
25584
25585 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25586 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25587 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25588 @end defun
25589
25590 @defun spam-stat-save
25591 Save the dictionary.
25592 @end defun
25593
25594 @defvar spam-stat-file
25595 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25596 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25597 @end defvar
25598
25599 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25600 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25601
25602 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25603 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25604
25605 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25606
25607 @lisp
25608 (require 'spam-stat)
25609 (spam-stat-load)
25610 @end lisp
25611
25612 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25613 created.
25614
25615 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25616 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25617 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25618 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25619
25620 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25621 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25622 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25623 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25624
25625 @lisp
25626 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25627 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25628 "mail.misc"))
25629 @end lisp
25630
25631 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25632 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25633 @end defvar
25634
25635 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25636 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25637 expression are considered potential spam.
25638
25639 @lisp
25640 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25641 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25642 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25643 "mail.misc"))
25644 @end lisp
25645
25646 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25647 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25648 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25649 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25650 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25651
25652 @lisp
25653 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25654 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25655 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25656 "mail.misc"))
25657 @end lisp
25658
25659 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25660 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25661 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25662 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25663 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25664 dictionary!
25665
25666 @lisp
25667 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25668 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25669 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25670 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25671 "mail.misc"))
25672 @end lisp
25673
25674
25675 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25676 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25677
25678 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25679
25680 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25681 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25682 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25683 @end defun
25684
25685 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25686 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25687 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25688 @end defun
25689
25690 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25691 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25692 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25693 already been processed as non-spam.
25694 @end defun
25695
25696 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25697 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25698 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25699 been processed as spam.
25700 @end defun
25701
25702 @defun spam-stat-save
25703 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25704 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25705 @end defun
25706
25707 @defun spam-stat-load
25708 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25709 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25710 @end defun
25711
25712 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25713 Return the spam score for a word.
25714 @end defun
25715
25716 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25717 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25718 @end defun
25719
25720 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25721 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25722 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25723 @end defun
25724
25725 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25726 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25727
25728 @lisp
25729 (require 'spam-stat)
25730 (spam-stat-load)
25731 @end lisp
25732
25733 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25734
25735 @smallexample
25736 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25737 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25738 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25739 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25740 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25741 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25742 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25743 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25744 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25745 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25746 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25747 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25748 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25749 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25750 @end smallexample
25751
25752 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25753
25754 @smallexample
25755 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25756 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25757 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25758 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25759 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25760 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25761 @end smallexample
25762
25763 @node The Gnus Registry
25764 @section The Gnus Registry
25765 @cindex registry
25766 @cindex split
25767 @cindex track
25768
25769 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25770 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25771 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25772 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25773 features are pretty cool.
25774
25775 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25776 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25777
25778 @enumerate
25779 @item
25780 Split messages to their parent
25781
25782 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25783 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25784 available.
25785
25786 @item
25787 Refer to messages by ID
25788
25789 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25790 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25791 of the group the message is in.
25792
25793 @item
25794 Store custom flags and keywords
25795
25796 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25797 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25798 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25799 etc. backends.
25800
25801 @item
25802 Store arbitrary data
25803
25804 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25805 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25806 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25807 @end enumerate
25808
25809 @menu
25810 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25811 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25812 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25813 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25814 * Store arbitrary data::
25815 @end menu
25816
25817 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25818 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25819
25820 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25821
25822 @lisp
25823 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25824
25825 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25826 @end lisp
25827
25828 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25829 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25830 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.) so
25831 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25832 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25833
25834 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25835 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25836
25837 @lisp
25838 (setq
25839 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25840 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25841 ("nnrss" t)
25842 ("spam" t)
25843 ("train" t))
25844 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25845 ;; this is the default
25846 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25847 @end lisp
25848
25849 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25850 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25851 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25852 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25853 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25854 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25855
25856 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25857 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25858 the general settings.
25859
25860 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25861 The groups that will not be followed by
25862 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25863 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25864 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25865 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25866 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25867 @end defvar
25868
25869 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25870 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25871 registry will keep.
25872 @end defvar
25873
25874 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25875 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25876 the registry will keep after pruning.
25877 @end defvar
25878
25879 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25880 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25881 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25882 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25883 @end defvar
25884
25885 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25886 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25887
25888 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25889 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25890 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25891 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25892
25893 @vindex nnregistry
25894 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25895
25896 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25897 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25898 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25899 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25900 lines:
25901
25902 @example
25903 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25904 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25905 ;; knows where the article is.
25906 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25907
25908 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25909
25910 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
25911 '(current
25912 (nnregistry)
25913 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
25914 @end example
25915
25916 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25917 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25918 all else fails, using Gmane.
25919
25920 @node Fancy splitting to parent
25921 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25922
25923 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25924
25925 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25926 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25927 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25928 strategy.
25929
25930 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25931 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25932 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
25933 have to put a rule like this:
25934
25935 @lisp
25936 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
25937
25938 ;; split to parent: you need this
25939 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25940
25941 ;; other rules, as an example
25942 (: spam-split)
25943 ;; default mailbox
25944 "mail")
25945 @end lisp
25946
25947 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
25948 following variables.
25949
25950 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
25951 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
25952 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
25953 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
25954 people don't stick to the same groups.
25955 @end defvar
25956
25957 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
25958 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
25959 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
25960 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
25961 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
25962 works best.
25963 @end defvar
25964
25965 @node Store custom flags and keywords
25966 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
25967
25968 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
25969 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
25970 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
25971
25972 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
25973 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
25974 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
25975 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
25976 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
25977 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
25978
25979 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
25980 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
25981 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
25982 letter.
25983 @end defvar
25984
25985 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
25986 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
25987 will offer the available marks for completion.
25988 @end defun
25989
25990 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
25991 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
25992 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
25993 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
25994
25995 @lisp
25996 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
25997 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
25998 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
25999
26000 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26001 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26002 @end lisp
26003
26004
26005 @node Store arbitrary data
26006 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26007
26008 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26009 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26010 storage).
26011
26012 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26013 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26014 @end defun
26015
26016 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26017 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26018 @end defun
26019
26020 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26021 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26022 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26023 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26024 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26025 precious.
26026 @end defvar
26027
26028 @node Other modes
26029 @section Interaction with other modes
26030
26031 @subsection Dired
26032 @cindex dired
26033
26034 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26035 buffers. It is enabled with
26036 @lisp
26037 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26038 @end lisp
26039
26040 @table @kbd
26041 @item C-c C-m C-a
26042 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26043 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26044 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26045 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26046
26047 @item C-c C-m C-l
26048 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26049 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26050 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26051 buffer.
26052
26053 @item C-c C-m C-p
26054 @findex gnus-dired-print
26055 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26056 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26057 @end table
26058
26059 @node Various Various
26060 @section Various Various
26061 @cindex mode lines
26062 @cindex highlights
26063
26064 @table @code
26065
26066 @item gnus-home-directory
26067 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26068 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26069 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26070
26071 @item gnus-directory
26072 @vindex gnus-directory
26073 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26074 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26075 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26076
26077 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26078 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26079 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26080 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26081
26082 @item gnus-default-directory
26083 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26084 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26085 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26086 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26087 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26088 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26089 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26090
26091 @item gnus-verbose
26092 @vindex gnus-verbose
26093 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26094 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26095 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26096 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26097 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26098
26099 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26100 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26101 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26102 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26103
26104 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26105 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26106 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26107 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26108 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26109 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26110 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26111 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26112 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26113 displayed in the echo area.
26114
26115 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26116 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26117 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26118 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26119 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26120 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26121 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26122 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26123 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26124 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26125
26126 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26127 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26128 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26129 read when doing the operation described above.
26130
26131 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26132 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26133 @cindex file names
26134 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26135 @cindex characters in file names
26136 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26137 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26138 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26139
26140 @lisp
26141 @group
26142 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26143 '((?: . ?_)))
26144 @end group
26145 @end lisp
26146
26147 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26148 Windows (phooey) systems.
26149
26150 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26151 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26152 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26153 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26154 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26155
26156 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26157 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26158 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26159 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26160 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26161
26162 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26163 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26164 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26165
26166 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26167 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26168
26169 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26170 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26171 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26172 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26173 group).
26174
26175 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26176
26177 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26178 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26179 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26180 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26181 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26182 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26183 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26184 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26185 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26186
26187 @end table
26188
26189 @node The End
26190 @chapter The End
26191
26192 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26193 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26194
26195 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26196
26197 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26198
26199 @quotation
26200 @strong{Te Deum}
26201
26202 @sp 1
26203 Not because of victories @*
26204 I sing,@*
26205 having none,@*
26206 but for the common sunshine,@*
26207 the breeze,@*
26208 the largess of the spring.
26209
26210 @sp 1
26211 Not for victory@*
26212 but for the day's work done@*
26213 as well as I was able;@*
26214 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26215 but at the common table.@*
26216 @end quotation
26217
26218
26219 @node Appendices
26220 @chapter Appendices
26221
26222 @menu
26223 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26224 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26225 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26226 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26227 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26228 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26229 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26230 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26231 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26232 @end menu
26233
26234
26235 @node XEmacs
26236 @section XEmacs
26237 @cindex XEmacs
26238 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26239
26240 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26241 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26242 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26243 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26244 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26245 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26246
26247
26248 @node History
26249 @section History
26250
26251 @cindex history
26252 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26253 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26254
26255 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26256 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26257 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26258 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26259 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26260
26261 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26262 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26263 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26264 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26265 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26266 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26267
26268 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26269 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26270 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26271 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26272
26273 @menu
26274 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26275 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26276 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26277 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26278 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26279 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26280 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26281 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26282 @end menu
26283
26284
26285 @node Gnus Versions
26286 @subsection Gnus Versions
26287 @cindex ding Gnus
26288 @cindex September Gnus
26289 @cindex Red Gnus
26290 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26291 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26292 @cindex Oort Gnus
26293 @cindex No Gnus
26294 @cindex Ma Gnus
26295 @cindex Gnus versions
26296
26297 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26298 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26299 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26300
26301 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26302 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26303
26304 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26305 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26306
26307 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26308 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26309
26310 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26311 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26312 1999.
26313
26314 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26315 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26316
26317 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26318
26319 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26320 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26321 with the information when possible).
26322
26323 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26324
26325 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26326 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26327 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26328 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26329 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26330 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26331 that instead.
26332
26333
26334 @node Why?
26335 @subsection Why?
26336
26337 What's the point of Gnus?
26338
26339 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26340 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26341 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26342 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26343 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26344 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26345 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26346 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26347 keep track of millions of people who post?
26348
26349 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26350 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26351 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26352 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26353 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26354 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26355 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26356 every one of you to explore and invent.
26357
26358 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26359 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26360
26361
26362 @node Compatibility
26363 @subsection Compatibility
26364
26365 @cindex compatibility
26366 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26367 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26368 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26369
26370 Our motto is:
26371 @quotation
26372 @cartouche
26373 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26374 @end cartouche
26375 @end quotation
26376
26377 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26378 their names.
26379
26380 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26381 Articles}.
26382
26383 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26384 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26385 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26386 important variables have their values copied into their global
26387 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26388 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26389
26390 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26391 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26392 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26393 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26394 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26395 peculiar results.
26396
26397 @cindex hilit19
26398 @cindex highlighting
26399 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26400 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26401 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26402 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26403 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26404 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26405 Away!
26406
26407 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26408 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26409 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26410 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26411
26412 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26413 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26414 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26415 to stop doing it the old way.
26416
26417 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26418
26419 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26420 @findex gnus-bug
26421 @cindex reporting bugs
26422 @cindex bugs
26423 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26424 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26425 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26426
26427 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26428 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26429 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26430 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26431 up at you.
26432
26433
26434 @node Conformity
26435 @subsection Conformity
26436
26437 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26438 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26439 with, of course.
26440
26441 @table @strong
26442
26443 @item RFC (2)822
26444 @cindex RFC 822
26445 @cindex RFC 2822
26446 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26447
26448 @item RFC 1036
26449 @cindex RFC 1036
26450 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26451
26452 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26453 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26454 We do have some breaches to this one.
26455
26456 @table @emph
26457
26458 @item X-Newsreader
26459 @itemx User-Agent
26460 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26461 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26462 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26463 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26464 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26465 @end table
26466
26467 @item USEFOR
26468 @cindex USEFOR
26469 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26470 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26471 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26472 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26473
26474 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26475 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26476 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26477
26478 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26479 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26480
26481 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26482 @cindex RFC 1991
26483 @cindex RFC 2440
26484 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26485 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26486 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26487 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26488 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26489 decryption).
26490
26491 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26492 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26493 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26494 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26495
26496 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26497 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26498
26499 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26500 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26501 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26502 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26503 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26504 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26505 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26506 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26507
26508 @end table
26509
26510 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26511 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26512 know.
26513
26514
26515 @node Emacsen
26516 @subsection Emacsen
26517 @cindex Emacsen
26518 @cindex XEmacs
26519 @cindex Mule
26520 @cindex Emacs
26521
26522 This version of Gnus should work on:
26523
26524 @itemize @bullet
26525
26526 @item
26527 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26528
26529 @item
26530 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26531
26532 @end itemize
26533
26534 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26535 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26536 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26537 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26538
26539 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26540 @c synced here!
26541
26542 @node Gnus Development
26543 @subsection Gnus Development
26544
26545 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26546 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26547 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26548 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26549 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26550 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26551 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26552 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26553
26554 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26555 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26556 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26557 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26558 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26559 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26560 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26561 in Emacs.
26562
26563 @cindex Incoming*
26564 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26565 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26566 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26567 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26568 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26569
26570 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26571 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26572 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26573 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26574 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26575 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26576 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26577 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26578 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26579 can't be assumed to do so.
26580
26581 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26582 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26583 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26584
26585 @cindex Incoming*
26586 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26587 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26588 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26589 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26590 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26591
26592 @node Contributors
26593 @subsection Contributors
26594 @cindex contributors
26595
26596 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26597 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26598 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26599 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26600 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26601 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26602 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26603 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26604 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26605 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26606
26607 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26608 wrong show.
26609
26610 @itemize @bullet
26611
26612 @item
26613 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26614
26615 @item
26616 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26617 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26618 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26619 functionality and stuff.
26620
26621 @item
26622 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26623 well as numerous other things).
26624
26625 @item
26626 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26627
26628 @item
26629 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26630
26631 @item
26632 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26633
26634 @item
26635 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26636
26637 @item
26638 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26639 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26640
26641 @item
26642 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26643
26644 @item
26645 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26646
26647 @item
26648 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26649
26650 @item
26651 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26652
26653 @item
26654 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26655
26656 @item
26657 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26658
26659 @item
26660 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26661 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26662
26663 @item
26664 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26665
26666 @item
26667 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26668
26669 @item
26670 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26671
26672 @item
26673 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26674 .newsrc files.
26675
26676 @item
26677 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26678
26679 @item
26680 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26681
26682 @item
26683 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26684
26685 @item
26686 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26687 well as autoconf support.
26688
26689 @end itemize
26690
26691 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26692 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26693
26694 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26695
26696 Christopher Davis,
26697 Andrew Eskilsson,
26698 Kai Grossjohann,
26699 Kevin Greiner,
26700 Jesper Harder,
26701 Paul Jarc,
26702 Simon Josefsson,
26703 David K@aa{}gedal,
26704 Richard Pieri,
26705 Fabrice Popineau,
26706 Daniel Quinlan,
26707 Michael Shields,
26708 Reiner Steib,
26709 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26710 Jack Vinson,
26711 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26712 and
26713 Teodor Zlatanov.
26714
26715 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26716
26717 Jari Aalto,
26718 Adrian Aichner,
26719 Vladimir Alexiev,
26720 Russ Allbery,
26721 Peter Arius,
26722 Matt Armstrong,
26723 Marc Auslander,
26724 Miles Bader,
26725 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26726 Frank Bennett,
26727 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26728 Chris Bone,
26729 Mark Borges,
26730 Mark Boyns,
26731 Lance A. Brown,
26732 Rob Browning,
26733 Kees de Bruin,
26734 Martin Buchholz,
26735 Joe Buehler,
26736 Kevin Buhr,
26737 Alastair Burt,
26738 Joao Cachopo,
26739 Zlatko Calusic,
26740 Massimo Campostrini,
26741 Castor,
26742 David Charlap,
26743 Dan Christensen,
26744 Kevin Christian,
26745 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26746 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26747 Laura Conrad,
26748 Michael R. Cook,
26749 Glenn Coombs,
26750 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26751 Neil Crellin,
26752 Frank D. Cringle,
26753 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26754 Andre Deparade,
26755 Ulrik Dickow,
26756 Dave Disser,
26757 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26758 Joev Dubach,
26759 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26760 Dave Edmondson,
26761 Paul Eggert,
26762 Mark W. Eichin,
26763 Karl Eichwalder,
26764 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26765 Michael Ernst,
26766 Luc Van Eycken,
26767 Sam Falkner,
26768 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26769 Sigbjorn Finne,
26770 Sven Fischer,
26771 Paul Fisher,
26772 Decklin Foster,
26773 Gary D. Foster,
26774 Paul Franklin,
26775 Guy Geens,
26776 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26777 David S. Goldberg,
26778 Michelangelo Grigni,
26779 Dale Hagglund,
26780 D. Hall,
26781 Magnus Hammerin,
26782 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26783 Raja R. Harinath,
26784 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26785 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26786 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26787 Scott Hofmann,
26788 Tassilo Horn,
26789 Marc Horowitz,
26790 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26791 Richard Hoskins,
26792 Brad Howes,
26793 Miguel de Icaza,
26794 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26795 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26796 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26797 Lee Iverson,
26798 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26799 Rajappa Iyer,
26800 Andreas Jaeger,
26801 Adam P. Jenkins,
26802 Randell Jesup,
26803 Fred Johansen,
26804 Gareth Jones,
26805 Greg Klanderman,
26806 Karl Kleinpaste,
26807 Michael Klingbeil,
26808 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26809 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26810 Petr Konecny,
26811 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26812 Thor Kristoffersen,
26813 Jens Lautenbacher,
26814 Martin Larose,
26815 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26816 Joerg Lenneis,
26817 Carsten Leonhardt,
26818 James LewisMoss,
26819 Christian Limpach,
26820 Markus Linnala,
26821 Dave Love,
26822 Mike McEwan,
26823 Tonny Madsen,
26824 Shlomo Mahlab,
26825 Nat Makarevitch,
26826 Istvan Marko,
26827 David Martin,
26828 Jason R. Mastaler,
26829 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26830 Timo Metzemakers,
26831 Richard Mlynarik,
26832 Lantz Moore,
26833 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26834 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26835 Hrvoje Niksic,
26836 Andy Norman,
26837 Fred Oberhauser,
26838 C. R. Oldham,
26839 Alexandre Oliva,
26840 Ken Olstad,
26841 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26842 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26843 Ettore Perazzoli,
26844 William Perry,
26845 Stephen Peters,
26846 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26847 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26848 Matt Pharr,
26849 Andy Piper,
26850 John McClary Prevost,
26851 Bill Pringlemeir,
26852 Mike Pullen,
26853 Jim Radford,
26854 Colin Rafferty,
26855 Lasse Rasinen,
26856 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26857 Joe Reiss,
26858 Renaud Rioboo,
26859 Roland B. Roberts,
26860 Bart Robinson,
26861 Christian von Roques,
26862 Markus Rost,
26863 Jason Rumney,
26864 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26865 Jay Sachs,
26866 Dewey M. Sasser,
26867 Conrad Sauerwald,
26868 Loren Schall,
26869 Dan Schmidt,
26870 Ralph Schleicher,
26871 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26872 Andreas Schwab,
26873 Randal L. Schwartz,
26874 Danny Siu,
26875 Matt Simmons,
26876 Paul D. Smith,
26877 Jeff Sparkes,
26878 Toby Speight,
26879 Michael Sperber,
26880 Darren Stalder,
26881 Richard Stallman,
26882 Greg Stark,
26883 Sam Steingold,
26884 Paul Stevenson,
26885 Jonas Steverud,
26886 Paul Stodghill,
26887 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26888 Kurt Swanson,
26889 Samuel Tardieu,
26890 Teddy,
26891 Chuck Thompson,
26892 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26893 Philippe Troin,
26894 James Troup,
26895 Trung Tran-Duc,
26896 Jack Twilley,
26897 Aaron M. Ucko,
26898 Aki Vehtari,
26899 Didier Verna,
26900 Vladimir Volovich,
26901 Jan Vroonhof,
26902 Stefan Waldherr,
26903 Pete Ware,
26904 Barry A. Warsaw,
26905 Christoph Wedler,
26906 Joe Wells,
26907 Lee Willis,
26908 and
26909 Lloyd Zusman.
26910
26911
26912 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26913 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26914 (550kB and counting).
26915
26916 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26917 sure.
26918
26919 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26920 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26921
26922
26923 @node New Features
26924 @subsection New Features
26925 @cindex new features
26926
26927 @menu
26928 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
26929 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
26930 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
26931 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
26932 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
26933 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
26934 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
26935 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
26936 @end menu
26937
26938 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
26939 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
26940 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
26941
26942 @node ding Gnus
26943 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
26944
26945 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
26946
26947 @itemize @bullet
26948
26949 @item
26950 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
26951 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
26952
26953 @item
26954 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
26955 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
26956
26957 @item
26958 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
26959
26960 @item
26961 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
26962 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
26963 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
26964
26965 @item
26966 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
26967 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
26968 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
26969 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26970
26971 @item
26972 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
26973 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26974
26975 @item
26976 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
26977 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
26978 (@pxref{The Active File}).
26979
26980 @item
26981 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
26982 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
26983
26984 @item
26985 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
26986 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
26987 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26988
26989 @item
26990 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
26991 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
26992 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
26993
26994 @item
26995 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
26996 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
26997
26998 @item
26999 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27000 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27001
27002 @item
27003 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27004 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27005
27006 @item
27007 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27008 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27009
27010 @item
27011 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27012 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27013
27014 @item
27015 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27016
27017 @item
27018 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27019 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27020
27021 @item
27022 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27023 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27024
27025 @item
27026 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27027 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27028
27029 @item
27030 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27031
27032 @item
27033 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27034 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27035
27036 @item
27037 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27038 Articles}).
27039
27040 @item
27041 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27042 Buttons}).
27043
27044 @item
27045 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27046 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27047
27048 @end itemize
27049
27050
27051 @node September Gnus
27052 @subsubsection September Gnus
27053
27054 @iftex
27055 @iflatex
27056 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27057 @end iflatex
27058 @end iftex
27059
27060 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27061
27062 @itemize @bullet
27063
27064 @item
27065 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27066 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27067 now obsolete.
27068
27069 @item
27070 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27071 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27072 Threading}).
27073
27074 @lisp
27075 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27076 @end lisp
27077
27078 @item
27079 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27080 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27081
27082 @item
27083 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27084 referred.
27085
27086 @item
27087 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27088
27089 @item
27090 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27091
27092 @item
27093 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27094
27095 @lisp
27096 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27097 @end lisp
27098
27099 @item
27100 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27101 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27102
27103 @lisp
27104 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27105 @end lisp
27106
27107 @item
27108 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27109 Groups}).
27110
27111 @item
27112 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27113 Topics}).
27114
27115 @lisp
27116 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27117 @end lisp
27118
27119 @item
27120 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27121
27122 @item
27123 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27124 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27125
27126 @lisp
27127 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27128 @end lisp
27129
27130 @item
27131 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27132 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27133
27134 @item
27135 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27136
27137 @item
27138 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27139 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27140 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27141
27142 @item
27143 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27144
27145 @item
27146 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27147
27148 @item
27149 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27150 Groups}).
27151
27152 @item
27153 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27154 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27155
27156 @item
27157 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27158 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27159
27160 @item
27161 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27162 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27163
27164 @item
27165 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27166 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27167 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27168
27169 @item
27170 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27171 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27172
27173 @item
27174 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27175
27176 @item
27177 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27178
27179 @item
27180 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27181
27182 @item
27183 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27184
27185 @item
27186 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27187 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27188
27189 @item
27190 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27191 Layout}).
27192
27193 @item
27194 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27195 @iftex
27196 @iflatex
27197 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27198 @end iflatex
27199 @end iftex
27200
27201 @item
27202 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27203
27204 @lisp
27205 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27206 @end lisp
27207
27208 @item
27209 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27210
27211 @item
27212 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27213
27214 @item
27215 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27216 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27217
27218 @lisp
27219 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27220 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27221 @end lisp
27222
27223 @item
27224 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27225 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27226
27227 @lisp
27228 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27229 @end lisp
27230
27231 @item
27232 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27233 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27234
27235 @item
27236 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27237
27238 @item
27239 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27240 Articles}).
27241
27242 @lisp
27243 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27244 @end lisp
27245
27246 @item
27247 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27248 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27249
27250 @lisp
27251 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27252 @end lisp
27253
27254 @item
27255 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27256 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27257
27258 @item
27259 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27260 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27261
27262 @lisp
27263 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27264 @end lisp
27265
27266 @item
27267 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27268
27269 @item
27270 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27271
27272 @item
27273 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27274
27275 @end itemize
27276
27277
27278 @node Red Gnus
27279 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27280
27281 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27282
27283 @iftex
27284 @iflatex
27285 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27286 @end iflatex
27287 @end iftex
27288
27289 @itemize @bullet
27290
27291 @item
27292 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27293
27294 @item
27295 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27296 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27297
27298 @item
27299 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27300 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27301 Scoring}).
27302
27303 @item
27304 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27305 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27306
27307 @item
27308 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27309
27310 @item
27311 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27312 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27313
27314 @lisp
27315 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27316 @end lisp
27317
27318 @item
27319 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27320 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27321 been added.
27322
27323 @item
27324 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27325 Server Internals}).
27326
27327 @item
27328 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27329 Parameters}).
27330
27331 @item
27332 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27333
27334 @item
27335 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27336 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27337
27338 @item
27339 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27340 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27341 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27342
27343 @item
27344 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27345 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27346
27347 @item
27348 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27349 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27350
27351 @item
27352 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27353 (@pxref{Undo}).
27354
27355 @item
27356 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27357 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27358
27359 @item
27360 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27361 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27362
27363 @lisp
27364 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27365 @end lisp
27366
27367 @item
27368 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27369
27370 @lisp
27371 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27372 @end lisp
27373
27374 @item
27375 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27376 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27377
27378 @item
27379 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27380 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27381
27382 @item
27383 A new command for reading collections of documents
27384 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27385 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27386
27387 @item
27388 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27389 Marks}).
27390
27391 @item
27392 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27393 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27394
27395 @item
27396 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27397 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27398 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27399
27400 @item
27401 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27402 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27403 Sorting}).
27404
27405 @item
27406 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27407 Groups}).
27408
27409 @item
27410 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27411 Commands}).
27412 @iftex
27413 @iflatex
27414 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27415 @end iflatex
27416 @end iftex
27417
27418 @item
27419 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27420 Variables}).
27421
27422 @item
27423 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27424 Mail}).
27425
27426 @item
27427 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27428 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27429
27430 @item
27431 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27432
27433 @end itemize
27434
27435
27436 @node Quassia Gnus
27437 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27438
27439 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27440
27441 @itemize @bullet
27442
27443 @item
27444 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27445 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27446 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27447
27448 @item
27449 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27450 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27451 group, which is created automatically.
27452
27453 @item
27454 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27455 values.
27456
27457 @item
27458 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27459
27460 @item
27461 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27462 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27463
27464 @item
27465 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27466 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27467
27468 @item
27469 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27470
27471 @item
27472 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27473 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27474
27475 @item
27476 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27477
27478 @item
27479 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27480 details.
27481
27482 @item
27483 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27484 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27485
27486 @item
27487 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27488 control over simplification.
27489
27490 @item
27491 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27492
27493 @item
27494 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27495 limit.
27496
27497 @item
27498 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27499
27500 @item
27501 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27502
27503 @item
27504 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27505 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27506 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27507
27508 @item
27509 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27510 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27511
27512 @item
27513 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27514 text---@kbd{W d}.
27515
27516 @item
27517 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27518 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27519
27520 @item
27521 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27522 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27523
27524 @item
27525 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27526 has been added.
27527
27528 @item
27529 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27530
27531 @item
27532 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27533
27534 @item
27535 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27536 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27537
27538 @item
27539 A new function for citing in Message has been
27540 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27541
27542 @item
27543 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27544
27545 @item
27546 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27547 been added.
27548
27549 @item
27550 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27551 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27552
27553 @item
27554 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27555 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27556
27557 @item
27558 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27559
27560 @item
27561 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27562
27563 @end itemize
27564
27565 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27566 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27567
27568 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27569
27570 @itemize @bullet
27571
27572 @item
27573 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27574 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27575
27576 If you used procmail like in
27577
27578 @lisp
27579 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27580 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27581 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27582 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27583 @end lisp
27584
27585 this now has changed to
27586
27587 @lisp
27588 (setq mail-sources
27589 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27590 :suffix ".in")))
27591 @end lisp
27592
27593 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27594
27595 @item
27596 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27597 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27598
27599 @item
27600 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27601 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27602
27603 @item
27604 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27605 called to position point.
27606
27607 @item
27608 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27609 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27610
27611 @item
27612 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27613 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27614
27615 @item
27616 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27617 subtly different manner.
27618
27619 @item
27620 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27621 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27622 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27623
27624 @item
27625 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27626
27627 @end itemize
27628
27629 @node Oort Gnus
27630 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27631 @cindex Oort Gnus
27632
27633 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27634
27635 @itemize @bullet
27636
27637 @item Installation changes
27638 @c ***********************
27639
27640 @itemize @bullet
27641 @item
27642 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27643
27644 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27645 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27646 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27647 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27648 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27649 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27650 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27651 isn't save in general.
27652
27653 @item
27654 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27655 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27656 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27657 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27658 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27659 remove-installed-shadows}.
27660
27661 @item
27662 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27663
27664 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27665 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27666 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27667 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27668 the second parameter.
27669
27670 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27671 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27672 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27673 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27674 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27675 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27676 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27677 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27678 cycle used under Unix systems.
27679
27680 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27681 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27682
27683 @item
27684 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27685
27686 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27687 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27688 hierarchy.
27689
27690 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27691 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27692 @item
27693 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27694
27695 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27696 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27697 lisp directory into load-path.
27698
27699 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27700 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27701
27702 @end itemize
27703
27704 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27705 @c *****************************************
27706
27707 @itemize @bullet
27708
27709 @item
27710 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27711 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27712
27713 @item
27714 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27715
27716 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27717 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27718
27719 @item
27720 Improved anti-spam features.
27721
27722 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27723 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27724 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27725 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27726 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27727 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27728
27729 @item
27730 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27731
27732 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27733 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27734 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27735 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27736 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27737
27738 @end itemize
27739
27740 @item Changes in group mode
27741 @c ************************
27742
27743 @itemize @bullet
27744
27745 @item
27746 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27747 using @kbd{G M}.
27748
27749 @item
27750 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27751
27752 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27753 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27754
27755 @item
27756 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27757
27758 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27759 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27760 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27761 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27762 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27763 parameters, a'la:
27764 @lisp
27765 (setq gnus-parameters
27766 '(("mail\\..*"
27767 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27768 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27769 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27770 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27771 @end lisp
27772
27773 @item
27774 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27775
27776 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27777 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27778 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27779 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27780 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27781 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27782 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27783 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27784 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27785
27786 @item
27787 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27788
27789 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27790 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27791 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27792
27793 @item
27794 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27795 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27796
27797 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27798 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27799 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27800 @lisp
27801 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27802 @end lisp
27803
27804 @item
27805 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27806 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27807 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27808
27809 @end itemize
27810
27811 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27812 @c **************************************
27813
27814 @itemize @bullet
27815
27816 @item
27817 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27818 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27819 region if the region is active.
27820
27821 @item
27822 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27823 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27824
27825 @item
27826 Article Buttons
27827
27828 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27829 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27830 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27831 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27832
27833 @item
27834 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27835
27836 @item
27837 Picons
27838
27839 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27840 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27841
27842 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27843 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27844 @xref{Picons}.
27845
27846 @item
27847 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27848 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27849
27850 @item
27851 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27852
27853 @item
27854 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27855 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27856
27857 @item
27858 Warn about email replies to news
27859
27860 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27861 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27862 you.
27863
27864 @item
27865 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27866 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27867 built.
27868
27869 @item
27870 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27871 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27872
27873 @item
27874 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27875 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27876
27877 @item
27878 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27879 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27880
27881 @item
27882 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27883
27884 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27885 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27886 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27887 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27888 citations.
27889
27890 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27891 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27892 Outlook (Express) articles.
27893
27894 @item
27895 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27896
27897 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27898 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27899 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27900 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27901
27902 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27903 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27904 message cited below.
27905
27906 @item
27907 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
27908 Emacs too.
27909
27910 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27911 disable it.
27912
27913 @item
27914 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27915
27916 @item
27917 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27918 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27919
27920 @item
27921 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27922
27923 @item
27924 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27925
27926 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27927 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27928 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
27929 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
27930 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
27931 groups.
27932
27933 @item
27934 Deleting of attachments.
27935
27936 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
27937 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27938 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27939 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27940 that support editing.
27941
27942 @item
27943 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27944
27945 The default value is determined from the
27946 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27947 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
27948 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
27949
27950 @item
27951 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
27952
27953 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
27954 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
27955 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
27956
27957 @item
27958 Extended format specs.
27959
27960 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
27961 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
27962 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
27963 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
27964 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
27965 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27966
27967 @item
27968 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27969 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27970
27971 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
27972 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
27973 out other articles.
27974
27975 @item
27976 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
27977
27978 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
27979 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
27980 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
27981 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
27982
27983 @item
27984 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
27985
27986 @end itemize
27987
27988 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
27989 @c ****************************************************
27990
27991 @itemize @bullet
27992
27993 @item
27994 Delayed articles
27995
27996 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
27997 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
27998 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
27999
28000 @item
28001 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28002 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28003
28004 @item
28005 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28006 Gcc articles as read.
28007
28008 @item
28009 Externalizing of attachments
28010
28011 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28012 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28013 local files as external parts.
28014
28015 @item
28016 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28017 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28018
28019 @item
28020 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28021
28022 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28023 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28024 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28025 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28026 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28027 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28028 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28029 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28030 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28031
28032 @item
28033 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28034
28035 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28036 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28037 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28038 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28039 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28040 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28041
28042 @item
28043 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28044 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28045 @code{nil}.
28046
28047 @item
28048 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28049
28050 @item
28051 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28052
28053 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28054 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28055 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28056 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28057 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28058 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28059 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28060 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28061 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28062 was inserted directly.
28063
28064 @item
28065 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28066
28067 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28068 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28069 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28070 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28071 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28072
28073 @item
28074 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28075
28076 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28077 @lisp
28078 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28079 'bbdb-complete-name)
28080 @end lisp
28081
28082 @item
28083 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28084
28085 Add a new format of match like
28086 @lisp
28087 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28088 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28089 @end lisp
28090 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28091 @lisp
28092 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28093 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28094 @end lisp
28095
28096 @item
28097 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28098
28099 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28100 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28101 need add those two headers too.
28102
28103 @item
28104 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28105 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28106 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28107 versions.
28108
28109 @item
28110 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28111 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28112 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28113 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28114 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28115
28116 @item
28117 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28118
28119 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28120
28121 @item
28122 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28123
28124 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28125 the valid values.
28126
28127 @item
28128 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28129
28130 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28131 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28132 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28133 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28134 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28135 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28136 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28137 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28138
28139 @item
28140 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28141 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28142
28143 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28144 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28145 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28146 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28147
28148 @item
28149 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28150 C-m}.
28151
28152 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28153 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28154
28155 @item
28156 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28157 @code{best}.
28158
28159 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28160 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28161 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28162 invalidate the digital signature.
28163
28164 @item
28165 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28166 decompressed when activated.
28167 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28168
28169 @item
28170 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28171
28172 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28173 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28174 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28175 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28176 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28177 controls this.
28178
28179 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28180 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28181 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28182 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28183
28184 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28185 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28186 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28187 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28188
28189 @end itemize
28190
28191 @item Changes in back ends
28192 @c ***********************
28193
28194 @itemize @bullet
28195 @item
28196 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28197
28198 @item
28199 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28200
28201 @item
28202 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28203
28204 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28205
28206 @item
28207 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28208
28209 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28210 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28211 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28212 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28213 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28214 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28215 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28216 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28217 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28218 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28219 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28220
28221 @end itemize
28222
28223 @item Appearance
28224 @c *************
28225
28226 @itemize @bullet
28227
28228 @item
28229 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28230 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28231
28232 @item
28233 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28234 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28235 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28236 message, Message Manual}).
28237
28238 @item
28239 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28240 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28241 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28242 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28243
28244 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28245 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28246 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28247 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28248 @end itemize
28249
28250
28251 @item Miscellaneous changes
28252 @c ************************
28253
28254 @itemize @bullet
28255
28256 @item
28257 @code{gnus-agent}
28258
28259 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28260 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28261 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28262 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28263 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28264 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28265 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28266 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28267 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28268 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28269 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28270 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28271 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28272 is not needed any more.
28273
28274 @item
28275 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28276
28277 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28278 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28279 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28280
28281 @item
28282 Dired integration
28283
28284 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28285 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28286 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28287 entry.
28288
28289 @item
28290 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28291
28292 @item
28293 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28294
28295 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28296
28297 @end itemize
28298
28299 @end itemize
28300
28301 @node No Gnus
28302 @subsubsection No Gnus
28303 @cindex No Gnus
28304
28305 New features in No Gnus:
28306 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28307
28308 @include gnus-news.texi
28309
28310 @node Ma Gnus
28311 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28312 @cindex Ma Gnus
28313
28314 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28315 Gnus.
28316
28317 New features in Ma Gnus:
28318
28319 @itemize @bullet
28320
28321 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28322 @c ****************************************************
28323
28324 @itemize @bullet
28325
28326 @item
28327 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28328 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28329 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28330 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28331
28332 @end itemize
28333
28334 @end itemize
28335
28336 @iftex
28337
28338 @page
28339 @node The Manual
28340 @section The Manual
28341 @cindex colophon
28342 @cindex manual
28343
28344 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28345 either @code{texi2dvi}
28346 @iflatex
28347 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28348 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28349 @end iflatex
28350 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28351
28352 The following conventions have been used:
28353
28354 @enumerate
28355
28356 @item
28357 This is a @samp{string}
28358
28359 @item
28360 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28361
28362 @item
28363 This is a @file{file}
28364
28365 @item
28366 This is a @code{symbol}
28367
28368 @end enumerate
28369
28370 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28371 mean:
28372
28373 @lisp
28374 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28375 @end lisp
28376
28377 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28378
28379 @lisp
28380 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28381 @end lisp
28382
28383 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28384 ever get them confused.
28385
28386 @iflatex
28387 @c @head
28388 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28389 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28390 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28391 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28392 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28393 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28394 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28395 @end iflatex
28396
28397 @end iftex
28398
28399
28400 @node On Writing Manuals
28401 @section On Writing Manuals
28402
28403 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28404 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28405 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28406 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28407 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28408 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28409 in hand.
28410
28411 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28412 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28413 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28414 started with Gnus.
28415
28416 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28417 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28418
28419
28420 @page
28421 @node Terminology
28422 @section Terminology
28423
28424 @cindex terminology
28425 @table @dfn
28426
28427 @item news
28428 @cindex news
28429 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28430 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28431 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28432 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28433 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28434
28435 @item mail
28436 @cindex mail
28437 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28438 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28439 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28440 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28441
28442 @item reply
28443 @cindex reply
28444 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28445
28446 @item follow up
28447 @cindex follow up
28448 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28449 are reading.
28450
28451 @item back end
28452 @cindex back end
28453 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28454 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28455 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28456 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28457 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28458 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28459 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28460 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28461 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28462 number 4711''.
28463
28464 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28465 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28466 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28467 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28468 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28469 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28470
28471 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28472 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28473 access the articles.
28474
28475 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28476 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28477 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28478 confusing.
28479
28480 @item native
28481 @cindex native
28482 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28483 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28484 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28485
28486 @item foreign
28487 @cindex foreign
28488 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28489 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28490 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28491 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28492
28493 @item secondary
28494 @cindex secondary
28495 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28496 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28497 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28498
28499 @item article
28500 @cindex article
28501 A message that has been posted as news.
28502
28503 @item mail message
28504 @cindex mail message
28505 A message that has been mailed.
28506
28507 @item message
28508 @cindex message
28509 A mail message or news article
28510
28511 @item head
28512 @cindex head
28513 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
28514 put.
28515
28516 @item body
28517 @cindex body
28518 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28519 body.
28520
28521 @item header
28522 @cindex header
28523 A line from the head of an article.
28524
28525 @item headers
28526 @cindex headers
28527 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28528 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28529
28530 @item @acronym{NOV}
28531 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28532 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28533 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28534 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28535 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28536 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28537
28538 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28539 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28540 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28541 normal @sc{head} format.
28542
28543 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28544 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28545 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28546 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28547 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28548 references, etc.
28549
28550 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28551 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28552 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28553 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28554 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28555 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28556 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28557
28558 @item level
28559 @cindex levels
28560 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28561 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28562 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28563 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28564 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28565 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28566
28567 @item killed groups
28568 @cindex killed groups
28569 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28570 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28571
28572 @item zombie groups
28573 @cindex zombie groups
28574 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28575
28576 @item active file
28577 @cindex active file
28578 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28579 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28580 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28581
28582 @item bogus groups
28583 @cindex bogus groups
28584 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28585 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28586 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28587
28588 @item activating
28589 @cindex activating groups
28590 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28591 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28592 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28593
28594 @item spool
28595 @cindex spool
28596 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28597 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28598 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28599
28600 @item server
28601 @cindex server
28602 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28603
28604 @item select method
28605 @cindex select method
28606 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28607 server settings.
28608
28609 @item virtual server
28610 @cindex virtual server
28611 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28612 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28613 whole is a virtual server.
28614
28615 @item washing
28616 @cindex washing
28617 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28618 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28619 original.
28620
28621 @item ephemeral groups
28622 @cindex ephemeral groups
28623 @cindex temporary groups
28624 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28625 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28626 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28627
28628 @item solid groups
28629 @cindex solid groups
28630 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28631 group buffer are solid groups.
28632
28633 @item sparse articles
28634 @cindex sparse articles
28635 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28636 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28637
28638 @item threading
28639 @cindex threading
28640 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28641 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28642
28643 @item root
28644 @cindex root
28645 @cindex thread root
28646 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28647 articles in the thread.
28648
28649 @item parent
28650 @cindex parent
28651 An article that has responses.
28652
28653 @item child
28654 @cindex child
28655 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28656
28657 @item digest
28658 @cindex digest
28659 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28660 specified by RFC 1153.
28661
28662 @item splitting
28663 @cindex splitting, terminology
28664 @cindex mail sorting
28665 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28666 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28667 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28668
28669 @end table
28670
28671
28672 @page
28673 @node Customization
28674 @section Customization
28675 @cindex general customization
28676
28677 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28678 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28679 for some quite common situations.
28680
28681 @menu
28682 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28683 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28684 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28685 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28686 @end menu
28687
28688
28689 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28690 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28691
28692 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28693 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28694 Gnus has to get from the server.
28695
28696 @table @code
28697
28698 @item gnus-read-active-file
28699 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28700 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28701 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28702 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28703 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28704
28705 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28706 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28707 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28708 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28709 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28710 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28711 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28712 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28713 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28714 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28715 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28716
28717 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28718 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28719 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28720 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28721 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28722 variables.
28723 @end table
28724
28725
28726 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28727 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28728
28729 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28730 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28731 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28732
28733 @table @code
28734
28735 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28736 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28737 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28738 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28739 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28740
28741 @item gnus-visible-headers
28742 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28743 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28744 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28745 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28746
28747 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28748 @lisp
28749 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28750 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28751 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28752 @end lisp
28753
28754 @item gnus-use-full-window
28755 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28756 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28757 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28758 want to read them anyway.
28759
28760 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28761 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28762 hidden initially.
28763
28764
28765 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28766 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28767 lines, which might save some time.
28768 @end table
28769
28770
28771 @node Little Disk Space
28772 @subsection Little Disk Space
28773 @cindex disk space
28774
28775 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28776 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28777
28778 @table @code
28779
28780 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28781 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28782 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28783 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28784 default.
28785
28786 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28787 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28788 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28789 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28790 default.
28791
28792 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28793 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28794 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28795 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28796 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28797
28798 @end table
28799
28800
28801 @node Slow Machine
28802 @subsection Slow Machine
28803 @cindex slow machine
28804
28805 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28806 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28807
28808 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28809 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28810
28811 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28812 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28813 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28814
28815
28816 @page
28817 @node Troubleshooting
28818 @section Troubleshooting
28819 @cindex troubleshooting
28820
28821 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28822 problems, really.
28823
28824 Ahem.
28825
28826 @enumerate
28827
28828 @item
28829 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28830
28831 @item
28832 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28833 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28834 Gnus will work.
28835
28836 @item
28837 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28838 like @c
28839 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28840 @c
28841 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28842 files lying around. Delete these.
28843
28844 @item
28845 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28846 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28847
28848 @item
28849 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28850 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28851 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28852 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28853 something like that.
28854 @end enumerate
28855
28856 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28857
28858 @cindex bugs
28859 @cindex reporting bugs
28860
28861 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28862 @findex gnus-bug
28863 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28864 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28865 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28866 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28867
28868 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28869 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28870 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28871 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28872 time.
28873
28874 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28875 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28876 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28877 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28878 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28879 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28880
28881 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28882 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28883 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28884 the bug report.
28885
28886 @cindex patches
28887 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28888 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28889
28890 @cindex edebug
28891 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28892 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28893 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28894 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28895 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28896 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28897 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28898 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28899 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28900 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28901 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28902 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28903 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28904 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28905
28906 @cindex elp
28907 @cindex profile
28908 @cindex slow
28909 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28910 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28911 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28912 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28913 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28914
28915 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
28916 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28917 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28918 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
28919 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28920 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28921 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28922 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28923 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28924 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28925 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28926 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28927 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28928 work perfectly.
28929
28930 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28931 @cindex ding mailing list
28932 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28933 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28934 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28935 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28936
28937
28938 @page
28939 @node Gnus Reference Guide
28940 @section Gnus Reference Guide
28941
28942 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
28943 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
28944 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
28945 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
28946 it.
28947
28948 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
28949 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
28950 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
28951 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
28952 and general methods of operation.
28953
28954 @menu
28955 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
28956 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
28957 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
28958 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
28959 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
28960 * Group Info:: The group info format.
28961 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
28962 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
28963 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
28964 @end menu
28965
28966
28967 @node Gnus Utility Functions
28968 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
28969 @cindex Gnus utility functions
28970 @cindex utility functions
28971 @cindex functions
28972 @cindex internal variables
28973
28974 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
28975 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
28976 Below is a list of the most common ones.
28977
28978 @table @code
28979
28980 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
28981 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
28982 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
28983
28984 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
28985 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
28986 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
28987
28988 @item gnus-group-real-name
28989 @findex gnus-group-real-name
28990 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
28991 name.
28992
28993 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
28994 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
28995 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
28996 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
28997
28998 @item gnus-get-info
28999 @findex gnus-get-info
29000 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29001
29002 @item gnus-group-unread
29003 @findex gnus-group-unread
29004 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29005 unknown.
29006
29007 @item gnus-active
29008 @findex gnus-active
29009 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29010 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29011
29012 @item gnus-set-active
29013 @findex gnus-set-active
29014 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29015
29016 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29017 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29018 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29019 exit.
29020
29021 @item gnus-continuum-version
29022 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29023 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29024 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29025 versions.
29026
29027 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29028 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29029 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29030
29031 @item gnus-news-group-p
29032 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29033 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29034
29035 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29036 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29037 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29038
29039 @item gnus-server-to-method
29040 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29041 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29042
29043 @item gnus-server-equal
29044 @findex gnus-server-equal
29045 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29046 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29047 this function will consider them equal.
29048
29049 @item gnus-group-native-p
29050 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29051 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29052
29053 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29054 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29055 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29056
29057 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29058 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29059 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29060
29061 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29062 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29063 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29064 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29065 @var{group}.
29066
29067 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29068 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29069 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29070
29071 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29072 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29073 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29074
29075 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29076 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29077 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29078 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29079
29080 @lisp
29081 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29082 @result{} t
29083 @end lisp
29084
29085 @item gnus-read-method
29086 @findex gnus-read-method
29087 Prompts the user for a select method.
29088
29089 @end table
29090
29091
29092 @node Back End Interface
29093 @subsection Back End Interface
29094
29095 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29096 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29097 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29098 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29099 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29100 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29101
29102 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29103 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29104 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29105 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29106 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29107 been opened, the function should fail.
29108
29109 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29110 name. Take this example:
29111
29112 @lisp
29113 (nntp "odd-one"
29114 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29115 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29116 @end lisp
29117
29118 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29119 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29120
29121 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29122 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29123 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29124
29125 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29126 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29127 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29128
29129 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29130 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29131 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29132 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29133 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29134 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29135 return value.
29136
29137 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29138 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29139 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29140 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29141 more.
29142
29143 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29144 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29145 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29146 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29147 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29148 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29149 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29150 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29151 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29152 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29153
29154 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29155 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29156 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29157 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29158 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29159 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29160 of numbers as long as possible.
29161
29162 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29163 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29164 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29165
29166 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29167 @code{nnchoke}.
29168
29169 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29170
29171 @menu
29172 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29173 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29174 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29175 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29176 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29177 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29178 @end menu
29179
29180
29181 @node Required Back End Functions
29182 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29183
29184 @table @code
29185
29186 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29187
29188 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29189 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29190 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29191 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29192
29193 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29194 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29195 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29196 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29197
29198 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29199 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29200 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29201 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29202 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29203 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29204 number, do maximum fetches.
29205
29206 Here's an example HEAD:
29207
29208 @example
29209 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29210 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29211 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29212 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29213 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29214 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29215 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29216 Lines: 26
29217 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29218 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29219 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29220 .
29221 @end example
29222
29223 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29224 these in the data buffer.
29225
29226 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29227
29228 @example
29229 headers = *head
29230 head = error / valid-head
29231 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29232 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29233 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29234 header = <text> eol
29235 @end example
29236
29237 @cindex BNF
29238 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29239
29240 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29241 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29242 separated by tabs.
29243
29244 @example
29245 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29246 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29247 field = <text except TAB>
29248 @end example
29249
29250 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29251 @pxref{Headers}.
29252
29253
29254 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29255
29256 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29257 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29258
29259 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29260 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29261 server. In fact, it should do so.
29262
29263 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29264 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29265
29266
29267 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29268
29269 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29270 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29271 reason.
29272
29273 There should be no data returned.
29274
29275
29276 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29277
29278 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29279 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29280 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29281 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29282
29283 There should be no data returned.
29284
29285
29286 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29287
29288 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29289 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29290 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29291 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29292
29293 There should be no data returned.
29294
29295
29296 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29297
29298 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29299
29300 There should be no data returned.
29301
29302
29303 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29304
29305 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29306 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29307 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29308 it would be nice if that were possible.
29309
29310 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29311 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29312 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29313 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29314 into its article buffer.
29315
29316 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29317 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29318 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29319 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29320 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29321 on successful article retrieval.
29322
29323
29324 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29325
29326 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29327 making @var{group} the current group.
29328
29329 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29330 the current group.
29331
29332 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29333 structure.
29334
29335 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29336
29337 @example
29338 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29339 @end example
29340
29341 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29342 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29343 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29344 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29345 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29346 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29347 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29348 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29349 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29350 highest as 0.
29351
29352 @example
29353 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29354 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29355 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29356 @end example
29357
29358
29359 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29360
29361 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29362 a no-op on most back ends.
29363
29364 There should be no data returned.
29365
29366
29367 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29368
29369 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29370 @emph{all}.
29371
29372 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29373
29374 @example
29375 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29376 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29377 @end example
29378
29379 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29380 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29381 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29382 and the highest as 0.
29383
29384 @example
29385 active-file = *active-line
29386 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29387 name = <string>
29388 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29389 @end example
29390
29391 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29392 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29393 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29394
29395
29396 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29397
29398 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29399 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29400 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29401 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29402 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29403 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29404
29405 There should be no result data from this function.
29406
29407 @end table
29408
29409
29410 @node Optional Back End Functions
29411 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29412
29413 @table @code
29414
29415 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29416
29417 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29418 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29419 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29420
29421 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29422 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29423 former is in the same format as the data from
29424 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29425 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29426
29427 @example
29428 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29429 @end example
29430
29431
29432 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29433
29434 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29435 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29436 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29437 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29438 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29439 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29440 the network resources).
29441
29442 There should be no result data from this function.
29443
29444
29445 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29446
29447 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29448 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29449 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29450 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29451 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29452 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29453 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29454 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29455
29456 There should be no result data from this function.
29457
29458
29459 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29460
29461 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29462 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
29463 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29464 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29465 propagate the mark information to the server.
29466
29467 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29468
29469 @example
29470 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29471 @end example
29472
29473 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29474 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29475 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29476 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29477 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29478 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29479 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29480 itself to these.
29481
29482 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29483 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29484 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29485 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29486
29487 An example action list:
29488
29489 @example
29490 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29491 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29492 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29493 @end example
29494
29495 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29496 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29497
29498 There should be no result data from this function.
29499
29500 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29501
29502 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29503 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29504 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29505 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29506 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29507
29508 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29509 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29510 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29511 expirable.
29512
29513 There should be no result data from this function.
29514
29515
29516 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29517
29518 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29519 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29520 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29521 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29522 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29523 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29524 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29525 local if that's practical.
29526
29527 There should be no result data from this function.
29528
29529
29530 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29531
29532 The result data from this function should be a description of
29533 @var{group}.
29534
29535 @example
29536 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29537 name = <string>
29538 description = <text>
29539 @end example
29540
29541 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29542
29543 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29544 groups available on the server.
29545
29546 @example
29547 description-buffer = *description-line
29548 @end example
29549
29550
29551 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29552
29553 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29554 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29555 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29556 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29557 in the active buffer format.
29558
29559 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29560 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29561 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29562 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29563 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29564 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29565 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29566
29567
29568 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29569
29570 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29571
29572 There should be no return data.
29573
29574
29575 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29576
29577 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29578 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29579 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29580 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29581 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29582 they are.
29583
29584 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29585 able to delete.
29586
29587 There should be no result data returned.
29588
29589
29590 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29591
29592 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29593 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29594
29595 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29596 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29597 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29598 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29599 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29600 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29601
29602 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29603 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29604 optimizations.
29605
29606 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29607 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29608
29609 There should be no data returned.
29610
29611
29612 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29613
29614 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29615 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29616 this function in short order.
29617
29618 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29619 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29620
29621 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29622 article for that group.
29623
29624 There should be no data returned.
29625
29626
29627 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29628
29629 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29630 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29631
29632 There should be no data returned.
29633
29634
29635 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29636
29637 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29638 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29639 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29640
29641 There should be no data returned.
29642
29643
29644 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29645
29646 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29647 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29648
29649 There should be no data returned.
29650
29651 @end table
29652
29653
29654 @node Error Messaging
29655 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29656
29657 @findex nnheader-report
29658 @findex nnheader-get-report
29659 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29660 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29661 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29662 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29663 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29664 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29665
29666 @lisp
29667 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29668
29669 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29670 @end lisp
29671
29672 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29673 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29674 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29675 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29676
29677 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29678 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29679 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29680
29681
29682 @node Writing New Back Ends
29683 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29684
29685 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29686 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29687 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29688 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29689 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29690 editing articles.
29691
29692 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29693 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29694 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29695
29696 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29697 package called @code{nnoo}.
29698
29699 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29700 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29701 following macros:
29702
29703 @table @code
29704
29705 @item nnoo-declare
29706 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29707 parameters. For instance:
29708
29709 @lisp
29710 (nnoo-declare nndir
29711 nnml nnmh)
29712 @end lisp
29713
29714 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29715 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29716
29717 @item defvoo
29718 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29719 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29720 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29721
29722 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29723 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29724 a function in those back ends.
29725
29726 @lisp
29727 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29728 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29729 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29730 @end lisp
29731
29732 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29733 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29734 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29735
29736 @item nnoo-define-basics
29737 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29738 have.
29739
29740 @lisp
29741 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29742 @end lisp
29743
29744 @item deffoo
29745 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29746 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29747 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29748
29749 @item nnoo-map-functions
29750 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29751 functions from the parent back ends.
29752
29753 @lisp
29754 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29755 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29756 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29757 @end lisp
29758
29759 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29760 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29761 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29762 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29763
29764 @item nnoo-import
29765 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29766 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29767 haven't already been defined.
29768
29769 @lisp
29770 (nnoo-import nndir
29771 (nnmh
29772 nnmh-request-list
29773 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29774 (nnml))
29775 @end lisp
29776
29777 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29778 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29779 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29780 defined now.
29781
29782 @end table
29783
29784 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29785
29786 @lisp
29787 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29788 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29789
29790 ;;; @r{Code:}
29791
29792 (require 'nnheader)
29793 (require 'nnmh)
29794 (require 'nnml)
29795 (require 'nnoo)
29796 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29797
29798 (nnoo-declare nndir
29799 nnml nnmh)
29800
29801 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29802 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29803 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29804
29805 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29806 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29807 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29808
29809 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29810 nil
29811 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29812 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29813 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29814
29815 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29816 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29817
29818 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29819
29820 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29821
29822 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29823 (setq nndir-directory
29824 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29825 server))
29826 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29827 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29828 (push `(nndir-current-group
29829 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29830 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29831 defs)
29832 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29833 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29834 defs)
29835 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29836
29837 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29838 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29839 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29840 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29841 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29842
29843 (nnoo-import nndir
29844 (nnmh
29845 nnmh-status-message
29846 nnmh-request-list
29847 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29848
29849 (provide 'nndir)
29850 @end lisp
29851
29852
29853 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29854 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29855
29856 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29857 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29858 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29859 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29860 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29861
29862 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29863 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29864
29865 Here's an example:
29866
29867 @lisp
29868 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29869 @end lisp
29870
29871 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29872
29873 The abilities can be:
29874
29875 @table @code
29876 @item mail
29877 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29878 @item post
29879 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29880 @item post-mail
29881 This back end supports both mail and news.
29882 @item none
29883 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29884 different.
29885 @item respool
29886 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29887 articles and groups.
29888 @item address
29889 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29890 true for almost all back ends.
29891 @item prompt-address
29892 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29893 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29894 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29895 @end table
29896
29897
29898 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29899 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29900
29901 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29902 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29903 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29904 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29905
29906 @lisp
29907 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29908 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29909 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29910 @end lisp
29911
29912 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29913 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29914 mail.
29915
29916 This function takes four parameters.
29917
29918 @table @var
29919 @item method
29920 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29921 the call.
29922
29923 @item exit-function
29924 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29925
29926 @item temp-directory
29927 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29928
29929 @item group
29930 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29931 performed for one group only.
29932 @end table
29933
29934 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29935 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29936 find the article number assigned to this article.
29937
29938 The function also uses the following variables:
29939 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
29940 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
29941 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
29942 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
29943 this:
29944
29945 @example
29946 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
29947 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
29948 @end example
29949
29950
29951 @node Score File Syntax
29952 @subsection Score File Syntax
29953
29954 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
29955 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
29956 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
29957
29958 Here's a typical score file:
29959
29960 @lisp
29961 (("summary"
29962 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
29963 ("Gnus"))
29964 ("from"
29965 ("Lars" -1000))
29966 (mark -100))
29967 @end lisp
29968
29969 BNF definition of a score file:
29970
29971 @example
29972 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
29973 element = rule / atom
29974 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
29975 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
29976 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
29977 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
29978 quote = <ascii 34>
29979 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
29980 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
29981 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
29982 date-header = "date"
29983 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29984 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29985 score = "nil" / <integer>
29986 date = "nil" / <natural number>
29987 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
29988 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
29989 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
29990 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
29991 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29992 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29993 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
29994 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29995 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
29996 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
29997 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
29998 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
29999 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30000 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30001 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30002 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30003 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30004 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30005 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30006 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30007 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30008 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30009 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30010 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30011 eval = "eval" space <form>
30012 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30013 @end example
30014
30015 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30016 discarded.
30017
30018 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30019 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30020 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30021 one looong line, then that's ok.
30022
30023 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30024 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30025
30026
30027 @node Headers
30028 @subsection Headers
30029
30030 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30031 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30032 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30033 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30034
30035 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30036 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30037 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30038 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30039 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30040 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30041 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30042
30043 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30044 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30045 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30046 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30047 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30048
30049 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30050 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30051
30052
30053 @node Ranges
30054 @subsection Ranges
30055
30056 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30057 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30058
30059 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30060 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30061 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30062 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30063
30064 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30065 sequence.
30066
30067 @example
30068 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30069 @end example
30070
30071 is transformed into
30072
30073 @example
30074 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30075 @end example
30076
30077 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30078 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30079
30080 @example
30081 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30082 @end example
30083
30084 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30085 is slightly tricky:
30086
30087 @example
30088 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30089 @end example
30090
30091 and
30092
30093 @example
30094 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30095 @end example
30096
30097 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30098
30099 @example
30100 (1 2 3 4 5)
30101 @end example
30102
30103 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30104 also valid:
30105
30106 @example
30107 (1 . 5)
30108 @end example
30109
30110 and is equal to the previous range.
30111
30112 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30113 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30114 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30115 range handling.)
30116
30117 @example
30118 range = simple-range / normal-range
30119 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30120 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30121 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30122 number *[ " " contents ]
30123 @end example
30124
30125 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30126 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30127 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30128 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30129 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30130 sequences.)
30131
30132
30133 @node Group Info
30134 @subsection Group Info
30135
30136 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30137 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30138 describes the group.
30139
30140 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30141 second is a more complex one:
30142
30143 @example
30144 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30145
30146 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30147 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30148 (nnml "")
30149 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30150 @end example
30151
30152 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30153 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30154 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30155 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30156 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30157 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30158 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30159 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30160 this section is about.
30161
30162 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30163 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30164 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30165
30166 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30167
30168 @example
30169 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30170 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30171 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30172 group = quote <string> quote
30173 ralevel = rank / level
30174 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30175 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30176 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30177 read = range
30178 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30179 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30180 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30181 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30182 @end example
30183
30184 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30185 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30186 in pseudo-BNF.
30187
30188 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30189 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30190
30191 @table @code
30192 @item gnus-info-group
30193 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30194 @findex gnus-info-group
30195 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30196 Get/set the group name.
30197
30198 @item gnus-info-rank
30199 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30200 @findex gnus-info-rank
30201 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30202 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30203
30204 @item gnus-info-level
30205 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30206 @findex gnus-info-level
30207 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30208 Get/set the group level.
30209
30210 @item gnus-info-score
30211 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30212 @findex gnus-info-score
30213 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30214 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30215
30216 @item gnus-info-read
30217 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30218 @findex gnus-info-read
30219 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30220 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30221
30222 @item gnus-info-marks
30223 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30224 @findex gnus-info-marks
30225 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30226 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30227
30228 @item gnus-info-method
30229 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30230 @findex gnus-info-method
30231 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30232 Get/set the group select method.
30233
30234 @item gnus-info-params
30235 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30236 @findex gnus-info-params
30237 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30238 Get/set the group parameters.
30239 @end table
30240
30241 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30242 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30243
30244 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30245 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30246 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30247 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30248
30249
30250 @node Extended Interactive
30251 @subsection Extended Interactive
30252 @cindex interactive
30253 @findex gnus-interactive
30254
30255 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30256 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30257 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30258
30259 @lisp
30260 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30261 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30262 ...
30263 )
30264 @end lisp
30265
30266 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30267 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30268 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30269 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30270 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30271 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30272 @code{interactive}.
30273
30274 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30275 adds a few more.
30276
30277 @table @samp
30278 @item y
30279 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30280 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30281 variable.
30282
30283 @item Y
30284 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30285 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30286 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30287
30288 @item A
30289 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30290 function.
30291
30292 @item H
30293 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30294 function.
30295
30296 @item g
30297 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30298 function.
30299
30300 @end table
30301
30302
30303 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30304 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30305 @cindex XEmacs
30306 @cindex Emacsen
30307
30308 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30309 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30310 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30311
30312 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30313 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30314 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30315 Gnus, that's very useful.
30316
30317 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30318 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30319 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30320 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30321 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30322 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30323 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30324 following function:
30325
30326 @lisp
30327 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30328 (start-itimer
30329 "gnus-run-at-time"
30330 `(lambda ()
30331 (,function ,@@args))
30332 time repeat))
30333 @end lisp
30334
30335 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30336 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30337 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30338 all over.
30339
30340 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30341 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30342 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30343
30344 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30345 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30346 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30347
30348
30349 @node Various File Formats
30350 @subsection Various File Formats
30351
30352 @menu
30353 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30354 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30355 @end menu
30356
30357
30358 @node Active File Format
30359 @subsubsection Active File Format
30360
30361 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30362 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30363 in each group.
30364
30365 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30366
30367 @example
30368 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30369 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30370 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30371 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30372 no.general 1000 900 y
30373 @end example
30374
30375 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30376
30377 @example
30378 active = *group-line
30379 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30380 group = <non-white-space string>
30381 spc = " "
30382 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30383 low-number = <positive integer>
30384 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30385 @end example
30386
30387 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30388 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30389
30390
30391 @node Newsgroups File Format
30392 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30393
30394 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30395 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30396 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30397 the user.
30398
30399 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30400 Here's the definition:
30401
30402 @example
30403 newsgroups = *line
30404 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30405 group = <non-white-space string>
30406 tab = <TAB>
30407 description = <string>
30408 @end example
30409
30410
30411 @page
30412 @node Emacs for Heathens
30413 @section Emacs for Heathens
30414
30415 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30416 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30417 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30418 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30419 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30420 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30421 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30422 cat instead.
30423
30424 @menu
30425 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30426 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30427 @end menu
30428
30429
30430 @node Keystrokes
30431 @subsection Keystrokes
30432
30433 @itemize @bullet
30434 @item
30435 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30436
30437 @item
30438 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30439 @end itemize
30440
30441 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30442 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30443 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30444 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30445 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30446 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30447
30448 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30449 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30450 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30451 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30452 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30453 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30454 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30455
30456 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30457 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30458 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30459 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30460 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30461 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30462 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30463
30464 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30465 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30466 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30467 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30468 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30469 it.
30470
30471
30472
30473 @node Emacs Lisp
30474 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30475
30476 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30477 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30478 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30479 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30480
30481 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30482 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30483 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30484 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30485 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30486 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30487 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30488 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30489 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30490 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30491
30492 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30493 write the following:
30494
30495 @lisp
30496 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30497 @end lisp
30498
30499 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30500 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30501 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30502 change how Gnus works.
30503
30504 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30505 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30506 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30507 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30508 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30509
30510 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30511 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30512 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30513
30514 Some pitfalls:
30515
30516 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30517 that means:
30518
30519 @lisp
30520 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30521 @end lisp
30522
30523 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30524 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30525
30526 @lisp
30527 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30528 @end lisp
30529
30530 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30531 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30532
30533 @page
30534 @include gnus-faq.texi
30535
30536 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30537 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30538 @include doclicense.texi
30539
30540 @node Index
30541 @chapter Index
30542 @printindex cp
30543
30544 @node Key Index
30545 @chapter Key Index
30546 @printindex ky
30547
30548 @bye
30549
30550 @iftex
30551 @iflatex
30552 \end{document}
30553 @end iflatex
30554 @end iftex
30555
30556 @c Local Variables:
30557 @c mode: texinfo
30558 @c coding: utf-8
30559 @c End: